Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Forms and Substances in The Arts - Etienne Gilson PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 327
At a glance
Powered by AI
The book discusses different arts including architecture, statuary, painting, music, dance, poetry, and theatre. It aims to test conclusions from another work about the nature of beauty in art.

The book is testing the validity of conclusions from another work about the arts of the beautiful by examining the major arts in more detail.

Some of the major arts discussed in the book include architecture, statuary, painting, music, dance, poetry, and theatre.

ETIENNE GILSON

Translated from the French by


SALVATOR ATTANASIO

Forms and Substances


in the Arts

Charles Scribner’s Sons New York


Copyright © 1966 Etienne Gilson
Matière et Formes (French language edition)
© 1964 Librairie Philosophique J. Vrin.

This book published simultaneously in the United States


of America and in Canada—Copyright under the Berne
Convention
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be produced
in any form without the permission of Charles Scribner’s
Sons.

A-9.66[V]

Printed in the United States of America


Library of Congress Catalog Card Number 66-24495

ii
CONTENTS

Introduction 1
ONE The Distinction Between
the Arts of the Beautiful 18
TWO Architecture 45
THREE Statuary 87
FOUR Painting 122
FIVE Music 164
SIX The Dance 213
SEVEN Poetry 243
EIGHT The Theatre 282

iii
“ As a productive faculty of cognition,
the imagination is endowed with the great power
of creating another nature,
as it were, out of the material
that actual nature gives it. ”

IMMANUEL KANT:
Critique of Judgment # 49

iv
Introduction

THE OBJECT OF THIS BOOK is to test the validity of the


general and abstract conclusions arrived at in The Arts of
the Beautiful. The test will be made only with respect to
what might be called the major arts, that is to say, those to
which the other arts are ultimately reduced upon analysis
and which are but combinations of the major arts. It is
rare, moreover, to encounter a major art in its pure state,
and when such an opportunity arises it is difficult to
define the essence of an art of this kind in its absolute
purity. Expressions such as pure poetry, pure painting,
pure music, chiefly denote arenas in which the friends of
the fine arts obviously find pleasure in taking each other’s
measure, but the philosopher’s purpose is to separate into
distinct concepts a real complex which rightly resists
division into its components. Our only concern therefore
is to prepare an intelligible frame into which all the
particular kinds of beauty produced by each major art may
find a place, including even those arts which are still the
secret of the future.
This book should contain all the information
necessary to make it intelligible to the reader, but it is only
fair to warn him in advance that he will often encounter

1
expressions such as “the beautiful” and “beauty”. Today
such words suffice to discredit a philosophy in the minds
of those who, by confusing the philosophy of art with
metaphysics, imagine “the beautiful” as a sort of ideal
category, a transcendent and immutable thing in itself,
which the artist is duty-bound to imitate. Nothing of this
sort is here in question. Beauty is a property inseparable
from being, hence it is proper to every work of art; the
function of art, moreover, is to produce, not to imitate.
We shall never depart from concrete reality here save to
extract from it those concepts which alone enable us to
reflect upon reality. The task as such is difficult enough
and subject to possible errors. Our hope is that none will
be added to those which the book actually contains. For
this hope to be fulfilled, all the reader has to do is to
understand the book in terms of the concepts to which it
refers, as we have set them forth. It should be possible to
understand these concepts without necessarily being in
agreement with them.
We shall cite some of the concepts which will be taken
for granted here, if not approved, inasmuch as they have
been studied individually elsewhere. It is only a matter of
plainly stating some theoretical positions which shall be
posited throughout this study.
The first is the distinction between calology, the
philosophy of art, and esthetics. Calology is a part of
metaphysics, whose subject matter is the beautiful as a
transcendental of being. Hence, it is a branch of ontology.
Being, insofar as it partakes of the beautiful, goes far
beyond the field of art. We do not propose to discuss

2
being in this sense here. Esthetics is the apprehension of
the beautiful as produced by the fine arts. I do not know
whether or not this discipline is a science; in any case I
have never been able to find access to it. The philosophy
of art, if the arts of the beautiful are in question, has as its
object human activity in the general order of making,
whose proper end is to produce beautiful objects. These
objects are commonly known as “works of art”. Our
assumption here is that both disciplines share a common
concern with the work of art itself, but that they are in
actuality distinct. They are connected disciplines, inasmuch
as they have the work of art in common, but they are as
distinct from each other as making is from knowing, the
end of art being to produce a work, whereas esthetics
presupposes its completion. Art terminates in a work of
art, esthetic apprehension makes this terminus its point of
departure. The two disciplines are as different as writing a
symphony is from listening to one. Art alone will be under
discussion here, considerations answerable to esthetics will
figure in this study only as concrete experiences facilitating
our understanding of art.
The book’s very title implies acceptance of the classic
distinction in philosophy between matter and form. At the
outset the objection can be raised that this principle, by
virtue of its applicability to everything, actually explains
nothing. That is true, at least in the sense that by itself it
does not suffice to explain anything.
Our principal intention has been to determine, as
precisely as the subject matter allows, the structural
elements of form not only in the arts of the beautiful but

3
in each one of the major arts whose proper function is to
fashion this form.
The word form does not suggest a very precise image
to the mind. Among the twenty-five meanings or usages
of the word in Littré’s dictionary, none particularly applies
to the work of art. André Lalande’s authoritative
Vocabulaire notes first of all that “this term is almost
always opposed to matter” and follows it with an example
illustrating its specific meaning: “A. Geometric figure
consisting of the contours of an object. It is opposed to
the matter of which this object is made. ‘Wax takes the
form of the seal.’” By broadening this notion to the limits
of its generality and extending it to works of art, its
meaning might also be described as that arrangement
which makes the parts of a whole out of a plurality of
elements and thereby structures the latter into a distinct
object. This is one of the meanings that confirms the
scholastic adage: Forma dat esse. Without pushing as far as
the metaphysical ground of the formula, manifestly we
speak of a being only when we can grasp a plurality in a
principle of unity which is precisely its form. This can be
the form of a concept, of a mode of reasoning, of a tree,
of an animal, or of a man; it can also be that of a work of
art. To say that a symphony, a poem or any book is
“formless” is tantamount to denying its existence. This
being settled, it remains for us to determine the nature of
form in each particular work of art. Strictly speaking, form
is proper to each art, and its discernment in the very
process of perceiving it is what is called “understanding” a
work of art. A critic has a hard job to determine whether a

4
work lacks form or whether he fails to perceive it. Even an
artist would find it equally difficult to discuss particular
cases, for no two are alike, but we can try to distinguish
the general types of forms proper to some of the fine arts.
We shall not aim further.
This attempt, moreover, will lead us directly to the
concept of matter, itself viewed as the kind of plurality
which all artistry knows how to submit to the unity of
form. All material substances are given in nature or made
from natural products. Hence any art involves the use of
substances of this type, but what we shall have to say
about it presupposes the recognition of a truth which
might be called Focillon’s law: the material substances of nature
establish a new order upon becoming the material substances of art.
This is a truth of major importance in the philosophy of
art, but seemingly it is a hopeless task to try to convince
those who have not been convinced by direct evidence or
by reading Focillon’s The Life of Forms in Art. 1 In this
respect nothing can replace the third chapter of this book
in which Focillon formulates two principles that
complement each other. The first principle states that “all
different kinds of matter are subject to a certain destiny, or
at all events, to a certain formal vocation”; the second that
the materials an artist uses for his proper ends establish a
new order “even when they are bound together by the
strictest formal propriety.” The material substances of
nature and those of art constitute two distinct realms

1Trs. by Charles Beecher Hogan and George Kubler, Yale


University Press, New Haven, 1942.
5
“even if technical devices and manufacturers are not
introduced.” Indeed, all the physical qualities of a material
substance enter into the work of art only on the strength
of their plastic qualities. They no longer are only constitutive
elements of being in the work of art but, more accurately,
of being informed with beauty.
We shall come upon these notions again in a more
concrete context, but I thought it would be useful to
inscribe them as an exergue, so to speak, at the beginning
of this work. Whatever the reader may think of this book,
I suspect that he will inevitably interrupt his reading to
make some reservation, to add a finer nuance, or merely to
deny an assertion. I did this so often while writing the
book and trying to keep it within its proper frame that I
fail to see how others can avoid doing likewise. The fact is
that in matters of art, more than elsewhere, it is hardly
possible to avoid seeming to confuse what one has not
distinguished, or to separate what one does distinguish.
Everything is given as a whole and the philosopher
perforce must distinguish what art itself might try to
render all at once. That is his trade. The friends of art do
not need the philosopher to tell them that one can create
beauty out of almost nothing, or lay before her an
enormous amount of the most opulent materials and that,
at times, the same artist does both successively, or dreams
of doing so. There is not a single art which does not use
other arts as materials without the least concern for the
purity of essence which the philosopher must strive to
extract because “quiddity” is the primary if not the
ultimate object of his concern. The artist is free; no one is

6
authorized to prescribe rules for him, nor impose upon
him limits. The artist alone knows what he wants to do, and
although the work almost always falls short of the desired
end, partial success or failure are the only conceivable
sanctions of his work. They come too late to affect it, and
they are so uncertain that it is very difficult to say
something intelligible about them. Be that as it may, I
hope I have not provided any pretext for condemning or
despising any particular work of art; I would like to be able
to love them all, and I certainly have no intention of
spoiling the pleasure others derive from some works of art
which my own limitations often prevent me from
enjoying. I merely wanted to put my own ideas into some
kind of order; I hope too that I have avoided the spirit of
controversy that flares up so easily over these matters; if
on occasion I have taken the positions of others into
consideration, it was only for the purpose of establishing
my own more solidly. There are always several possible
orders; it is hard enough to pursue one and altogether
impossible to pursue several of them simultaneously.
Above all, I hope I shall not be taken unduly to task
for having adopted a point of view toward art that may be
considered too narrow. Actually I had to take great pains
to keep it within its proper limits. Only a powerful
metaphysical genius can attempt the synthesis of all
aspects of art, including the artist and the lover of art.
Hegel was such a genius. He was well aware of the
inadequacy of the term esthetics as a designation for the
object of his study. Rightly, Hegel saw the cause of this in
the German school of Christian Wolff, in which art was

7
considered from the point of view of the impression it
produces on the beholder. He accepted the term,
however, reserving to himself the right to determine
exactly its different possible meanings in the course of his
work: “These lectures are devoted to esthetics. Their
subject is the broad realm of the beautiful, in particular the
field of art and more precisely the fine arts.” Thus
esthetics, calology and the philosophy of art are posited as
a whole. We might prefer another attitude with regard to
the problems of art, but since Hegel did exactly what he
wanted to do, what right do we have to pick a quarrel with
him? Moreover, a great mind always finds something
interesting to say, whatever the point of view. Thus Hegel
deems the beauty of art to be superior to that of nature;
because it is the work of the spirit. The assertion ties in
too neatly with the requirements of his system not to be
slightly disquieting, but it is interesting. Is it true? I don”t
know too much about it and I am not even sure that it
does not compare two realities that defy comparison, but
what is beyond question is that the presence of the mind is
included in the apprehension of a work of art, and Hegel
forbids us to forget it. Furthermore, he defines the origin
of art as “the rational impulse man feels to raise his inner
world and that of nature to spiritual consciousness, to
make of it an object in which he recognizes himself.” The
definition is somewhat too broad for what is being
defined. Personally, what impresses me in a work of art is
the work itself and not myself. But can we say that Hegel
is mistaken? His definition is loose, but it is not erroneous.
But why should we prolong the discussion further in the

8
course of which all truth would disappear?
No work on esthetics will ever match the brevity of
Benedetto Croce’s article, published separately under the
title of “Esthetics in a Nutshell”: Aesthetics in nuce. What a
virtuoso! We sense that these pages literally flowed off the
tip of his pen and that he felt no need to ponder over
them. Yet nothing is missing, despite its brevity. In fifty-
eight pages, we learn what art or poetry is and what it is
not; the article contains a definition of “the science of art
or esthetics”, intuition and expression, expression and
communication, “the theory of the particular arts and
natural beauty”, literary and artistic genres, esthetic
categories, rhetoric, the grammar and the philosophy of
language, classicism and romanticism, artistic-literary
criticism and historiography. Even the history of esthetics
is not forgotten and a relevant bibliography is added for
good measure. Who would make himself ridiculous by
complaining? If this panoramic view makes one dizzy,
each one is free to choose a vantage point therein that
especially suits him. Discoursing on the philosophy of art,
one can even bestow upon himself the originality of
making art the center of his philosophical reflections.
It would even be more fruitless to kindle a controversy
here on the nature of art itself. In his excellent essay on
The Life and Work of Ravaisson, Henri Bergson attributes the
following formula to Ravaisson, although it is hard to say
whether it actually originated with him or with Bergson:
“It is the same intuition, differently utilized, which makes
the profound philosopher or the great artist.” This
formula gives me the great satisfaction of stating exactly

9
the opposite of what I believe to be true. If it were used as
a point of departure, there would no longer be agreement
on anything; there is no point in discussing it, but it is
useful to bear it in mind, for if they are not the “same
intuition”, these two intuitions perhaps share a
resemblance in their respective depths. In distinguishing
characteristics, let us remember not always to set them in
opposition.
Similar remarks would have a bearing on the opinions
that we can entertain of philosophies of art with which we
do not agree when the latter are formulated in the name of
a general philosophy to which one lays claim. Philosophies
of art have been derived from the doctrine of Saint
Thomas of Aquinas. They should be ascribed to Thomism
rather than be derived from it. As far as I know, Saint
Thomas said almost nothing about the arts of the
beautiful as such. His writings contain neither a
philosophy of art nor an esthetic. All we find in them are
the elements of a calology which might have been
suggested to him by a reading of the Neo-Platonist
Dionysius the Areopagite, but the metaphysics of the
beautiful is part of the ontology; it goes beyond art in
every respect. We also find in Saint Thomas’s writings a
definition of art which has wrought great havoc, even
though it was not intended to define art as such, and even
less the art of the beautiful, but rather to distinguish it
from ethics. This is clearly seen in the stereotyped
character of the formula, for it speaks of making (facere)
only to distinguish it from acting in general (agere), and
Saint Thomas is obviously more interested in the latter

10
than in the former. Unquestionably art for him is an
intellectual virtue. Moral prudence is also a virtue, but of
another order: “ars est recta ratio factibilium; prudentia vero est
recta ratio agibilium” (S.T., I-II, 57, 4 Resp.). And that is true,
for can we conceive of any human activity which is not
presided over by a virtue, or of a human operation which
is not finally conducted, judged and regulated by the
intellect? The intellect digests, according to Albert
Magnus. This is a useful admonition to those who would
array art against reason, or even separate them. But Saint
Thomas was not interested in art as factivity; his primary
concern was to avoid confusion between the role of
reason in art and in ethics. He said nothing about the art
of the beautiful as factivity. As a theologian there was no
reason for him to discuss it; let us not reproach him
therefore for his silence on this matter.
It is legitimate to talk about it when making use of
Thomas’s name, but in that case it is more prudent to
refer to a concept of art formulated by a philosopher who
was really concerned with art and to whose authority Saint
Thomas himself appeals everywhere, namely Aristotle.
Reason is not absent in his concept, but it occupies its
proper place in it, art being viewed as a virtus factiva cum
ratione or exis poietika meta logou, which is very different, for
it is the poietique or productive essence of art which
imparts its meaning to the definition. By failing to go back
to Aristotle from Saint Thomas, great minds have created
an esthetics ex nihilo Thomism which they have placed
under his authority. This is proof that Thomism lives on,
or more simply, that thought never dies. But we have seen

11
artists, naively trusting in the competence of philosophers,
who perplexedly compare their personal experience of art
with what the rationalist theories of this type say about it,
and become troubled because they have not recognized in
them the face of art.
There is some substance here. Like all sculptors, Eric
Gall was a workman. Modelling was not enough for him,
he wanted to be a stone-carver not by imparting form to
the block but by extracting it from within the stone itself.
In any case, for him the hand was no doubt the pre-
eminent tool and in his view art should make use of it.
Imagine his surprise when he came upon the assertion
“manual dexterity does not belong to art” written by
philosophers whom he admired, trusted and whose views
he hoped to share. He must have thought he was
dreaming. For after all, if manual dexterity has nothing to
do with art, what does the art of sculpture, of painting, or
that of playing any musical instrument consist of? We can
easily recognize in this lofty contempt for the hand that
eighteenth-century rationalism which, though it bore the
mark of greatness and was beneficent in some respects,
was no less maleficent in others. Behind excesses of this
kind there generally lies more “jeandesainthomisme” than
genuine Thomism. Jean de Saint Thomas perhaps thought
that it was necessary merely to remove what was of excess
in a block of stone in order to obtain the statue. There is
no doubt that he did think, inasmuch as he wrote it, that
the work of learning to play the guitar—to acquire
“fingers”—does not bring a new art into being, but merely
eliminates the obstacle to its exercise. Let us grant that

12
finger-dexterity in playing the piano is not an art different
from that of playing the piano; it is an improvement of the
same art, but how are we to conclude therefrom that this
art does not essentially involve manual dexterity? By the
same token, all we would have to do in order to be able to
play Chopin’s Préludes is to understand thoroughly Alfred
Cortot’s instructions on how to play them. Unfortunately,
Cortot also prescribes finger exercises appropriate to each
prelude. As is the case with Debussy’s Les tierces alternées
the ability to play them calls for more than being
intelligent.
“Art stands wholly on the side of the mind.” All we
can do in the presence of such absolute certainty is to turn
to account the light that such a statement sheds on so
many real aspects of art which otherwise we would risk
missing, or losing sight of. When reality has reached this
degree of complexity, no particular aspect of truth
suffices. If one excludes the body from the essence of art,
the reason may be to spare us from making the mistake of
excluding the mind from it. There is nothing more
intelligent than the fingers of a pianist except, perhaps, the
body of a dancer. Art, nevertheless, does not stand wholly
on the side of the mind. The role played by the mind
depends more or less upon the art involved, playing a
greater role in architecture and poetry, and a lesser one in
sculpture and in the execution of musical compositions,
but making, which is the very essence of art, is brought to
bear in the body and through it. But, again, what would be
the point of kindling useless controversy? Even notions
with which we do not wholly agree challenge us to do our

13
utmost to avoid running the risk of losing sight of the
least possible glimmer of truth.
After Painting and Reality (1958) and The Arts of the
Beautiful (1963), this makes the third book that I have
devoted to the philosophy of art. It will also be the last
one, for even though I have been happy to have had the
time to expound what others do not seem to have
expounded sufficiently, I know that I have nothing useful
to add. Further elaborations would be endless and all of us
can make our own contributions. I have been saying but
one thing, the art of the artist and what we say about it do
not belong to the same order. I would like to add the
order of art, which is neither to know nor to act but to
make, to the Pascalian doctrine of the specificity of
“orders”. I am under no illusion that I am making a world-
shaking revelation with this platitude, but I do want to
invite those concerned with the arts to take it into
consideration. Personally, it is above all a question of
paying a debt of gratitude. Some artists have become rich,
which is very good. Others were born rich, which is even
better. Up to now no one has given proper attention to
the specific characteristics of the literature produced by
rentiers. However, by far the majority of artists have lived
in uncertainty, in doubt, in travail, surrounded by the
indifference of a society which, without really being at
fault, condemns them to a kind of solitude. Indeed, artists
do not work for society. Their sights are set higher, but it
is for each one of us they toil. I was prompted to write on
art out of a deep, indeed passionate feeling of gratitude
toward artists, known and unknown, whose works have

14
enriched and enhanced life for me. Often, they have even
justified it in my own eyes. Upon reading a beautiful line
of verse, viewing or listening to a beautiful work, how
many times have I said to myself, “After one has done
something like this, one can die with the certitude that
living was worthwhile!” We know this, but the artist
himself is rarely altogether sure of it. Hence we owe him
this avowal. The artist is irreplaceable in the exercise of his
beneficent function. And the philosopher must be excused
for having wanted to express his thanks to him with the
cumbersomeness that is inseparable from his own
function.
I hope no one will find any cause for controversy in
the following pages. Originally, I had planned to answer
some objections in a special chapter at the end of the
work, but I concluded that any effort to dispel
misunderstandings would only create additional ones.
Some critics have been offended by some of the positions
I have taken. I think they have misunderstood me. I said
that criticism has no bearing on art, but rather on the
apprehension of the work of art. The object which the
critic sets out to describe cannot be the work produced by
the artist, but what he thinks of it. The critic does not
produce art but criticism, and the object of his activity
does not pertain to art but to esthetics. This is the reason,
moreover, why critics and estheticians most often refuse
to distinguish between the two orders, inasmuch as their
only chance to remain within the order of art is by
blurring the lines of demarcation. But I think that they
misapprehend the nature of the merit that is uniquely

15
theirs and the meaning of what I say about it.
I have steeped myself in Sainte-Beuve. For me his
substantial Literary Comedy has been what Montaigne’s
Essays have been for so many others. Sainte-Beuve
suffered enough over the fact that he was not one of his
own heroes so that we should not add to his suffering by
attributing a confusion of this kind to him. How often we
see him prepare a modest but honored place in his
criticism for those demi-poets or demi-novelists among
whom he hoped he would be accorded a rank some day!
But at bottom he knew very well that Hugo was the poet,
not Joseph Delorme. The excellent Charles du Bos, a
more subtle critic, would have liked to persuade himself
that to understand is to make equal. Therefore, he looked
for elysium of the spirit in a kind of general spirituality in
which elect critics, writers of genius and some inspired
great men in all the arts would find a common homeland.
He was laboring under a delusion. The artist really is
interested only in what he is making, and in others only in
their capacity as makers. They alone are his real family.
The others are not strictly in his class, as it were, and
count for little in his eyes. Who understood Delacroix
better than Baudelaire? Who honored him more nobly?
Who served him more intelligently? Yet there is scarcely
any evidence of the slightest expression of gratitude on the
part of the painter toward his eminent critic. Perhaps this
widespread indifference translates into facts a profound
truth, namely that of the radical distinction between orders
that face each other. We will never be able to produce the
least of La Fontaine’s fables with all of the writings of

16
Sainte-Beuve, Francesco de Sanctis and Charles du Bos
taken together. It is not a question here of measuring
degrees but, simply, of discerning orders.
There remains the large family of professors of
philosophy, to which I belong, and of the professors of
esthetics, to which I do not flatter myself I belong. I
realize that any philosophy treating of art must expect to
receive special attention from them. Some professors of
esthetics have attributed to me absurdities so manifest,
without, moreover, citing any supporting evidence, that
these absurdities would merit being taken as subjects for
study in themselves. One possible explanation for these
inventions, perhaps, is that one always disturbs a
philosopher by thinking differently from him. In the
presence of a thought different from his own, a reductio ad
absurdum suffices to liberate him from his disquietude.
This catharsis may be useful, but hardly necessary. To
suggest a certain philosophical interpretation of the arts of
the beautiful does not imply disapproval of other
interpretations. Hence no one should be disturbed by
what I have to say. In my efforts to order my own ideas
and to submit them to the judgment of others, I expressly
accord the same freedom to them.

17
ONE
The Distinction Between
the Arts of the Beautiful

PARADOXICALLY, ONE OF Alain’s primary concerns in


his work entitled Systems of the Fine Arts was to ascertain
that the fine arts as such do not constitute a system.1 They
1 Alain’s book is an excellent example of a book that one
delights in reading and with whose author one likes to engage in
a secret dialogue, but which it would be futile to discuss; for if its
thesis is granted, everything is justifiable, and if it is not granted
disagreement is inevitable on much of the detail. As far as I
understand, Alain intends to take the arts of the beautiful as they
are brought to bear in fact in the complexity of their concrete
works. This provides him with ample material in which to display
his taste for reflection and exercise his style. It is exactly the
opposite of venatio essentiae. The two enterprises seem legitimate to
me, but we would waste our time judging one from the point of
view of the other. As has already been done in connection with
another book, I simply permit myself to point out how far off the
mark is the attempt to make Alain into a kind of modern
Socrates. Socrates did not write anything. Moreover, ancient
testimonies are agreed in attributing to him one major concern
exemplified in his response each time to a question: “What are
we talking about?” or, “What do you mean by this word?” Alain
18
are not deducible from some general notion, first posited
by the mind, which would furnish its own subdivisions.
Assuredly, the poietic or productive activity from which
they derive is one in its origin as in its general effects, but
it varies in its particular effects according to the material
substances on which it is brought to bear. These materials
cannot be ordered into a system; they are simply what they
are, and given the organs of cognition and movement at
man’s disposal he can utilize them to produce beauty.
It is the intellect’s love of order therefore that tempts
philosophers to organize the fine arts into some system in
which the necessity of the whole would confer a kind of a
priori justification upon each one of the arts. This same
love of order invites them to attempt a classification of the
arts of the beautiful, for classification is possible only on
the basis of an ordering principle of some kind. But logical
order exists only between ideas or between things which
can be treated as ideas by reducing them, directly or
indirectly, to an idea among others. It will be seen that
such is not the case with the fine arts. Homo artifex, who is
but a remarkable variety of Homo faber, is hardly less
ancient than Homo sapiens and Homo loquens. He is the
selfsame man, and he has left us evidence of his poietic
creativity in the order of the beautiful which antedates by
far those which enable us to attribute an articulated
language to him. History begins with writing, but man
perhaps is wise to show reserve on this point, for he is not sure
that all things are definable, but I have often observed how
difficult it was to catch him red-handed making definitions in the
matter of the arts.
19
sculpted and painted long before he wrote, and he began
very early to make plastic objects with the usable materials
at hand. Cave art includes sculptured, engraved objects
decorated with line drawings of a formal perfection at
times surprising, as well as broad painted wall surfaces
where a concern with composition is revealed in the
arrangement of the figures. The manner in which these are
ordered in the space that nature placed at the artist’s
disposal clearly shows that so-called “pre-historic” man
was already pretty much like ourselves; placed in front of a
bare wall, he felt the urge to cover it with figures in his
own fashion according to the possibilities offered by the
free space and the available means for decorating it. It will
be objected that he had ends in view other than those of
creating “art”, and that is no doubt true, but whether the
ends he had in mind were of a magical, religious or
practical character, the artist of Altamira certainly intended
to pursue such ends through painting. This is what makes
him essentially a kinsman of modern painters.
No serious hypothesis can be advanced regarding the
possible character of the arts of language or of sound at
the time when man was decorating the walls of his cave-
dwellings. Even less probable is the conjecture that these
remote ancestors already exercised their voices, as infants
in the cradle still do today. Besides, the history of the fine
arts is alien to our present purpose. We wish merely to
note that the arts have their origins in an ensemble of
empirically given possibilities which, on the one hand, are
determined by the organs of the human body proper to
cognition and movement, and, on the other, by the

20
physical properties of certain material substances. Man
invents as many fine arts as he finds in the nature of the
different material substances suitable for being worked on
through the natural means at his disposal. Before long he
will supplement these natural means by tools appropriate
to the materials that are to be worked on and by the
invention of new materials which, if need be, will be
manufactured with art and art’s end in view. New arts are
possibly yet to be born. If so, this will be effected in a
wholly empirical manner and in keeping with the
development of art itself, or of industry. What is striking,
in any case, is the fact that some major arts have been
practiced since the beginnings of the historical age and
that no new major art has been invented since the Greeks.
In default of systemizing the arts, we can try to classify
them. Classification is absolutely necessary if the arts are
to be discussed in an orderly way. The problem, moreover,
offers philosophers a prime occasion to be at variance not
only over the manner of classifying the arts but, first of all,
over those works which it is opportune to classify. What
are works of art and how many kinds are there?
Disagreement sets in from the start of the discussion. The
reasons for this are multiple, but one of the principal ones
seems to be the confusion that exists, intentional or not,
between the meaning of the word “art” in the expression
“fine-arts” and the meaning ascribed to it when it is used
as an equivalent of “technique”. Perhaps there is no need
to talk about confusion here, for the word art, in French
and English, is a continuation of the Latin ars whose
meaning is tantamount to that of the Greek word which

21
we have made technique. Any technique is an art and, when
it is understood in this sense, the word inevitably brings to
mind the definition of art so dear to the scholastics: recta
ratio factibilium. The formula suggests the notion of a rule
for making something well. Obviously every art of the
beautiful involves rules of this kind; there is a technique,
or more simply a “know-how”, in each of the arts whose
end is to produce objects. Only those whose purpose is to
produce objects desired for their beauty alone have a right
to the title of fine arts, but it happens in fact that some
techniques employed for ends other than the production.
of the beautiful surreptitiously creep into the general
tableau of the fine arts. Hence the confusions which,
perhaps, are not all avoidable.
So many are the bonds connecting these two orders of
operations, in which one contains the other as genus does
the species, that an exact demarcation is difficult. Such a
demarcation, perhaps, is not even desirable. Yet
philosophical reflection must apply itself to it and can do
this only by distinguishing the fine arts from the other
techniques in general terms of the proper ends which they
pursue. All techniques are operating rules, each one of
which determines a way of making something well,
whereas the fine arts are ways of setting about properly for
making something beautiful. Now any work that is well
done has its own beauty inasmuch as it is well done, its
beauty being the resultant of the perfect adaptation of the
means to the end. We call it a “beautiful piece of work”.
Saint Augustine’s lost treatise De pulchro et apto may have
had something to say about this genre of beauty. Be it as it

22
may, this distinction clearly implies that a fine art, to the
extent that it presupposes a technique, includes a
knowledge of the operating rules in default of which a
successful execution would be difficult or impossible.
Tricks of the trade and the knack of doing something well
are never enough, but they are everywhere necessary. The
most exceptional natural gifts, the loftiest genius, cannot
dispense with “know-how” and dexterity in any art.
The inclusion of the techniques of good workmanship
in the arts of the beautiful is no warrant for confusing
them. Hence we should be wary of the tendency to classify
among the fine arts mere perfection in the application of
any technique and in the results it obtains, for in such a
case the result is always beautiful, but it does not
necessarily follow that the art which produces it is one of
the fine arts. It was a mistake, I think, to have wanted to
include ballroom dancing, horsemanship and fencing,
acrobatics, and even military parades in a system of the
fine arts. Indeed, there are elements of the beautiful in the
movements of a good dancer, in the way a good horseman
holds himself in the saddle or simply in the way he puts
his mount through the paces, just as there are in the
precision and grace of a well-executed military parade or
in a gymnastic feat performed with ease. There is no less
beauty, moreover, in the movements of the carpenter, the
blacksmith, the laborer and the sower. Generally speaking,
we cannot remain insensitive to the artistry involved in the
practice of all sports which impose on the body the
discipline and rhythm required for the proper execution of
movements. Yet, even though the result is beautiful,

23
beauty is not the end on which this discipline sets its
sights. To dance well, to play well, to bear oneself well in
society are the arts of gracious living whose aim is the
perfection of what one is. A good military parade is a
beautiful parade but its ends are always discipline, the
assertion of order, the repeated drilling of the troops; in
short, the primary concern is the command of armies.
They are not the operations of an art whose end is beauty.
A second cause of confusion is due to the fact that
these kinds of beauty, albeit of a different order, have in
common the attribute of being kinds of beauty that are
desirable as such and capable of being grasped at the same
time in a single and self-same experience. Taken together
they are perceived as a single beauty. This explains why in
the work of art we do not distinguish clearly between the
pleasure we derive from the natural beauty of the model,
and that produced in us by the art of the sculptor or the
painter. A fine horseman resembles his statue, a beautiful
portrait makes us believe that we are beholding the natural
beauty of the model, with the result that each individual
beauty nourishes the other to produce the greatest visual
pleasure. The same observation applies to the utilitarian
arts. Perfection in the adaptation of ends to means with a
practical end of any kind in view is accompanied by a
beauty of its own which is, so to speak, the natural beauty
of the products of factivity. This industrial beauty is even
closer to that of nature than is the beauty of the fine arts.
Advertising experts know how to exploit this kinship
between the natural beauty of machines and that of the
human body. The figure of a graceful young woman

24
standing beside a luxurious motor car, or on the bridge of
a ship, or in front of a sleek airliner offers a visual image
of harmony to which few remain unresponsive. The
quality common to all these kinds of beauty is their
gratuitousness. On the other hand, it is difficult to
combine felicitously the beauties of nature or of industry
with those of the arts whose proper end is beauty itself.
The beauty of a machine is in some way natural to it, like
that which accompanies the right proportions of a human
body, but it is always hazardous to confuse an effort that
is accessory to beautification with one aiming at good
workmanship. The incongruous mixture which results
therefrom is rarely a pleasing sight. All too many
embellishments work their way into the products of
industry on behalf of this miscellany of heterogeneous
intentions; in the view of people of taste, these machines
which are made to look pretty generally produce an effect
that is both distressing and ludicrous. True enough, the
taste of the public for whom the industrialist works is
often different. Because of his refusal to harmonize with
the different ends pursued. by other techniques, his error
at least aids the observer to perceive the specific character
of the technique of the arts of the beautiful.
The situation is not altogether the same with respect
to the commonly accepted distinction between the
decorative arts and the fine arts. The decorative arts have
an unchallengeable right to be counted among the
company of the fine arts because their end also is the
creation of beauty. But they are in a special class because
the beauty which the decorator intends to produce is of an

25
accessory character and subordinated to that of a major
work whose end he must serve. Hence it is not possible to
lay down a general rule here. Very few architects are happy
with the embellishments that sculpture presumably adds
to their work. Yet, it is possible to conceive a collective
work in which each decorator would exactly follow the
intention of the master-workman, and would integrate the
product of his art seamlessly with the ensemble of the
project so that the work as a whole would enjoy a perfect
unity of style and a genre of beauty. Such successes are
unfortunately rare. Beautiful statues and beautiful
paintings often spoil beautiful churches; nor is there a lack
of frescoes which actually disfigure walls. Decorative art
abjures itself if it practices self-restraint; on the other
hand, if it boldly asserts itself it betrays its function as a
decorative art. A choice must be made. Does not, perhaps,
the profusion of gesticulating statues typical of some
forms of Baroque architecture reveal a secret desire, as it
were, in their creators to see a hesitant architecture come
to a decision and turn resolutely toward sculpture or
architecture rather than remain in a state of bastardy
between the two? Be it as it may, decorative art at its worst
is displaced art; often it is an undesirable art, without it
necessarily being the architect's fault, for left to itself the
work is pathetically powerless and nothing protects it
against the uses that are made of it. At rare times,
decoration is so perfectly integrated with the main work
that both become as one. But to effect this perfect fusion,
the beauty of the decoration must not be so striking as to
obscure the beauty of the whole. If it fulfills its function

26
properly, it is somewhat like the violinist of a quartette
who forbids himself to playas a soloist. Thus, as a
participant in the beauty of the whole which it adorns,
decorative art merits its place among the fine arts.
Some may consider these distinctions useless
subtleties. More precisely, they will censure them as
evidence of a regrettable tendency to think abstractly in
matters where concrete result is paramount. According to
them, no object of beauty exists which does not serve
some useful purpose, hence why would not a useful object
be a work of art, as long as it is beautiful? It is that and
also many other things at the same time, but inasmuch as
it serves ends other than beauty it does not belong to the
fine arts. The Descent from the Cross, on view in the
Cathedral of Anvers, is first and foremost a painting; in
addition, it has become a decorative work serving as
ornamentation to a work of architecture; further, it is a
work of religious art, a means of teaching sacred history, a
tourist attraction because it has a three-star
recommendation in the Belgian travel-guides, with all the
financial consequences that this privilege entails for the
church which contains the painting, the city in which it is
found, and for the travel agencies and the hotels catering
to tourists. The picture which the artist paints is already in
itself the object of an inevitable utilitarian calculation, for
the artist lives from art as the priest lives from the altar,
indeed much more so, as a general rule. But those who
remind the philosopher of these facts only set before him
once again the complexity of the real which is the point of
departure of his own attempt to analyze and order it. At

27
the beginning of these facts lies the act, bearing no
relation to them,with which Rubens long ago executed this
celebrated composition. He made his living from his art,
and a very good living too. But he had deliberately chosen
to live from it as have so many others who, though living
in poverty as painters, would have preferred death to any
other style of life. Let us recall Van Gogh and Gauguin,
among others. It would not be an exaggeration to say that
all those who deal with art live from art, except the artists.
Art historians and biographers, estheticians, curators of
museums, art dealers, in short all those engaged in the
more or less profitable exploitation of the artist’s work
merely exploit the fruits of his genius to their profit. One
can earn money from Van Gogh’s misery simply by
writing a book about it. The function of philosophical
analysis remains no less that of extracting from the matrix
the essence of the art of the beautiful imprisoned therein.
It is found in the act of painting, hence all the rest must be
brought into relation with it.
A final cause of the reigning confusion in the
classification of the fine arts, which indeed has almost
become a rule, is that which considers the philosophy of
art and esthetics as identical disciplines. They are,
however, two different disciplines. True enough, the work
of art is at the center of both, but the philosophy of art
considers the work in its relation to the artist who
produces it, whereas esthetics considers it in its relation to
the spectator, the listener or the reader who perceives it.
Two distinct orders are involved here, for the artist is
never the spectator of his work while he is working on it,

28
the views that he takes of his work in progress being so
many integrating elements of the act of producing them,
and the spectator of the work is never its author since the
experience that he acquires of it presupposes that the
work is fully wrought. When the painter becomes the
passive viewer of his picture, it is a sign that it is finished.
The work to be done, which is the core of the artist’s
concern, is specifically different from the work wrought
by another on which the reflection of the spectator and of
the critic is brought to bear. The object of esthetics is the
work of art given in the experience of the person who
perceives it; this object can have become wholly different
from what it was when it emerged from the artist’s hands,
and the esthetician has no less a right to take it as it is and
to analyze it in terms of his experience of it. On the other
hand, what is not given to him is the art which fashioned
the work, for he does not possess it and even if he did he
too would be as incapable as the artist to repeat the
singular, unique act through which the work was produced
in the first place. Artistic creation is a freedom structured
of freedoms which do not lend themselves to
enumeration, for though they are multiple they form but
one whose history cannot be told by anybody, not even by
the artist, because we know the outcome only after the
event, whereas it is of the essence of the creative act that
when it is happening the person who lives it is himself
ignorant of its end.
The confusion between the philosophy of art and
esthetics is ineradicable because it allows the
commentators on art the illusion of really participating in

29
the productive efficacy of the artist. Thus they feel
themselves on the same side as the artist, like those who
sit in the grandstands believe they are sportsmen because
they like to watch those who actually engage in them. This
is the source of countless difficulties, one of which
specifically affects the problem of the classification of the
arts, because the philosopher, who tries to distinguish
them, naturally substitutes the point of view of the
consumer for that of the producer, which he is not.
Therefore the resultant classifications are answerable
directly to esthetics rather than to the philosophy of art.
Kant’s influence was crucial in this respect. The Critique
of Pure Reason begins with an “esthetic” whose purpose is
not to define the experience of the work of art, but rather
to determine the conditions of sensible experience in
general. These are the two a priori forms of the sensibility,
space and time. It was inevitable, therefore, that some
“estheticians” should decide to distinguish the arts of
space from the arts of time by ordering them from the
point of view of their apprehension by the subject, to
whom the arts are given as objects. Sculpture and painting
would be examples of the former, music and poetry would
represent the others. But one should have been wary of
this all too facile expedient, for in connection with these
two forms, Kant himself pointed out that the form of time
finally includes that of space. In fact, all apprehension
being an act of cognition, even space must accommodate
itself to the conditions of the act in which any object is
cognized. Hence it is impossible to speak of an art which
would pertain to space alone, for everything given in space

30
is simultaneously in time. Indeed, the converse is true, it
requires time to visit a monument or to look at a painting,
but the listener and the music which he hears are always
somewhere in space. It is therefore a priori impossible to
make a distinction in the fine arts between the arts of
space and the arts of time from the point of view of their
esthetic apprehension.
Nor would we be any more successful by posing the
problem from the point of view of art itself. In fact, works
of art, as human creations, are subject to the burden of the
human condition, which is to endure. Whether it is a
question of architecture, music or poetry, time is as
involved in the operations required for the production of
works of art as it is in their apprehension by the
consumer. Time is needed, sometimes years and, in the
case of collective works, even centuries in order to bring
some enterprises to completion, such as the construction
of temples or of palaces whose completion exceeds the
limits of a life or a generation. In one sense, such works
are never really finished, for no matter how long the time
that was required to bring them into being there is
practically no end to the time that will be needed to
prevent their destruction or demise. For their part, music
and poetry are always being produced somewhere and the
written symbols which preserve them fill books, which in
turn rest on the shelves of libraries, which with the
passage of time increasingly and ceaselessly take up more
and more space. And musicians follow the fate of music,
for just as the “monuments of antiquity” last in time, so
does a symphony orchestra, a quartette, a singer “occupy a

31
place”. In general, these two great frames of sensible
experience are also two universal laws of material life, to
which all works of art are subject; hence they cannot be
used as criteria for distinguishing them.
We might perhaps be more successful by substituting
for the esthetic point of view that of the philosophy of art.
The latter implies a metaphysics of art, that is to say, an
ontology which considers the works in their substantial
structure and in their relation to their cause. Taken as
singular beings, actually existing works of art are
essentially material objects which are given as sense data.
Esthetics deals with our apprehension of them, but the
philosophy of art is rightfully concerned with the material
from which these works of art are wrought, and this
consideration provides an objective means for
distinguishing them and, perhaps, even for drawing the
broad outlines of a system for classifying them.
Furthermore, in trying this approach we must bear in
mind that the prime. matter of which philosophers speak
cannot possibly be in question here. The artist does not
work on a pure indeterminable substance which is not nec
quid, nec quale, the possibility of whose actual existence,
moreover, is at best doubtful. The respective material
substances on which the different arts work do not enable
us to distinguish them inasmuch as they themselves are
distinct from each other. Every material is differentiated
from the others by reason of the natural form which
makes it stone, wood, color, musical sound or a written or
spoken word. They are called materials, despite their
forms, because the artist freely takes possession of them in

32
order to make works of art out of them. In this sense, the
natural forms themselves act as materials in relation to the
form, specifically different in origin and in finality, which
the artist imparts to them for the production of the works
he has in mind. This is a rule of general import, the
consequences of which are innumerable, because everything
which the artist presses into service for the purpose of his
art plays the role of matter in relation to the form of the
work. On the other hand, since this matter is not the
prime matter of the metaphysicians but rather some
substance already determined by its form, the artist using
it as a material is forced to take account of its natural
formal determinations in the artistic use that he makes of
it. The sculpture can choose to work in wood, stone or
marble; he is totally free in this respect, but once his
decision has been made his art must respect the conditions
imposed by the natural form of the material on which he
will have chosen to exercise his skill. This determination
goes even further. Michelangelo was free to do everything
it is possible to do with a given block of marble of this or
that cut, form, grain and color. This is the source of the
unceasing interaction between the material and the
operations of the artist, who draws inspiration from both
in order to invent the forms that will best suit him. The
material, inasmuch as it is determined by its natural forms,
itself brings a positive determining action to bear to which
the artist cannot remain insensible. When the sculptor asks
himself whether a block of marble shall be a god, a table
or a basin, the marble has something to say about it. In its
own way, in fact, it is the first to speak, announcing its

33
vocation.
This manner of operation would be in keeping with
the feeling expressed by many artists which can be
summarized in the well-known words of Robert
Schumann: “The esthetics of one art is the same as that of
the others; only the material differs.” It has often been
quoted only as a reproach. Taken within the limits that
Schumann had in mind, it is true. He did not claim that
forms are of the same nature in all the arts, but rather that
if they are different in music from what they are in
architecture, in sculpture, or in painting, it is precisely
because the mind, in creating them through an act that is
always essentially the same, must adopt the forms to the
exigencies or demands of the different materials on which
the artist works. Thus the diversity that exists in the
techniques of the arts really is attributable to the diversity
of the materials on which they are brought to bear.
Perhaps we do not always express ourselves properly
when we speak of art as an effort to overcome the
resistance of matter. This resistance is real, and this is why
creativity is always an effort, but while the artist pits
himself against it in order to conquer it he also bases
himself upon it in order to surmount it. Far from being an
enemy, the material of his art is an ally of the creator: an
accomplice whose suggestions he gladly accepts and
whose call he hears before he sets to work. For we must
never forget the great image of the Greek philosopher:
matter desires form as the female desires the male, and we
can add vice-versa. From this point of view we can
understand not only the great divisions of the arts in

34
general, but also those within each of them which
determine the different properties and possibilities of the
materials which they use: in painting, for example, the
types of paintings such as frescoes, oils or water colors;
and alongside the different manners of painting, engraving
and the different arts of the engraver, on wood, on stone,
on copper, through the graving-tool or etching and so
forth. In the presence of a given material the artist always
asks himself: “What can be done with it?” He knows what
he is talking about when he praises the “possibilities” of
the stone or of the wood at hand, as well as those of the
different techniques from which they are inseparable. This
is why it is so difficult to distinguish the two notions of art
and technique in reality, for the arts cannot be classified
according to their materials without at the same time
classifying them according to the techniques which are
used to work them. Technique is the particular manner of
imparting to a particular material the particular type of
form that is proper to it.
If we take account of these precise distinctions, we will
be more disposed than ever to give up the idea of ordering
the arts of the beautiful into a synthesis in which each of
them would find a place assigned to it on the basis of a
general principle. Man produces works of art with the
materials that he finds and in accordance with the means
at his disposal. This is not a deduction but a confirmed
fact.
In an altogether general way, works of art can be
classified in two major groups, according to whether their
material is inorganic or organic. Within the first group, we

35
shall distinguish the arts of extension and the arts of
sound. Within the second group, composed almost
exclusively of the arts whose material is man himself, we
shall distinguish the arts of the human body and the arts
of linguistic expression, spoken or written. In none of
these groups, particularly the second, are we to expect
clear and sharp distinctions, and, even less,
contradistinctions. All arts by origin are arts of man, and
all those for which man furnishes the material itself are
connected with each other through the “human” qualities
of the materials used. A dance movement is executed by a
human body, a song is produced by a human voice, an
intelligible word rightfully belongs to the human language.
Everything here connects and communes in a natural
identity, but there is diversity in the unity.
Such will be the order that we here intend to sketch
along broad lines, basing ourselves on these general
notions.
Among the arts of extension, we shall distinguish the
arts of volume, principally architecture and sculpture, and
the arts of surface,2 principally drawing, painting and those

2 It would take a long time to discuss the opposite thesis, but


it will be found forcefully expounded by M. Charles Lapicque
who combines the double authority of the painter and the
philosopher. See his Essais sur l’espace, l’art et la destinée, preface by
Jean Wahl (Paris: Grasset, 1958), notably pp. 16-20 and 183-185.
I refer the reader to it and draw his attention to the difference of
the two points of view. I speak of the work of art itself, whereas
Lapicque speaks above all of its apprehension by the spectator.
From the point of view of this work, it is without importance
36
arts derived from, or associated with, them.
Among the arts of sound, which include all forms of
music, we shall distinguish musical instruments and types
of vocal music; the voice being a living sound, the latter
constitutes a transition, a kind of bridge between the arts
of inorganic matter and the arts of man.
In turn, the arts of man will be distinguished in three
principal groups: those of which the human body
furnishes the material, such as the dance; those whose
material is language, namely different forms of spoken or
written poetry; and finally those of which, for lack of a
term that is more directly significative, we shall say that
human life itself is the material, whether it involves
imitation or a free re-creation, such as the arts of
pantomime and the theatre. The creations of these latter

that it involves only one center of perspective (as in that of the


Italian Renaissance, known as Albert’s perspective) or several as
in all other kinds of painting, ancient or modern. I don’t know
whether it is proper to call the latter a “dynamic perspective”. In
fact, all perspectives are such for the eye of the spectator and, on
the other hand, the movement required for the perception of the
picture affects only the spectator, not the work itself. The picture
presents simultaneously the traces left on a surface through
successive movements. It itself exists all at once. As we shall see
more amply in connection with architecture, the conditions of
the esthetic experience of the picture are affected by it: this is
why it is totally present and one can transverse it from any end
and even, if one wishes, from the back. We cannot read a poem
backwards, or play a symphony backwards, or present a play
without being concerned about the order of the scenes or of the
verses. All the arts of time find themselves in this situation.
37
arts require almost the totality of appearances given in
experience, including man himself in his body, his gesture,
in the intonations of his voice, in the words that he utters
taken in their very meaning, including what is most
intimate and almost sacred in him, his personality.
If it is permissible to prefer other classifications which
in fact might be desirable from other points of view, this
distinction of the arts of the beautiful is eminently
legitimate in a study which considers them from the
distinct point of view of their materials and forms. A more
general objection would hold that such a distinction
neglects some very important arts, some of which occupy
a first rank in contemporary letters.
The novel is the most notable among the cases of this
kind. For various reasons, the novel occupies a more
important place than poetry in contemporary literary
production. On the other hand, it cannot be denied that
many novels are works of art. Who does not immediately
think of Madame Bovary? Flaubert nearly died in order to
give birth to this masterpiece which he willed for the pure
beauty of its form, as he himself never ceased to repeat.
Flaubert’s letters to Louise Collet are an irreplaceable
document on the creative travail of a writer whose
ultimate end is beauty alone. It was inevitable that the
passage from his letter of January 16, 1852, would be
frequently quoted: “What seems beautiful to me, what I
would like to write is a book about nothing, a book
dependent upon nothing external which would sustain
itself by the inner strength of its style, as the earth is
suspended in space; a book that would have almost no

38
subject or in which the subject would be almost invisible,
if such a thing is possible.” Such a thing is possible, of
course, but on the condition that it not be a novel. Madame
Bovary has a subject, as every novel must have. Flaubert
might well have chosen his as the most mediocre subject
possible so that the novel would owe nothing of its beauty
to it, but it is there nevertheless, with all the onerous
limitations it entails. To choose the novel in order to write
a literary work without any subject-matter or end other
than its own beauty was a form of self-deception
regarding the nature of that literary genre. Flaubert keenly
felt the contradiction inherent in the project that he had
set for himself when he had to write “a coarse and gross
dialogue” between a woman and “a parish priest” because
the subject required it. How write a dialogue of this kind
which would ring true and possess a style at one and the
same time? “I reached the conclusion sometimes,” he
himself says, “that it is impossible to write.” Yet, while
discussing this very Madame Bovary, Albert Thibaudet made
a point of insisting on the reality of the characters created
by Flaubert in this masterpiece,3 about which the author

3 If I am mistaken here, only Albert Thibaudet would be able


to correct me but, unfortunately, he is no longer among us. See
his pages on Flaubert in Histoire de la littérature francaise de 1789 à
nos jours (Paris: Stock, 1936), pp. 336-338, and above all in Gustave
Flaubert, sa vie, ses romans, son style (Paris: 1922), the inexhaustible
comparison between the pair Corneille-Balzac and Racine-
Flaubert. Finally there is always Flaubert himself. We can hear
him in the texts collected under the title, Extraits de la
correspondance ou Préface à la vie d’écrivain, presentation and selection
39
repeated twenty times that the subject in no way suited
him. Perhaps Flaubert was mistaken about himself? See
how masterfully he prepares his “great scene of the
agricultural meetings”, this “rustico-municipal feast”!
Does not this art of inventing the real also have its beauty?
Flaubert asked himself this question. He knew that others
responded affirmatively, and he did not try to deny the
question, but he had his doubts: “They say it’s also art,
and everything is art. But by dint of seeing so much art, I
ask where are the fine arts?” The philosophy of art will
never surpass the profundity that Flaubert’s reflection
arrived at by itself.
Flaubert criticizes Balzac for having remained too
alien to the concern of art, yet Balzac, though less an artist
than Flaubert, is by far the better novelist. It is impossible
to discuss novels without bringing up Balzac, but it is
equally impossible to avoid asking oneself: to what order
of literary creation does his work belong? In the preface of
1842 to the Comédie humaine, Balzac presented himself as

by Geneviève Bollème (Paris: Editions du Seuil, 1963). The


Presentation in fact includes precisely the following utterance,
which is so true, from the Education sentimentale, first version
(Paris: Conrad, 1910), p. 259: “Every work of art has its special
poetics in virtue of which it is fashioned and subsists. . .” If
Madame Bovary did not exist to recall this truth to the philosopher
as well as to the critic, I would be grateful to this unsurpassed
novel for arousing in me a doubt which I feel that I have not
altogether succeeded in removing.

40
an observer of what he called “social nature”. 4 This is
what he purposed to observe and learn about before all
else, so as to portray it later in his work and thus compete
with all the data of civic life. Taine called the Comédie
humaine “the largest warehouse of documents that we have
on human nature along with Shakespeare and Saint
Simon.” If this is true, Balzac’s work set knowledge rather
than beauty as its end. No doubt, his work has a beauty of
its own. It is enough to re-read the short story “Colonel
Chabert” to sense its greatness, but it is the greatness of a
biologist whose imagination creates objects by virtue of
the passionately objective way with which he describes
them. There is no perspective, everything in the story is on
the same plane and has a right to the exact same
treatment: the solicitor as much as Colonel Chabert, the
clerks and the errand-boy as much as the solicitor, the
office as much as the clerks, and in the office the
cardboard boxes, the dossiers, that old pouch inherited
from Chatelet, in short everything that is describable in

4 The preface of 1842 to La Comédie humaine is clearer than


any commentary could be. Even if it contains an element of
imagination, Balzac’s scientific ideal is sincere and is lucidly
expressed. “Hence there have existed, and hence there will always
exist in all times, social species just as there are zoological species.
If Buffon has wrought a magnificent work in trying to represent
the ensemble of zoology in one book, was there not a need to
fashion a work of this kind for society?” Balzac, vol. I (Paris:
Pléiade), p. 4. If this is not the Balzacian novel in toto, at least it is
an essential trait of it.

41
detail. It overwhelms the reader with a simulated truth,
and at times it is a trifle tiresome; many find Balzac
unreadable, but they are artists of style. The novel, as
Balzac understood it, is an art, even a great art, but it is
not an art of the beautiful.
This is not said to diminish the novel, not even as a
work of art. Our concern here is not to pass judgments
but to classify objects by defining the notions we have
about them. Many arts, rich in beauties of all kinds, are
not essentially arts of the beautiful. History is not an art of
the beautiful, even if a Michelet is the historian. Neither is
eloquence one of the fine arts, even though the oratorical
art merits the name. But eloquence employs the beautiful
for the ends of persuasion which are its proper end. It
would have made Bossuet indignant to be told that he
preached sermons for the love of art: the end religious
eloquence sets itself is religion. The history of literature,
which Francis Bacon conceived and described long before
it existed, is not to be included among the fine arts. Nor
are works of literary criticism, even when their authors are
De Sanctis, Sainte-Beuve and Charles du Bas. Indeed, the
more they attain the perfection of their respective types,
the more do these literary genres differ from the fine arts.
There is an art of the beautiful in literature each time that
the end of a word is its own beauty, independently of its
truth. This is why poetry, finally, is the supreme form of
the arts of language, for it is understood in advance that
multa mentiuntur poetae, and no one holds them to strict
account.
This homeland of the arts which, though rich in

42
beauty, are not fine arts, is immense and populated by
servants of the mind, themselves artists but not primarily
the servants of the beautiful. Balzac included among them
Colonel Chabert: “If he pursued his military fame, his
fortune, himself, perhaps it was in order to obey that
inexplicable feeling, an embryo in the heart of all men, and
to which we owe the researches of the alchemists, the
passion for glory, the discoveries of astronomy, of physics,
of all that which impels man to make himself more
important by increasing his stature by deeds or ideas.” All
these men have a right to our respect and sympathy, but
none of their “deeds”, to use Balzac’s language, surpasses
in gratuitousness the work of the servants of the beautiful,
loved and served for its own sake. Their model is
Stéphane Mallarmé whose volume Vers et Prose sold at the
average rate of 250 copies a year for almost sixty years.5
The poet publishing his slender volume of verse has been
compared to the traveller who leans over the edge of the
Grand Canyon in Colorado to drop a feather and then
cocks an ear to catch the sound its fall will make upon
hitting bottom. Philosophy is perhaps the only discipline
that can render this ultimate service to the arts of the
beautiful, and can recognize them for what they really are.
By insisting upon the transcendental specificity of the
beautiful as a good of the sensibility, and consequently
upon that of the arts of the beautiful as being essentially
dedicated to its service, it can at least protect them against
5Henri Mondor, Autres précisions sur Mallarmé et inédits (Paris:
Gallimard, 1961), p. 114.

43
the last danger besetting them: annihilation as the result of
being confused with those arts which, by usurping the title
of the arts of the beautiful, occupy their place in thought
as if it were not enough to have taken their place in reality.

44
TWO
Architecture

ACCORDING TO THE USUAL meaning of the word,


architecture is the art of constructing, ordering and
ornamenting buildings in conformity with plans drawn up
beforehand. The architect lays out the plan of all
construction of this kind and directs its execution. There
is no reason to dispute this usage, only it must be exactly
circumscribed and determined if we wish to speak of
architecture as one of the fine arts. One of these arts, to
be sure, answers to the name of architecture, but all
architecture is not necessarily one of the fine arts.
Architecture can be included in this category only if the
architect’s principal purpose is to create the kind of beauty
proper to the building constructed according to his plans.
A fairly wide-spread view of the problem would
dispense with the need to pose it at all, for it is traditional
to consider architecture as the mother of all the fine arts,
that is to say of all those which, according to the usual
dictionary definition, have as their object “the
representation of the beautiful”. First of all, we can ask
ourselves whether architecture’s purpose is to “represent”
anything at all. Secondly, architecture has obviously

45
provided practitioners of other arts with opportunities to
bring their skills to bear: buildings to be ornamented with
statues, walls, ceilings or vaults to be adorned with
decorative paintings, wood-paneling and iron-work to be
executed, and so forth. Yet very ancient statuettes such as
the Aurignacian Venus, the mural paintings like those in
the Lascaux caverns and other prehistoric sites seem to
ante-date the construction of proper buildings. Once
integrated with architecture, these arts have regularly made
efforts to break away from it. Whether this was a step in
the right direction or an error on their part is another
question, but the fact is they did. Hence it is not clear that
architecture is one of the fine arts inasmuch as it is the
source or the mother of other arts of the beautiful.
Taken in this broad, usual and therefore legitimate
sense, architecture presents a character that is wholly
unexpected from an art of the beautiful: of all the arts, it is
the only one most obviously related to a practical need.
Man builds habitations to shelter himself against cold,
heat, wind and rain. To build a shelter with materials of
any kind is a purely technical problem that can be solved
in many ways according to the materials available, the
convenience with which they can be found or produced
and, finally, according to the kind of order and
arrangement ultimately imparted to them to give them the
form of a human shelter. Any form of this kind is
necessarily invented; the simplest general plan calls for a
roof supported by walls which afford an opening called a
door through which one can come and go. Simpler
constructions also exist but it seems that ever since the

46
human habitation assumed this form it has not undergone
any change down to our day. The most impressive
temples, the most magnificent palaces, the most complex
modern structures, factories that look like miniature
cities—which moreover are better planned than the
latter—all finally follow this same model: walls, roofs,
openings for lighting and ventilation. The art of
constructing edifices of this kind is a genuine art but it is
essentially a utilitarian art. Like all the products of factivity,
buildings can have a beauty of their own, but it is a beauty
that is itself utilitarian, at least in the sense that it is born
of the perfect adaptation of the means to the end. The
master-builder, or architect in the broader sense of the
term, does not seek beauty for its own sake. If he chances
upon it even to the extent that he might have willed it into
being, this beauty, even though very real, is of a kind
properly suited to an architecture that is essentially
functional. The beauty proper to factivity does not belong
to the order of the arts of the beautiful any more than
does natural beauty; inasmuch as it aims to achieve the
beauty proper to factivity, architecture cannot be
considered as one of the fine arts.
Many will be surprised by such a simple remark. They
will object that functional architecture, on the contrary, is
the only architecture which is truly beautiful and should
unquestionably be ranked among the fine arts. Architects
themselves betray an obvious tendency to extend their
sphere of competence, which would constitute a real
authority. The pursuit of the beautiful always finds a place
in this sphere but it is no longer the principal goal; indeed,

47
at times it is rather hard to locate it at all.
Some confuse architecture with the body of town
planning, itself a confused notion. Aristotle, no doubt,
would admit that town-planning is architectonic in relation
to architecture proper, but its problems are concerned
with providing a setting and as favorable a habitat as
possible for the full and harmonious development of
human life. Controversy abounds over what this setting
and habitat ought to be, surrounding every conceivable
subject, including sociology, ethics and even metaphysics,
but no mention is ever made of the pursuit of beauty
constructed in space for its own sake.
The conception underlying the construction of
housing poses problems which, though less lofty, are just
as complex. First of all, housing is conceived in terms of
utility rather than of beauty. This has been known since
time immemorial, and whenever an architect has forgotten
it the budget-director of the project has taken it upon
himself to remind him of it. In 1750, after studying the
plans for the future Êcole Militaire which Ange-Jacques
Gabriel was to build, minister Paris-Duvernay wrote to the
architect: “It is less a question of erecting a monument to
the glory of His Majesty than of building one that would
be useful to the State. There is no point in trying to strike
a balance between beauty and usefulness when the two
cannot be realized.” 1 What are considered as utilitarian
1 Quoted in Ch.-M. Widor, Notice sur la vie et les oeuvres de
Charles Girault (1851-1932) (Paris: Firmin-Didot), p. 9. Read at
the annual meeting of the Académie des Beaux-Arts, December
2, 1933. I ask the indulgence of architects, who are all too
48
requirements today by far exceed anything which the
eighteenth century could imagine. The necessity of making
place for the useful inevitably limits the builder’s formal
freedom.

familiar with this kind of documentation, if I mention the


following data taken from an article in the U.S. News & World
Report, May 6, 1963, p. 54, for the enlightenment of philosophers
for whom the fine arts above all are an object of reflection: The
most recent trend in housing construction: buyers are above all
demanding more spacious houses with more bedrooms, more
rooms as such. In the new houses that have been built, 50 per
cent have two or more bathrooms as compared with 32 per cent
in the older houses. More than four out of five of the new houses
have a car-port or a garage, as compared with three out of four in
the older houses. The trend favors construction on ground-level
without basements. Less than 30 per cent of the new houses have
a whole or a partial basement as compared with 41 per cent in
the older houses. Moreover, more than 88 per cent of the new
houses are one-storey structures as compared with 88 per cent of
the older houses. Naturally these ratios vary according to regions,
the percentage of two-storey houses and basements being higher
in the colder regions. Not a word is said about style nor, of
course, about beauty. What happens first of all is that the buyer
“often demands a fourth bedroom, a central air-conditioning
system, a modern kitchen with equipment included in the
construction, and a common family room”. This does not mean
that the concern with art plays no role but it does mean that if
the architect wants to build houses, these are the demands that he
had to expect from his clients in 1963 in the United States.
Beauty, if it comes, will be given into the bargain.

49
This is so true that nowadays an architect is merely the
head of a collective enterprise in which the engineer plays
a role as important as his own. Often, indeed, the engineer
replaces him. Famous contemporary architects, in Europe
and America, take pride in the fact that they never set foot
in a school of Fine Arts; “functional” architecture, they
say, is the only architecture that satisfies the mind, and in
this way attains beauty.
True enough, the pursuit of utility does not exclude
the pursuit of beauty. It is also true that it should be
possible to obtain from the edifice built for utilitarian
purposes effects that would translate its very utility into
beautiful forms. In such a case, if success is complete, the
beautiful forms are not only accommodated to the
function but express it.2 Such is the case with “industrial
beauty” in general. Utility has its own perfection, attained
by the perfect adaptation of means to ends. When this
adaptation is successful the useful is endowed with the

2 Ath. Sfaellos Charalambos, Le fonctionalisme dans l’architecture


contemporaine (Paris: Vincent-Fréal, 1952). Notably:
“Functionalism in contemporary architecture tries to express: 1.
Function through an esthetically satisfying form; 2. Formal
perfection through working and functional elements. Its final
result in that case is the fusion of these two apparently
contradictory tendencies.” Cf. Robert Auzelle, “Le
fonctionalisme dans l’architecture,” Bulletin mensuel d’information de
la Société des architectes diplomés par le gouvernement, 116 (1963), pp.
622-630. This study is of the greatest importance to the
philosopher for its concrete discussion of architecture’s real task.

50
beauty proper to it as exemplified by a beautiful ship, a
beautiful automobile or a beautiful machine. Like the
beauty of nature, the beauty of the machine is given into
the bargain, and the beauty of a building is similar. Just as
one makes nature look ridiculous by embellishing her, and
a machine becomes a ludicrous object if it is adorned with
statues or anything else reminiscent of one of the fine arts,
so does the architect who thinks he is improving the looks
of a building by adding columns that serve no purpose or
capitals without a definite function expose himself to the
kind of sarcastic comments that so many of his colleagues
have directed against the canons of architecture and of
“styles” which survive in some institutes of Fine Arts.
Such protests are justified, but it remains no less true that
utilitarian beauty is not what the fine arts directly intend to
attain. If they also have a unique functionalism it can be
said to consist in the creation of the beautiful for its own
sake, independently of any utilitarian considerations. In
this respect, one of the paradoxes of architecture as an art
is that the beautiful is never its sole and exclusive end. A
painting answers no other purpose save that of being seen,
music that of being heard, poetry that of being read, but
the most beautiful of doors serves to let people pass
through it, any window serves to let in light, and even the
breathtaking solid walls of the Doge’s Palace, an unending
delight to behold, had the function of enclosing meeting
rooms—something we are quite surprised to learn upon
visiting the interior. Thus to speak of architecture
exclusively as an art of the beautiful requires us first of all
to make an effort at abstraction, after which we must bear

51
in mind that this was our point of departure.
This paradoxical nature of architecture is clearly
expressed in the remark of a modern architect who was
happy over the fact that for once in his life he had been
lucky enough to receive a commission to construct a
building that would “be useless”. Indeed even the
pedestals of statues and triumphal arches, in principle,
serve some purpose. As for city halls, post offices, railway
stations, schools, hospitals, barracks, prisons, banks, large
department stores and other similar edifices, the interior
arrangement of their space determines their exterior
structure, and obviously the whole is made to serve utility.
The construction of a totally useless building is therefore a
rare event, but at times the useful is of such a nature that it
does not necessarily determine any particular structure.
The less the structure of an edifice is determined by its
purpose, the more directly it is answerable to architecture
in the strict sense of the word that makes it one of the fine
arts. This is why, in all times and perhaps most obviously
in our day, religious edifices, whether temples or churches,
have directly belonged to this relatively untrammeled
architecture which can attain its particular utilitarian end
while committing itself to the creation of beauty as an
artistic end. Essentially, a Greek temple or a Christian
church is nothing else but an altar protected from the
elements by a roof and surrounded by walls. What is
involved in this case is a functional purpose of a kind that
practically imposes no conditions in terms of dimension,
form, or particular ornamentation on the edifice in
question. This or that religion can even exclude this or

52
that form of figure ornamentation, or actually forbid it
altogether, it matters little; as long as the edifice subsists as
a place of worship, of prayer, or even simply of
veneration, it is strictly a temple. The architect is free to
conceive of it as a pure object of beauty, that is, as if its
very beauty constituted the essence of the offering made
by man to the divinity. This is why the church is the only
object of beauty in so many villages. The other
achievements of any urban civilization partake of beauty
to the measure in which their architect, in order to
produce them, was free to make use of the variable
measure of freedom that his “specifications” left him.
What is left is utilitarian beauty, which is real beauty but
not our concern when we try to understand architecture as
one of the fine arts.
The creation of architectural beauty presupposes the
void that architecture requires. The architect works in
space empty of all solids as the musician works in the
silence which is the void that sound requires. Strictly
speaking, music can base itself on noise but not on sound,
unless it assimilates it. In the same way architecture can
base itself on natural forms; indeed it always does this
inasmuch as being fixed in place it must always
accommodate itself to a site. It does this by utilizing the
site, but it cannot accommodate itself to another
architecture if it is to be truly creative. Construction is
preceded by the work of demolition or leveling, or at least
the architect must start out from a space that nature has
left free of obstacles and that, by virtue of this very fact,
can be occupied by structures imagined by an architect.

53
Obviously, the overall design can even utilize the
particular configuration of a terrain in order to obtain the
best architectural advantage from it, but this very decision
is part of the work to be wrought, constituting its first free
moment of creativity. Some architects insist that a building
should be integrated as completely as possible with the
site; for example, they will not build a structure on the top
of a hill, but against it so that the hill can serve as a
backdrop. No doubt this is sound reasoning, but it would
make Mont St. Michel impossible. On the other hand,
other architects strive for effects that the first group
considers wrong and undesirable; their idea is that the
building should contrast with the environment, and cut
itself sharply off from it. But certain low dwellings, rooted
directly in the ground, which look like other undulations
in the terrain, also have their peculiar charm. These are the
different questions that an architect must wrestle with. But
whatever his decision, he must first of all clear the terrain
for the new structure. This is why architects themselves
are such dreadful destroyers of architecture: their work
can arise finally only upon an empty space.
This work is the building. As with all works of man,
the first cause of a building is its final cause. But there are
several kinds of final causes. One of them is the
perpetuation of some great collective remembrance by
endowing it with an important meaning: a hero, a victory,
an exploit, an event of joy or sorrow or anything else of a
commemorative nature. In that case it is a simple
monument. Its purpose determines its structure. Since a
monument has no definite practical purpose, it has no

54
interior, or practically none. While building it, the architect
does not have to worry about what it will look like inside.
In the first place, a monument cannot have an interior at
all as in the case of a commemorative stele; secondly, the
only purpose of the hollow of the structure is to make it
possible for one to move around in it and ensure easier
upkeep or easier access to the summit. Such are towers,
lantern-turrets in burial grounds, and trophies of all kinds.
Some types of monuments belong to both orders, but
mainly to the first, because they can containchambers
which do not serve any architectural purpose, as is the
case with the pyramids of Egypt. Constructions of this
kind are solids, or the solid dominates the empty space to
such a degree that we can consider them as simple solids.
The purpose of these architectural works, therefore,
directly affects their construction.
The one feature shared in common by all these
monuments is that they are willed and built to last. This is
not necessary—what is necessary in the free country of
art?—and we can amuse ourselves by erecting a flower-
bedecked triumphal arch designed to last but a day, in
order to honor a champion cyclist in our time, or a poet in
days of yore, but monumental architecture requires a more
solid material, especially as its purpose is to perpetuate the
memory of the man or the event it recalls. An open-air
altar is a monument of this kind; only a lasting monument
is fitting to celebrate the Eternal. Dolmens and mennins
defy the ravages of time, and they were willed into being
for an unlimited duration; the triumphal arches, which
serve only to be passed under or merely to recall the glory

55
of those who were the first to pass triumphantly under
them, the columns of Trajan, the column in the Place
Vendôme, or others. Monumental tombs and cenotaphs
of all kinds do not contain any interior space arranged for
the purpose of being seen; once they are completed, all
that is expected of them is to last, and they often do.
The second possible purpose of a building is to shelter
human beings (a house), animals (the stables of Chantilly
or of Strà), or objects (a museum). This creates new
problems. The latter have an exterior like the buildings
belonging to the first order; they occupy a part of the
space which contains them while implanting their forms
within it. But at the same time they create an interior
space; they are not contained in this space but they
contain, determine and shape it. Often, monuments of this
kind are also associated with a commemorative or
glorifying function, but this is neither their exclusive nor
proper end. This time it is the durability of a utilitarian
function that is counted upon to ensure memory. A simple
habitation, however, has no other purpose save that of
being habitable; so negligible is its commemorative
function that when the house is finished, death enters. In
any case, hollow solids of this kind pose problems of
arrangement and communication in terms of the interior
space, such as the rooms of a palace with their corridors,
their staircases (often themselves a monument within a
monument), their landings, and their exit-doors. The same
is true of temples or churches, whether their enclosed
space delights the beholder with the sudden impact of its
unity, or whether it charms him by the adroit arrangement

56
of naves, aisles, transepts, chapels, apses and small apses
which break up the unity through many artifices,
principally the pillars.
The material of architecture is the solid, or solids, used
to delimit the portion of empty space to be occupied or
enclosed. This material can be natural, like wood or stone,
or artificial like brick, cement, steel, glass, or any other
industrial product of this kind. In any case, the building
material chosen is not only solid but relatively durable.
The work of the architect, like the building material he
uses, is a tri-dimensional volume. This volume, inevitably
colored by the natural color of the materials used, by the
color which it acquires with the passage of time,
sometimes even by the color which is added to it, is
essentially immovable in space and, in its substance,
wholly alien to movement. Any edifice which “moves”,
that is to say, one whose horizontal stones, elevations or
elements begin to shift in relation to others, is on the road
to ruin. This is why the building materials must be
inorganic, or if they are organic they must have ceased to
live, like those oaken beams which acquire the hardness of
stone. Whether it is introduced into the building from
within, or from without, organic matter threatens it with
destruction.
Solid, situated in space and inert, the work of the
architect is given all at once. It is simultaneous as though
by definition. Obvious as this may be, it is nevertheless
contested in the name of a principle that is equally
obvious, only the two principles are not applicable to the
same fact. Some people, especially in architectural circles,

57
forcefully insist on what they call the dynamic of space
which, furthermore, they hold to be a constitutive element
of architectural beauty. That may be, but it is a dynamic of
the immovable. Such assertions once again confuse the
esthetic point of view, which is that of the spectator, with
that of art itself. It takes a lot of movement to erect a
building, and even more to ensure that it will remain
standing up after having been built. Movements likewise
are required on the part of the spectator. The fatigue that
comes over visitors to a palace or a cathedral is sufficient
evidence of the muscular exertion it takes to know such
structures, even superficially, in all their principal aspects.
Thus, it is rightfully contended that it is impossible to
apprehend a building as a whole, that is to say in the
totality of its form, without making a tour of it, without
perceiving from the outside its principal parts in their
reciprocal relations and in the ever changing perspectives
which a visitor’s own moving about from place to place
offers to his view. The same holds true for the interior,
with the monumental entrances of palaces, their formal
staircases, their enormous rooms and the surprises which
they hold in store for the visitor, such as the unexpected
small apartments which he suddenly comes upon by way
of narrow galleries cut off from charming vestibules
whose forms, proportions, and whose very order of
succession are a constant source of delight to the eye.
When we visit one of these palaces, we should make a
tour of the interior, but once inside we should also survey
the outside of the structure from the vantage point of the
windows and now and then from the balconies, from

58
where we can pick out in the distance a public square of
the city and the architecture of other monuments, or a
garden with its flower-beds and its fountains, or the
mirror of a lake with an island whose church is etched
against the mountainous backdrop of the landscape. True
enough, all this was foreseen, calculated and finally
brought into being through the art of the architect. He
included in the plan of his work the movements which
would be required to see the structure, and even if he may
have failed to do so they are inseparable from his work,
for without them man would not be able to, avail himself
of the services which the edifice must purvey, nor to
perceive its beauty.
Nothing could be truer, and such remarks apply to the
sequence of adventures that await the lover of beauty
during the exploration of a cathedral whose perspectives,
inside and outside the structure, ceaselessly change in
accordance with shifts in the observer’s position.
Although the artist must provide for the esthetic
apprehension of his work, such apprehension does not
belong to it per se. The artist works on the material that
must produce the esthetic experience of the beholder, not
on the esthetic experience itself. A building is not
composed of vistas, perspectives, or vantage points—no
matter how adroitly they may have been included in the
architect’s calculations—but of stones, walls, pillars or
columns arranged so as to provide precisely such
perspectives and such vistas for the spectator. The
spectator moves, but the building does not. By virtue of its
material, it is, upon completion, rooted in existence

59
simultaneously in the totality of its parts. The architect’s
work does not unfold in time like a poem or like a musical
composition. Like all that persists, a building endures in
time, but it is immobile in the flow of time in the primary
sense that it is immovable in its very being, inasmuch as it
is not in a process of becoming like a phrase that is being
spoken or sung, but is something wholly evolved, wrought
and perfect. That it requires time to become aware of this
in no way implies that its proper being is composed of
fragments succeeding each other in time.
The amazing development of the scientific study of art
and of art criticism enables us to understand why the
viewpoint of the consumer so often replaces that of the
artist. A good collection of photographs of the cathedral
of Chartres discloses many details which its master-
builders, perhaps, never gazed upon. As for the aerial
perspectives disclosed by vertical shots taken over ancient
chateaux, ancient fortresses, public squares or cities, we
can be absolutely certain that the architects of the twelfth
and thirteenth centuries never saw such vistas as the
helicopter and photography make possible to see today.
The dynamism we attribute to them is that which we
ourselves give them; the only dynamism these works of art
actually possess is an energy of immobility.
Moreover, the analysis of esthetic experience would
not exactly appear to confirm the opinion that architecture
is an art of movement. The spectator feels perfectly that
he has the movable experience of an immovable reality.
What is involved here is not merely the awareness, at
times overpowering, that such masses, like mountains,

60
“cannot move”; rather, as the spectator moves from one
place to another in order to see the different parts of the
structure successively, he perceives those which he sees in
relation to those which he no longer sees, or does not yet
see, but which he knows and senses are there.
This awareness is expressed in the certainty,
inseparable from the experience of architecture, that the
experience is reversible. We cannot read a poem or listen
to a symphony backwards, but we can begin our visit to a
building from the wrong side. All we have to do is to
make an about-face during our tour and we can start it all
over again simultaneously in all respects. Since there are an
infinite number of such directions, they could not have
been exactly calculated by the architect nor, for that
matter, did he have to foresee them in order to produce
them; all he had to do was to create the possibility of our
producing them by moving around on the outside or in
the interior of the immovable mass. It is said that
“architecture is walked through, traversed.” 3 Architecture,

3 Le Corbusier, Entretien avec les étudiants des écoles d’architecture


(Paris: Les Editions de Minuit, 1957), 4. Since it is an “artbook”,
this book is not paginated. The writing is dated October 17, 1942
(see its colophon). It goes without saying that the remark taken
into consideration here is not, in Corbusier’s thought, a definition
of architecture. For him it states essentially what architecture is in
reality: “regulation of the terrain and built volume” (in italics in
text). Another definition, in artist style, which is simply quoted, is
found not far from the beginning of the work: “Architecture is
the sapient, correct and magnificent play of volumes assembled
under light.” This is tantamount to saying, a built volume. The
61
indeed, is walked through, but architecture stands still.
The house, the palace or the church is walked through,

now classic comparison between architecture and music has


found its most seductive form in Paul Valéry, Eupalinos ou
l’architecte, Oeuvres, vol. II, ed. Jean Hytier (Paris: Pléiade), pp. 103-
105. Music and architecture both have this kinship with us of
being “two arts which enclose man or, rather, which enclose
being in his work. . .” It would be a pity if such pages had not
been written, but it would be a greater pity still to remain
insensible to the seductive views they set forth. However, reason
must know how to defend itself even against the charm of
Monsieur Teste. One is not necessarily inside architecture, for one
can view it from without; viewed from within, there one is in
effect surrounded on all sides but by the limits of a space,
whereas if at times we feel ourselves surrounded by music it is in
that case time that surrounds us (p. 102). To call time “an
intelligible and changing space” is a metaphor rather than a
concept, and without rejecting it as such it must not be permitted
to create confusions. The acts commanded by the mind of the
architect produce an object which lasts by itself in space, the acts
of the executants commanded by the mind of the musician
produce impermanent sounds which succeed each other in time
and whose existence is linked to that of the successive acts which
produce them. It is our body which is in a structured space; our
duration is not even included in that of the symphony, it
accompanies it. At the end of the first act of Parsifal we are all
older by an hour and forty-five minutes, from the orchestra
conductor to the musicians, the singers in the chorus and to the
last of the accessorists; the Festspielhaus in which we were actually
enclosed is still there, alas, for it is architecture, but Parsifal has
ceased to exist because it is music.

62
not so, however, with a symphony which runs its course;
and this time it is not we who provide the movement but
the symphony which sweeps us along with it. Architecture
is the art of that which is to last as music is the art of that
which is to pass away. Happily for us, music dies only to
be reborn, but it is restored to life just as we knew it the
first time, in the inflexibility of the same order—the one it
imposes on us—and not the one which we impose at
leisure on the inert and at times slightly ludicrous mass of
the monument.
Thus the nature of its material particularizes
architecture, but like any art it is the producer of beings
determined by their forms. Essentially, it produces an
edifice, a volume occupying space whose exterior forms
and interior structure are pleasing to the eye through the
order, proportion and arrangement of the parts. In this
sense, it is extension determined by visible forms. The
dynamic of architectural spaces is reduced to that which
they make possible, they themselves do not set it in
motion.
Building material is not the proper material of
architecture. The material of architecture, rather, is the
building material already organized into elements, each
one of which is a response to some prime construction
problem. Such are, among others, the wall, the angle
formed by the juncture of two walls, the openings made in
the wall in the form of doors and windows, the roof or the
vault, in short, those parts of an edifice required to define
and isolate a closed portion of space. These formal
elements are indispensable and independent of any

63
consideration of beauty; their material can be different but
the relationships between the materials of which they are
composed are the same, or at least very similar, and this is
the feature that confers a certain unity upon their group.
An angle wall poses problems and presents similar
features regardless of the material out of which it is built;
the roofing constitutes another group of the same kind,
but it is a real one because architects talk about it as a
distinct unity: it is always through the roof, they say, that a
building comes to a bad end.
We could perhaps discover the secret origin of
architecture if we could watch the formal virtues of its
building material come into being. Architect or not, the
man whom necessity transforms into a builder will always
proceed in the same way: a vertical wall, a horizontal roof.
To construct a building whose parts are harmoniously
integrated by employing the resources of modern
technique, the builder will content himself with piling little
houses on top of each other up to the height permitted by
the terrain and building material used without endangering
the solidity of the edifice. It is here that we can perhaps
best discern the formal vocation of the material and the
influence that it brings to bear on the art, for walls can be
built with anything at hand, but the first way that was
devised for putting up lasting walls was to superpose
stones of manageable dimensions and of suitable form—
or which were made suitable by cutting—either by leaving
them in their plain state as is done to this day, or by
joining them together with some kind of mortar. “All the
solids of a construction,” wrote the admirable Charles

64
Blanc, “are composed of props and of propped-up parts.”
The wall is the pre-eminent prop. Pillars and columns are
only broken or open walls; the essential element of
architecture is the wall.
Walls are of all kinds according to the materials of
which they are made—puddled clay, brick, concrete,
glass—and the choice of which are to be used depends on
the freedom of the entrepreneur limited only by
considerations of convenience, local resources and, finally,
cost. The problem pertains to the order of building, which
includes the order of architecture but which, as we have
said, is not to be confused with it. Building is an art
(Baukunst) distinct from that of architecture (Architektur)
and which the latter presupposes. It is an art of industrial
factivity, or of manufacture which, as we have seen, has a
beauty of its own. A beautiful but badly built edifice might
deceive the eye of the general public, but no architect will
be able to stand the sight of it; without the art of building,
it is no longer architecture but decoration. An essential
feature of architecture, viewed as one of the fine arts, is
that it presupposes another art whose specific end is to
ensure the solidity of the edifice. Now, masonry pursues
this end, and when it makes this solidity visible it yields
the beauty proper to it, that of the beautiful wall integrated
with the beauty of the edifice as a formal unity. Here as
elsewhere the beauty of art flourishes on other kinds of
beauty.
This can be better understood if we compare the
mason’s art to that of the carpenter. What is more
beautiful than a flawless work of carpentry? Not too long

65
ago a walker in the streets of Paris, or of any other large
city, would stop in his tracks at the sight of one of those
scaffoldings whose logical and harmonious structure gives
the mind a sense of complete gratification. Logic and
geometry are visibly materialized. This emotion is perhaps
joined by another which we hardly dare mention since it
so greatly risks being merely subjective, linked to the
feeling of a kind of distant but real kinship between man,
the living entity, and the wood, the residue of this other
living entity, the tree. All wood is not useable for
construction purposes, not even oak if oak is required.
What is so particularly engaging and intimate about the
wooden hut whose charm is desired even in palaces by
means of costly woodwork? But let us not pursue these
considerations which would be necessarily endless. What
endows the carpenter’s craft and creations with nobility is
the fact that he works on elements susceptible to
geometric forms which upon being conjoined are
endowed with a formal unity that is pleasing to behold,
even if the purpose is manifestly utilitarian.
The same holds true for the mason’s artistry. Although
it is more distant from man than wood since it is not a
living entity, stone is no less a natural product. It is not
found everywhere, we know where it comes from and we
call it by its name. Like wood, indeed even better, it lends
itself to division into units having a geometric form. Its
chief virtue is solidity, mother of duration, and a wall is
beautiful with the beauty proper to stone when, having
been built for solidity, it expresses this quality. There is
scarcely a man who, left to his own devices, would not

66
learn the answer to this problem by his own reasoning.
After man went beyond the stage in which materials were
held together by virtue of their weight alone, he had
recourse to cut stone. At the start, as if at the beginning of
an infinity of possible variations, we find the elementary
arrangement of the bed of stones, that is to say the regular
super-position of the stones, parallel with their beds. In
typical walling in its perfect form, the joints of a course are
placed opposite, or nearly so, to the middle of the stone
that is immediately higher or lower. This arrangement
prevents the disjunctions from spreading from one bed of
stones to the other. The solidity thus ensured is expressed
by the formal unity of a visible geometric arrangement: the
sight pleases us, it is a beautiful wall. Other courses can be
created with stones of different forms, for example, by
alternating respectively stones having long and narrow
surfaces, or by laying the stones out in a wholly different
manner, according to the materials available. The result is
always a quality of beauty that is directly answerable to the
building art. The art of the Romans was essentially the art
of masonry. This is why they were so fond of partition
walls, especially in all artifices that heightened the overall
effect of the particular structure of each wall. The Greeks
were, above all, architects. They did not fix attention upon
the wall by devices like cut stone in series, or by motif-
creating arrangements. Seeking, rather, the formal beauty
of the edifice itself, they avoided stressing its structural
elements.
Architecture, viewed under this aspect, utilizes for its
proper ends a building material already organized into

67
elements each one of which is a response to a
construction problem. We have just discussed stone as a
fundamental building material. Brick, glass and all the
other materials used in modern construction would merit
consideration from the same point of view, that is to say
in relation to architecture properly so-called. Discussions
of this kind could go on indefinitely, for it is impossible to
decree a priori, in the name of any principle, that a
particular building material ideally lends itself to plastic
beauty or, conversely, that it is naturally hostile to it. All
that philosophical reflection can do here is ask whether
the duality of the art of building and of architecture may
not be at the base of the difficulties which no disputation
will ever resolve.
It is fashionable among modern builders to heap abuse
on architects who cling to the classic style because of their
inability to find a style proper to reinforced concrete, or
even to plain concrete. The latter unhesitatingly
acknowledge this shortcoming. One of them may be
considered as their representative spokesman for having
made this avowal: “We are beginning to construct in
concrete but we continue to think in terms of stone.”4 It is

4 A remark attributed to the architect Tournon in Le


Corbusier, op. cit., about six pages before the end. Whether or not
it is authentic the remark expresses a fact, but Le Corbusier
somewhat over-hastily makes “an honest confession” of it. What
this remark expresses is a fact. Its author refers to a “tenement
building on Rue Nungesser-et-Coli, constructed of concrete and
which proclaims precisely that here the architect has thought in
concrete,” but this is not the question. The question is to know
68
easy to misuse an admission of this kind, but it would be
more instructive to ferret out its meaning. If relatively few
architects sincerely and persistently try “to think in terms
of concrete”, the reason may lie perhaps in the fact that
concrete does not suggest any architectural idea to them.
In other words, they do not love concrete; a building
made out of concrete does not strike them as pleasing to
behold. This material which lends itself to everything and
does not impose on the architect any formal conditions
proper to it, being grey, dull, monotonous and indifferent
to the play of light, first of all inflicts a curious feeling of
deception on the eye. A wonderful and highly appropriate
material to use in public works which must be integrated
with nature such as dams, dikes and other engineering
facts of this kind which also have a beauty all their own,
concrete is deceiving in architecture through a kind of
absence of the building art. The architect experiences an
insurmountable aversion when he does not perceive this
art, pleasing in itself, in the finished work. It would be
useless to object that concrete is also a building material

whether this idea in concrete is a beautiful idea. Here, all


objective criteria are lacking. We will never know whether what
the contractor takes for architectural beauty is not simply the
quite legitimate satisfaction that he experiences at the sight of his
technical success. Since Roman times, builders have sought
beauty in bigness which is precisely the criterion of technical
success in the art of building. It is the beauty of the genre
pyramid, which is real, but it behooves esthetics, not the
philosophy of the fine arts, to define the beauty proper to it.

69
because this is not a question here. What is at stake is to
ascertain whether concrete is a kind of structure from
which architecture can be created; if the architect’s answer
is negative, he scrutinizes the building and finds no
architecture in it.
The problem is of a universal character in an age like
ours in which industrial progress has super-abundantly
increased the number of potential building materials and
the techniques enabling their utilization. In its most
general form, the question is whether any potential
building material is susceptible to artistic form. In this
respect the attitude of the contractor or of the engineer is
quite different from that of the architect. In the presence
of a new building material or of a new technique, the
former will be very eager to use it. To what purpose? To
do everything that it is possible to do with it. It strikes him
as absurd not to utilize a means of production which, as
the achievement of our scientific and technological age,
opens up new perspectives to the builder. Those who
hesitate, or reject it, are denounced as reactionaries. At
times this is true but not always, nor necessarily. A sure
way of bringing ridicule upon oneself is to prophesy a case
in which this would not be true, yet it is not certain that
any new technique is bound to find a beauty proper to it,
or at least a beauty akin to that which we expect from an
art of the beautiful. Today in literature, in poetry, in
painting, in the theatre, everywhere, we find new means of
expression in search of a beauty which would be their
unique creation. We never know how long the quest ought
to go on in order to ascertain whether the failure is the

70
fault of men or of things. For a very long time now we
have known one thing: stone is the pre-eminent building
material of the architect’s art. The reason for this may lie
in the fact that stone introduces the minimum industrial
intervention between the artist’s conception and his work.
All we see of the form wrought in stone is the form itself.
Be that as it may, and whatever the outcome may be,
current experience favors stone. And this experience goes
back a very long time. Since the time of the Romans, the
golden age of masonry, imitation has always been a
oneway process. Plaques of all kinds, the crudest replicas,
have always aimed at having what was not stone look like
stone, not vice-versa. On the ground of symbolic fact, let
us recall that in the first bridge in Paris built of concrete
cut stones were simulated to reassure the public. This
symbolic fact can serve for a host of others. Even when it
imitates wood, cement engenders a disturbed feeling in the
beholder. In the future, when cement fully prevails, we
may know of the architectural masterpieces for which the
arts of the beautiful can be indebted to it. Assuredly, it can
serve other arts which have or can have their own beauty,
and since all beauty is pleasing, none is negligible. But this
is not in question here. We possess new building materials
for which we do not yet have styles. It is simply a question
of ascertaining whether some of these materials do not
contain artistic forms that are proper to them. It is
certainly possible. The philosopher is not qualified to
answer the question as to whether this is a fact that can be
ascertained or disproved. People deplore the ugliness of so
many modern buildings. Perhaps this ugliness is inevitable,

71
for there is no way to prohibit builders from utilizing any
new materials and adopting all new techniques. And it is
possible that among these new materials for which we
have not yet found beautiful forms, there are some which
do not contain them.5
Of all artists the architect is the one whose art is most
encumbered with limitations. He does not choose the kind
of building to be constructed; this is decided only by the
client, whether he be a private person or a public body;
the architect will build the city hall, the railroad station, the
school, the low-cost housing project or private mansion
which others need. Rarely is the location left to his choice.
The building material, the interior arrangement and, for
this very reason, its exterior aspect are in part
predetermined by the functions that the edifice must serve
and the financial resources available. There would be no
end to listing in detail the restrictions symbolized by the
“specifications”; the architect, in fact, is never sure that he

5 The connection between the technique of construction and


architecture is so close that if the former changes, an architect
can have the impression of finding himself before a building that
is a nullity. Here is a well-known architect who is not an enemy
of new building materials: “Steel, concrete, glass, are magnificent
building materials with magnificent possibilities!” But he takes his
students to see Ronchamp and his reaction is wholly negative:
“As a master builder, I think that Ronchamp is absolutely not a
building.” Why? “It denies all the laws of building.” Paul
Schmitthenner, “Tradition und Fortschritt in der Baukunst” in
Reden und Gedenkenwort (Orden Pour Le Mérite für Wissenschaften und
Künste), 3, 1958/59, p. 57.
72
has seen the last of them. Yet the person with a passion
for building endures all in the hope of ultimately realizing
his dream: to create the new being, a structure perfectly
occupying its space, solidly implanted in the ground and
which although serving a useful purpose will be a pleasing
sight to behold. Before, there was only an empty terrain,
which perhaps even had to be cleared; later, the building
rises on this spot; the architect looks upon it and thinks
that, after all is said and done, it is his work. If he has
created an artistic work, this work will resemble him and
he has enriched the world with it, and it is with pride that
he is ready to sign his name to it.
What did he contribute that was peculiarly his own?
Form. But even here, he was not completely free. A style
can be forced upon him, models can be suggested to him,
in short he can be enslaved to tastes that are alien to him;
but if he is sure of his own taste it will be the architect
who finally decides what the building is to be. His
creation, the first act from which all the rest will ensue, the
act in relation to which the subsequent ones will be
arranged in keeping with their purpose, is an act of the
mind. More precisely, it is an act of the creative
imagination which conceives the anticipated image of
what the edifice will be once it is built. Hence the
architect’s main problem is to invent its general form. Any
volume in space, solid or not, has a form. Form is the
arrangement and the ordering of parts so that the eye may
perceive the whole as a unity. In relation to what is
external to it, form constitutes the volume into a distinct
entity; by delimiting its contours, it defines it. In relation

73
to what is internal to it, and which in consequence
constitutes the volume, form is that which makes of it a
whole. The whole of a volume is not the sum of its parts,
but rather the ensemble of the parts insofar as its form
confers unity upon them. Leibniz would add that it also
confers being upon it inasmuch as being and being one
are the same thing. There is a form for everything that
exists, but in the case of an edifice which is to be built, or
is already built, it involves a form given in space visible to
the eye and conceived with the aim of being pleasing to
the beholder. To imagine such a form of a possible edifice
is to create it in the mind, while waiting for it to assume
the dimensions of being in reality.
Even if we do not go beyond this act of imagining, the
formal imagination of possible volumes does not start out
from a vacuum of images. We know nothing about the
beginnings of architectural invention, but archeology and
the history of art show that this invention unfolds in that
of general formal types called styles. The origin of each
style, the first acts that announce its advent, are also
shrouded in mystery and provide historians with subjects
for speculation which they find both irresistible and
ultimately deceptive. We try to divine a future style in the
forms out of which it would not have emerged if it were
not in them, but from which it still had to emerge. In any
case, historians and architects are agreed upon recognizing
what they call the primacy of technique in the history of
styles. Speaking abstractly, and by using a very general
formula embracing all possible cases, we can say that an
architectural style appears at the moment when a

74
technique of construction yields the formal beauty proper
to it.
The concept of the “life of forms”, which Focillon has
so forcefully and brilliantly formulated, assumes its full
significance here. Architectural forms live because the
architects, who create them, are living beings. Their
discoveries and the formal experiences that time and
circumstances permit each one of them accrue and are
compounded until that moment when, in the imagination
of some of them, the new technique reveals itself as rich
in possibilities which up to then were still unknown in the
order of beauty. Much time had to go by before the
discovery of the resources latent in the semi-circular arch
and in the semi-circular vault. These exceedingly simple
forms permitted the unfolding of the Romanesque style
with the naves in Sainte-Foy de Conques or Saint-Etienne de
Nevers and of apses such as those in Notre-Dame-du-Port at
Clermont, or in Santa Maria e Donato at Murano, to cite
only at random. Later the ogival, or pointed, arch was
born within the same Romanesque style as an element of
the new construction which, in the imagination of the
architects of the Ile-de-France, in turn engendered the
Gothic style. Today historians analyze monuments in
terms of plan, structure, elevation and ornamentation, or
in terms of other similar distinctions, but all this was born
of the edifice itself and first of all from the projected
image of it originally conceived by the architect. As an
artist he thinks of construction through volumes; he
becomes a surveyor, engineer and worker, if need be, only

75
so that the image may become a reality. 6 From the
moment the plan precedes the interior vision, the reign of
pedantry begins and architecture enters into a state of
decline.
The nature of the problem can easily be recognized in
our time when concrete is still trying to determine whether
it can create a style; or rather in the history of the other
technological revolution heralded by the advent of the
American skyscraper. Architect Frank Lloyd Wright often
pointed out that the first buildings of this kind consisted
merely of a pile of low houses superposed upon each
other. One day his teacher showed him a photograph of a
recently built skyscraper, simply saying, “Look, that’s a tall
building”; in other words, a building conceived in terms of
tallness and not merely as a heap of low buildings, piled
one upon the other up to the desired height. To do that it
was necessary that an architect think about a new form
which would make an organic whole out of the ensemble
of the structural elements included in the edifice. The
formal invention in that case consists in casting, so to

6 There is no architect who, as long as his age and vigor


permit him, does not like to prove before his men that he can
pitch in and do their work too. At any rate, it is certain that the
invention of constructed forms presupposes that of new
processes required in order to construct them. The architect who
finds an extraordinarily efficient collaborator in his contractor
may find himself becoming one. Indeed, it is classic to hear the
contractor who will confide to anyone who will listen that the
building would not stand up without him, as if the architect alone
had been involved in the project.
76
speak, this multiplicity into a unique form created to
receive it. Now that the problem has been solved at the
building level, will it also be solved at the level of
architecture? Up to now the skyscraper is the meeting-
ground of all the ancient styles rather than the revelation
of a new style, but it is too early to prophesy without
running the grave risk of being mistaken.7
Philosophers do not easily take to the notion that the
purpose of architecture is to produce buildings revealing
only their beauty. In contrast to those who forget the

7 There are encouraging signs. It seems that it is no longer


believed that a skyscraper has style if it terminates in a Florentine
villa, in a Siamese tiara or in any specimen of a style already
known. The most recent skyscrapers that have been built try to
find their own roof. As regards the constructions of traditional
dimensions, it is possible that they have already found their style,
but that our eye is not yet accustomed to discerning it. Styles
assert themselves with the greatest clarity at the very moment
that they are on the wane. Finally, we can ask whether the
characteristic of a new architectural style is not found elsewhere
than in the presence of a formal new element. We already
recognize a “modern” edifice at first sight. In trying to know
why, we learn first of all that it is not classifiable in the ancient
styles; in the second place that the novelty of forms is closely
related to the use of some new materials; and finally that their use
has the effect of enabling the adoption of lines which formerly
were still impossible. Therein lies one of the principal difficulties.
The desire to attempt everything that has become possible with
the new building materials and new techniques does not
guarantee that the result of the experiment will be beautiful.

77
beautiful in favor of the useful, metaphysicians betray
beauty for the sake of truth. In an essay written in 1900 on
the philosophy of Ravaisson, Emil Boutroux asked in the
most natural way in the world: “Indeed, are not the arts
themselves an effort of the mind to grasp and express that
which is most perfect and essential in nature and in man?”
Thus understood, the function of “works of genius” is to
disclose a certain “conception of things”. Reflection upon
architecture helps to free us from this error. The
anonymous creators of the Greek orders, those who were
the first to experiment with the use of the semi-circular
arch and then with the ogival arch, or those who were the
first to return to the Greek modes which, actually, had
never been forgotten, do not seem to have wanted to
know or express existing reality, but rather to create. Their
effort aimed at producing a being whose beauty would
justify its existence, and which would be an addition to
nature instead of an expression of it. It is significant that
in his sermon on death, the classic Bossuet should have
found a key to the realm of art in the dogma of the
creation of the world. God made the world like a huge
machine of which man can make use and which he can
further embellish by his art. And how could man do this if
he did not bear within himself “some artistry derived from
this primal artistry, some fecund ideas drawn from these
original ideas, in a word, some likeness, some flow, some
portion of this artisan spirit that has made the world?”
Can we determine exactly what is proper to the
architectural form which this thought creates? It is all the
more interesting to attempt it inasmuch as it is confirmed

78
by reflection, as fluid and immaterial as the matter which it
orders is solid. The contrast perceived between the
immateriality of artisan thought and the weight of the
mass that it orders seems to be included in the esthetic
experience of architectural beauty. Indeed, there is a
mysterious something in the event. It is really a thought
which has become stone by mobilizing for this purpose
the docile bodies of innumerable human beings freely
acquiescing to serve it, or forcibly made to bend to its law.
There is human blood in the mortar of any great
monument and much human pain in the beauty of a
cathedral. How many workers died on these immense
crosses? Along with the poets, we prefer to think that all
this was done by the waving of a magic wand, but the
mystery remains. When Amphion, the son of Jupiter and
of Antiope, built the walls of Thebes by the sound of his
lyre, the stones, of their own volition, gently slid into the
desired position in the walls. This beautiful myth has
crossed the centuries but not without attracting the
attention of some meditative persons born to understand
it. Faithful to their vocation, the German Romantics
formulated the meaning of this myth. Schelling translated
it into a concept when he defined architecture as the
“inorganic, artistic form of plastic music”; and Schlegel
coined a felicitous phrase, which rightly enjoyed a great
vogue, when he called it “a crystallized music”. Such
images draw attention to a very important point. Whatever
building material it uses, architecture consists in imparting
to it a form whose intelligibility is perceptible to the
senses. This form is the work of the mind, and by virtue

79
of this authority it bears its own justification within itself.
The geometric relationships between the forms of
volumes constructed in space contain their complete
meaning within themselves; like the relationships between
sounds that the musician creates, those established by the
architect between lines, surfaces, and volumes obey
mathematical laws and in neither of these two arts does
the manner in which they are arranged aim at the
reproduction, representation or imitation of any external
object. The meaning of an edifice is in itself; the plastic
structure realized by the architect is its own justification.
This autonomy of architecture is evident from the
moment a choice is made regarding the elements to be
used. If we look carefully, we can easily find in nature
forms similar to those organized by the architect. The
architect does not find ready-made straight lines in nature
any more than the musician finds therein the musical
sounds which he combines according to definite laws.
Delacroix declared that nature abhors them and tries to
destroy them—right angles, perfect arches and so forth.
Assuredly, there are no forms the idea of which is not
suggested by nature. The artist creates neither from a
vacuum of matter nor from a vacuum of forms, but those
forms which he uses are intermediaries between the
perfect geometric forms which exist only in the mind and
the rough outlines met with in nature. The ensemble of
invented elements that architectural invention utilizes
consists of straight lines, plane or curved surfaces whose
forms are calculated and owe as little as possible to
chance—in short, all the figures and solids that geometry

80
conceptualizes and that stereotomy produces. As in music,
everything in architecture is a work of art, even its
material. Everything in it is creation.
Architecture does not speak, it is. It is enveloped in a
great silence, but man, being a great talker, strains his
ingenuity to make it talk. We must have recourse to
ancient Greek temples, primitive Roman churches or
Cistercian chapels to offer examples of pure architecture
whose whole beauty is in the form. If architecture keeps
silent, monuments are made to talk. They are sculpted,
painted, they are made to tell the Bible story in a hundred
ways, that of Amiens or any other. As long as the
decoration is integrated with the edifice and does not alter
its line, not only does it not act as a disturbing element but
it varies the plays of light by catching it on the surfaces.
Moreover, taken in itself, a sculptured or painted
ornament can be a perfect masterpiece, but it is
answerable to another art. The effort to ascertain the
nature of architecture and to define it in itself does not
commit us to isolate it from what it is not. There are
Baroque churches which are nothing more than a pretext
offered to the sculptor to display his virtuosity. This does
not make sculpture into architecture, and the effect
produced is a question of personal taste. Pure architecture,
perhaps, would have only a handful of faithful followers if
buildings offered themselves to view without an imagery
designed to fix the attention of the beholders.
The formalism of architecture enables us to
understand why the great philosophers and theologians of
the Middle Ages, whenever they had occasion to talk

81
about artists, usually cited only the architect. Saint
Thomas, who inherited this idea from Aristotle, cites no
other, and he does this only to compare the architect to
the metaphysician. The First Philosophy, which is the
supreme architectonic science, stands at the summit of the
hierarchy of the sciences, since its proper object is the
cognition of the principles upon which the whole edifice
of knowledge depends. Thus, since Wisdom is
architecture, architecture is like the wisdom of an
ensemble of manual operations which it arranges and
regulates with a same end in view.
This explains the favor enjoyed among scholastics by
the famous definition of art as a good, reasoned method
of production. For it quite fittingly applies to the architect
who invents, projects, prescribes and superintends, but
does nothing with his hands. Once more, he resembles the
musician who composes the symphony but does not play
it. This results from the fact that both handle only forms,
although in different ways. In contrast to the musician, the
architect needs neither an interpreter nor executants to
carry out his plan; all he has are contractors and workers
who do not confer existence upon the materials of the
work in the way that executants create musical sounds,
and who do not decide, as does the orchestra conductor,
how the work will be realized. The architect disposes as he
pleases of the assured materials, all he has to do is to
choose them, and since he is ultimately responsible for the
whole he wields authority over the whole operation, but
he does not construct. The very nature of the operations
to be carried out opposes this. The architect is shown

82
holding a square-ruler, a compass, a simple ruler. A
plumbline can be seen alongside him, but he is never
pictured with a trowel in his hand. Like the composer, the
architect is a white-collar worker. His work is done at an
architect’s table, on which the future volumes are
schematically projected.
We are talking here about architecture proper, but it is
obvious that the completed edifice, house or monument,
is not the work of architecture alone. Architecture, being
an art of space, attracts all the other arts of space which
obtrude to adorn it, but also to disfigure it, or in any case
live off it parasitically. The arts of eloquence and music are
the only arts which ally themselves with architecture
without harming it. Since they are not arts of space, they
can associate with it and exploit it without harm. When
Monteverdi’s music used to be played on Fridays in the
festive hall of the palace in Mantua, the architecture did
not suffer from it. Ornamentation forms part of the
edifice, but the architect is not its author. 8 To ordain

8 The history of art rightfully takes the edifice as it is, or was,


in the global unity of its form, its structure, and of its
ornamentation. Its useful function even belongs to it. When a
Gothic cathedral loses its altar, by becoming Protestant, it loses
its intelligibility and its beauty at the same time. Roman art is not
pure architecture; its ornamentation belongs to it only in the
measure in which its bands, capitals and statue-columns have
been willed by an architect. If there is something excessive in this
philosophic spirit of abstraction, we will look for its antidote in
John Ruskin. The Seven Lamps of Architecture will provide the
reader with the opposite of almost everything I have said here. In
83
whether or not there is to be ornamentation depends on
special circumstances. In any case, it is remarkable that the
great mural decorations, whether on walls or on vaulted
ceilings, smoothly integrate with painted architecture, in
camaïeu or in trompe l’oeil, as if to effect a harmony
between the two arts of space which do not deal with it in
the same spirit or in the same way. Some architecture calls
for painting and statuary, some rejects them. The most
favorable circumstance is that in which, as in Romanesque
art at the time of its flowering, architecture secretes its
own ornamentation. But these are problems outside the
frame of architecture proper. Their solution depends on
the taste of the artists. Moreover, we are thereby touching

Ruskin’s book architecture is illumined by the lamp of Truth, it


imitates nature, and the illustrations with which the author
accompanies his text reproduce ornaments and decorations as
though architecture consisted essentially in that. Yet who would
wish that Ruskin’s book had never been written? It is replete with
beauties all its own, it abounds in correct estimates of its objects,
and if the author has chosen to talk more about what he likes in
the monuments of architecture than about the very essence of
the architect’s art, was this not his prerogative? Ruskin is
reproached for his moralism, but who will deny that there is a
probity of art, and that it is essential to beauty? It is a good thing
that most of the possible points of view on the same object are
already taken, even if we can occupy ourselves with them only
one at a time in order to arrive at a clear view. If we refer, for
example, to Aphorism 22, which expresses a prudential mistrust
of sculpture in architecture, we will see how different theoretical
views can at times agree on the same reality.

84
upon problems of esthetics, distinct from poietic activity
which is the very substance of art.
There is only one point in which esthetic experience
obviously affects art in its very poietic function. If the
artist’s general purpose is to produce the work, once this
work is wrought the purpose of the finished work is to be
seen. Therefore, the architect must construct the edifice
such as it must be in order for it to be seen as it should be
seen. Even as a simple optical instrument, the eye has its
exigencies. Therefore, the architect must calculate the site,
the dimensions and the proportions in terms of the way in
which they will be seen. The Greek architects knew this.
In the Parthenon the deliberate inward inclination of the
columns, the thickness of the angle columns, the exact
emplacement of those in the middle of the colonnade
were so many devices to give the edifice the appearance
that it has for us today. Relationships of a strictly
mathematical, rather than an optical, character would spoil
the impression that the artist wishes to produce. Likewise,
in a Gothic cathedral, in looking for the exact place for the
two towers of the facade—a problem whose complexity is
sufficiently revealed by the history of art—the architect
turns into the difficulty of passing from the horizontality
of the facade to the verticality of the spires. The so-called
gallery of Kings solves the problem, provided that the
simple small columns of the facade are of a height they
must have to ensure the apparent dimensions which they
ought to have. Some of these conditions of the esthetic
experience are unfortunately beyond the architect’s power.
It is not so much the edifice that will change as, inevitably,

85
the site around it. Saint-Germain-des-Près, Notre-Dame de Paris
and Sainte-Chapelle have become unrecognizable because
the absence of style in the structures around them today
makes them archeological remains denied by their
environment with which they in turn contend. The
architectural sites for which these edifices were originally
built have ceased to exist for a long time. The architect
loses exclusive control over his work even before it is
finished. Restorers know very well that the appearance of
a monument is almost always improved by restoring it to
its original state. The architect is not able to foresee
exactly how this edifice will age; the esthetic reality of his
work escapes him to the degree of his ignorance on this
point; he can only make the building as durable as
possible, and nothing allows him to foresee exactly when
or how it will eventually meet its demise.

86
THREE
Statuary

IT IS EASILY GRANTED that statuary progressively cut


itself off from architecture during the transition from low-
relief to high-relief to full-round. The hypothesis satisfied
the imagination, but the continuity which it implies is not
evident, for there exist prehistoric statuettes and nothing
about them indicates that they are posterior to an
evolution of this kind. Nevertheless, the ensemble of
operations whose end is to create in space a hollow
volume defining the contours of a habitable space differs
specifically from that whose intention is to create solids
the proportions of which are pleasing to the eye.
These solids (or objects giving the impression of being
solid) are statues. From the earliest beginnings to our day,
the art of statuary has been closely related to social
activities alien to the arts of the beautiful. Religions,
nations, families, at times individuals have had recourse to
statuary to illustrate their beliefs, their feelings, their
vanity, but actually this art is quite apart from all that.
Connected so closely with collective or individual
representations of this kind, it merely serves them by
producing statues. And it makes these representations

! 87!
serve it as much as it serves them, for statuary has always
lived on them, and it exists as an art of the beautiful only
to the extent to which the sculptor, regardless of the
feeling inspiring the “commission”, seizes the opportunity
to produce a work capable of pleasing the eye.
One is so far from limiting this plastic art to its proper
object that the definitions made of it sometimes neglect to
mention beauty as being among its ends. Sculpture,
according to one definition, “is the art of expressing ideas,
feelings or characteristics by the chosen and obvious
imitation of living forms.” Viewed thus, “sculpture is a
powerful means of public education, because its creations
perpetuate among men the presence of a higher beauty in
the visible and tangible forms which are manifestations of
the spirit.”1 But how many times has not the artist first
made the statue for its own sake and then looked around
for a label denoting that which the viewer might wish or
imagine it to express. Even granting that statuary is an art
of expression and of the expression of ideas, the fact
remains that it conveys this expression through the
medium of statues and that its proper end is to produce
them. What, then, is a statue?
Inasmuch as it belongs to the arts of the beautiful, its
first character is to appear to the beholder as a solid block,
constituting a distinct whole in space, immovable as the
inert material of which it is made and the sight of which is
desirable in itself. What is here in question, therefore, is
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
1 Charles Blanc, Grammaire des arts du dessin, book II, ch. 1; op.
cit., pp. 329 and 333.
! 88!
statuary in its perfect form, which is full-round, and of
which it can truly be said that it produces distinct and
isolated objects in space. Indeed, this is why the
temptation to define it as an imitative art is almost
irresistible, for it frequently imitates, and when it does it
gives the impression of emulating nature, indeed almost of
competing with it-and sometimes with a semblance of
success. This feeling is aptly expressed in the myth of
Pygmalion. We can say of a statue: all it lacks is the gift of
speech. In this respect, neither painting, music nor
literature is comparable to sculpture. The sculptor must
find in this feeling a source of the joys proper to his art.
The reason for this is that his work is a thing among others
and that it preserves its ontological status even if its
purpose happens to be imitation.
The statue, made of a solid of some kind, is as inert as
the material substance used to make it. This is why
statuary is an art of space, for it is of the essence of the
statue that it be given all at once. Some last for millennia.
“The bust outlives the city,” says the poet, but statues last
in the simultaneity of their parts, or of those which survive
the ravages of time. The same controversy that revolves
around the nature of architecture is repeated here. It is
pointed out that it is impossible to see a statue without
envisaging it in all its aspects, which cannot be done unless
the spectator moves around it. True enough, but in this
case it is the spectator who moves around to see it just as
the sculptor moved around while making it, but the statue
itself does not move. Kant has clearly established that the
form of space is given in that of time. Before him,

! 89!
Aristotle had asserted that we think in time, but it does
not follow therefrom that space is time. An art of
movement is one in which the works themselves exist only
successively in time, part after part, not an art which
requires that the artist move in order to produce them, or
that the spectator move in order to behold them. Whether
they are heavy or light, statues are immovable solids, and it
is precisely for this reason that the spectator must move
when looking at them. Whereas music, the dance, or
dramatic art, in order, to exist, move before spectators
fixed in their seats, sculpture’s essential immobility
requires the spectator himself to move around it so that he
can view it as a whole. A statue, no doubt, can be set on a
rotating platform, but in that case it would be necessary to
immobilize it in order to see only one aspect of it all at
once.2 When statues are carried in a pageant, the spectacle
can take on a hallucinatory beauty, which invariably
produces a strange effect, like the Spanish statues that
swing gently to and fro with an almost living grace when
they are borne in religious processions.
Statuary is the art of making statues, whatever the
process. Sculpture proper is the art of making statues by
working directly on a block of wood, stone or marble,
using a hammer and chisel, so that ultimately only the
form of the statue subsists. This process, called direct
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
2 The rotational movement
imparted to the statue produces a
curious effect of unreality, for in that case all its aspects are
presented successively in the same light, whereas the immobile
statue offers different lights and shadows to the spectator who
moves around it. The real statue does not move.
! 90!
carving, is distinguished from the statuary obtained
through modeling. Sculpture works directly on hard
material, whereas modeling is practiced on a substance
that is soft and suitable to being moulded by the hands
with the help, if necessary, of knives, chisels or other
similar tools. Like sculpture, modeling produces statues,
but it is a statuary of a different kind.
The basic material of sculpture is a natural product
endowed with its own structure and with physical qualities
that determine its formal vocation. Men have sculpted
stone and wood, secondarily ivory and bone, since time
immemorial. The initial choice of one of these materials
predetermines in part the kind of statue that will be
obtained. The color will be necessarily different. The
statue has a skin. The more or less deep brown of wood
can be distinguished at first sight from the greys or reds of
granite, as the whitenesses of ivory differ from stone or
marble. The physical qualities of the materials chosen are
infinitely varied, so to speak. The wood chosen is often
the heart of oak, of ash, or beech, but this can also be a
sap-wood that has been left to age for a long time to gain
the required hardness. These woods differ among
themselves and the statues bear the marks of the
differences, but they have in common the quality of being
structured matter, alive at one time, and whose substance,
henceforth inert, nevertheless remains that of an
organized body. Its fibrous, knotty structure, variegated by
a thousand irregularities, poses problems for the artist that
often turn out to be suggestions. Sometimes the artist
finds the form in the structure of the wood. To a lesser

! 91!
degree, perhaps, but no less surely, stone and marble
speak to the sculptor who is about to subject them to his
artistry. The anecdote about Michelangelo’s repeated visits
to a block of marble, as though to consult with it from
time to time on what it itself desired to become,
symbolizes a profound truth. Matter aspires to the form
potential in it. The more form dominates, the less it need
fear a dialogue with matter, and, at times, to heed it.
Hence, there can be an intelligible relation between
material form and artistic form; the form that art imparts
to matter does not come to it exclusively from without.
No doubt it is along this path that we must seek the
reason for the high esteem in which sculptors hold direct
carving, even when they do not practice it. The artist in
this case is in contact with the material, as though in
intimate communion with it, first through its direct and
almost personal resistance to him, then on a deeper level
through the ceaseless interrogation to which he submits
the material, and to whose responses he hearkens. It is still
true to say that direct carving is superior to any other
technique of statuary because of the absolute mastery of
the craft that it requires; it has little tolerance for mistakes.
But the real reason for its eminent dignity is attributable to
the fact that no other technique strives so literally “to
extract form from the potency of matter”, if we may use
Aristotle’s old formula, or, in other terms, to actualize the
form which the material contained only as potency. Let us
not conceal the ambiguity surrounding these words; such
is always the case when we approach the region of
principles, but we should also be wary of taking them for

! 92!
mere verbiage! No doubt, what Michelangelo saw in the
block of marble which he visited was not the future statue,
for if it lay within the marble only the marble knew it, but
rather he waited for silent counsel from the form of the
block, from the grain of the stone, and from the color of
its skin, regarding the kind of a statue it had the vocation
to become. The path of execution is the true path of
sculpture, along which counsels of this kind multiply to
such a degree that the form of the matter and the form of
the mind seem to unite to guide the hand and the chisel.
Perhaps there is no other case in which artistry merges
more completely with the execution itself, and in the last
analysis it is to this fact that the technique of direct carving
owes its eminent dignity.
Philosophy has no special prerogatives except where
principles are concerned; only art itself can say what it is,
and this is why it is outside the philosopher’s competence
to discuss practices and techniques in order to discern
their spirit except on the basis of what artists say about
them and of the works they produce. By questioning
artists,3 we soon learn that there is more than one way of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
3 When asking questions
of artists we must be wary not to
interpret what is only their personal manner of understanding
and practicing their art as a theory of the same. The
demonstrations, at times somewhat dramatic, that some
“masters” give in the ateliers which they direct are likewise
subject to caution. Finally, their trade is not that of the
philosopher; we must not always interpret as definition certain
outbursts which at bottom are only practical counsels given in a
paradoxical form in order to engrave them on the memory.
! 93!
practicing direct carving, depending on whether it
introduces more or fewer intermediaries between the hand
guided by the mind and the material on which it works.
Here again, it appears that the sculpture which is more
purely sculpture is also recognized as its highest type. This
is the sculpture of those primitives whose works are so
greatly admired by many artists, to the dismay of persons
of taste. Negro art puts such persons in the presence of a
technique, that of pure sculpture, from which modern
man is separated by centuries, perhaps by millennia, from
the history of art. Specifically, it is that the technique in
which the artist’s imagination informs matter without any
other intermediary save the tool held in his hand. In other
forms of sculpture, a drawing stands between the sculptor
and the statue. During the Renaissance, sculptors worked
from sketches, later from the live model, and even used
the method, by far the worst and yet the most widely
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
“Sculpture, although this may surprise you, is nothing else but
drawing, don’t expect more, it is nothing else.” Daniel Marquis-
Sebie, Une leçon de Antoine Bourdelle à la Grande Chaumière (Paris:
Artisan du livre, 1930), p. 17. Indeed, it is something else and
Bourdelle knew it. Let us add that at that time he was teaching
students to model clay from a living model, which is a special
exercise. On the following page, he recalls the example of Ingres,
but Delacroix would have protested. Bourdelle adds: “All of you
here must clearly understand that in order to sculpt it is necessary
to draw for the same reason that the pianist forces himself to
practice exercises.” But piano exercises are piano exercises,
whereas drawings are not exercises in sculpture. One would take
pleasure, however, in watching the mind of an expert at work,
pp. 18-19.
! 94!
practiced of all times, of sculpturing statues from statues.
The more intermediaries that come between the artist and
the material of the work, the less is the artistry marked by
vigor and freedom.
The second sovereign branch of statuary employs the
technique of modeling. Until recently, the principal
materials used for modeling have been clay, wax and
plaster. The latter is suitable for all kinds of projects; clay
is preferred for works of large dimensions, wax being used
for works of smaller size, such as busts and even jewels of
which the artist desires to make models before proceeding
to the definitive execution.
Whatever material he may use, the modeler does not
do the work of a sculptor, strictly speaking, but modeling
has so generally replaced sculpture that it seems pedantic
to insist on a distinction between these two arts. Those
who faithfully visit the exhibition of the works executed
for the Prix de Rome for Sculpture do not remember ever
seeing there anything else but freshly modeled grey clays
of potential statues, still to be executed. The success of
modeling is easily understandable. The plastic material it
utilizes is as malleable as stone is resistant; with clay
nothing is, ever definitive, any mistake can be corrected,
none is fatal. Even without taking into account vulgar
considerations, which are not without importance, such as
the lowering of the cost price of the materials on which
the artist pursues his experiments, modeling in itself offers
such facilities of execution, it is not at all surprising that
there are relatively few sculptors in stone today.
Its very facileness constitutes the danger to which

! 95!
modeling exposes the artist. By this, of course, we mean
the facilities that it permits him, indeed to which it invites
him. The sculptor can pursue only the realization of one
and the same purpose on one and the same block. The
statue, whose form he ferrets out in stone or marble,
cannot make place for another in the course of the
execution. Of course it changes under the artist’s hand,
but it is always the same work in different moments of its
progress. The facilities enjoyed by the modeler are such
that, while preserving all proper proportions, his work
changes form under his fingers like the vase incessantly
metamorphosized under the fingers of the potter. Even if
the unity of form is maintained up to the end of the
execution, the temptation remains to burden the work
with details not required by this form and which in
consequence obscure its recognizability. But the artist
yields to the temptation to execute these details simply for
the personal pleasure of exercising a skill at times
bordering on virtuosity. Finally, the very malleability of
clay and wax, or of modeling paste, excludes the
collaboration of the material in the birth of all form which
characterizes sculpture, imparting its proper perfection
and approximating its works to those of nature. A plastic
material which is wholly amorphous and strictly
homogeneous has nothing to say to an artist who
examines it; in the finished work we will never feel that
substantial unity of matter and form which is proclaimed
in those works whose very form owes its precise
configuration to its matter.
The influence that the spread of modeling has had on

! 96!
statuary is appraised in different ways. As the name
indicates, modeling means to work from a model. When
the artist has passed from the model to the statue, he can
make a cast of it from which other castings will be made.
Castings can be obtained through different processes each
of which utilizes a different material, different techniques
which, consequently, lead to artistically different results.
Bronze is the best known material. Nothing gives us a
more vivid idea of the nature of the relation between art
and technique with respect to the artist himself than the
exciting account of the casting of Perseus in Benvenuto
Cellini’s memoirs. Whatever the details may be, the aim of
an operation of this kind is to impart the form of a
previously modeled statue to a metallic mass which is
almost indefinitely durable. The process dispenses with
the more complex work which consists in executing in
stone the statue as it emerges from the modeler’s hands.
The casting of the statue marks the transition from art to
industry, thereby granting us the benefit of the increasing
infallibility of its techniques, but we draw further and
further away from the characteristic act of the sculptor in
which the mind, through hand and tool, engages
personally in a dialogue with an individually determined
material. Bronze is an avatar of the model; it has its
characteristic beauty plus the paradoxical feature of
preserving the maximum suppleness in the forms and in
the relief of the metal. Donatello’s charming and
somewhat disquieting David, at the Barzello in Florence,
whose back is hardly in the heroic mould, provides a
useful contrast to the powerful David executed in marble

! 97!
by Michelangelo. The conception underlying the works is
not here in question; rather what ought to hold our
attention is the relationship between their conception and
their execution, and the respective media employed. Who
would deny that each of the works has a beauty proper to
it? It would be impossible to place them mentally on a
common scale to measure the degree of this beauty; their
perfections are incommensurable and we should all feel
free to follow our own preference, if we have any. The
fact remains, however, that if we have formed a certain
idea of statuary through reflection, and if we compare the
notion of two arts rather than the success of two
creations, we will inevitably be led to the conclusion that
the casting of a model is several degrees removed from the
act by which the sculptor directly carves the wood or the
marble. Art always denies itself some perfections when it
grants itself some facilities.
Historians of statuary seem to admit the progressive
disappearance of sculpture proper as a second
consequence of the spread of modeling. The modeler,
having never served his apprenticeship, does not even
have to forget what he has learned about sculpture. In
order to transform his own model into a statue of stone or
of marble he must call on specialists who perform this
operation as a trade. Thus the artist has recourse to the
“rougher-out” whose function consists in sculpting statues
which he himself has not conceived. The operation is
possible and the person who performs it is often a highly
talented artisan. Indeed some of these artisans devote
themselves to the art of statuary, as was the case with

! 98!
Pompon (although in his personal production this
excellent animal sculptor always insisted on bringing his
own models to completion himself).
Feasible as the operation is,4 it cannot be reversed. It
is by definition impossible to retrace one’s steps over a
path that one has never taken. The “rougher-cut” can
never reconstitute from a modeling a sculpture that has
never existed. Therefore he will never go beyond the point
to which the modeler has brought his work, not because
he does not know the art of stone-carving—after all, that’s
his craft—but because he himself does not have to create
a beautiful form by working on the stone directly in the
manner of the sculptors of old. The statue-maker himself
would not be able to transform into sculpture a model
which he has not conceived by following the shape of the
material and by being in intimate communion with it.
Neither the “rougher-out” nor the statue-maker can
fashion a sculpture out of something which was not
sculptured in the first place.
One of the direct results of this situation is that the
greater part of modern statues are in reality replicas, in
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
4 Alain goes very
far in this direction. “It is not hard to
imagine a machine for sculpting which would give the stone or
the marble the exact hollows, reliefs and dimensions of the
model.” Système des beaux-arts (Paris: Plèiade), VII, 1 p. 366.
Philosophers have a great facility for inventing these machines in
their heads, but assuming such a machine has been invented, its
work would still presuppose that of the sculptor; it would
multiply his works without having the artist work at making
them.
! 99!
stone or in marble, of original models in clay, wax or some
kind of plastic material. The dimensions of the replica
moreover can differ from those of the original; all that is
required is the application of the mechanical processes of
enlargement or reduction without the artist’s personal in-
tervention being necessary, something inconceivable in
direct carving. Hence there are fewer and fewer true
sculptures in existence. Likewise, there are fewer and
fewer sculptors in the strict sense of the word. The
philosopher is not qualified to make prophecies, but it
seems reasonable to conjecture that the future of sculpture
is bound up with the advent of artists whom technological
progress has not yet cut off from the roots of their art.
This is the meaning of the stir caused by so-called
“Negro” art which disconcerted so many of our
contemporaries. Primitive peoples will perhaps step into
the breach. In our time, of course, primitive peoples do
not remain primitive for long. We have seen Eskimo art
decay in twenty years thanks to the enlightened care of a
paternalistic administration. Let us hope that from time to
time some artist will be found who is destined to
rediscover an art whose pure form is as old as man. There
need not be a large number of them, for only a few artists
suffice to fashion the happiness of mankind, provided
they are truly great. Phidias and Praxiteles, Michelangelo
and Verrocchio, Pierre Puget and their emulators have
staked out a time-honored path on which we can assume
others will more or less safely follow.
We change worlds when we proceed from architecture
to statuary. Sculpture has no connection with architecture,

! 100!
neither in terms of its end nor of its techniques; we find
nothing of the beginnings associated with the act of the
sculptor in the act of constructing an edifice. Furthermore,
we perceive no resemblance between an edifice and a
statue; on the contrary, the differences are striking, the
most obvious one being that architecture does not imitate
anything. No house suggests that it is a model of
something in nature, whereas it is impossible to utter the
word “statue” without mentally forming the question: of
what? The statue in which the sculptor actualizes the
perfection of its essence is almost always the
representation of a man, of a woman, of some animal, or
of one of those beings conceived as the effigy of a god.
Statues of things can be made, but this is a rare event and
it is not even certain that the notion is a meaningful one.
The sculptured or modeled representation of an inanimate
object in no way differs essentially from this object itself.
The statue of a marble chair is a marble chair, but the
statue of a seated man is not a seated man.
This natural destination of statuary to represent living
beings explains the predilection of sculptors for the
human or animal form or, that is to say, for subjects each
of which has a definite unity and is a whole isolatable in
space and around which the beholder can walk. In short,
sculpture burdens philosophical reflection with the
problem of the relation of art to imitation, for what is at
stake this time is not merely to ascertain whether statuary
is possible without imitation, but rather whether statuary is
not imitation by birth and in essence.
It is imitation at least in one sense. The very project of

! 101!
fashioning distinct objects, each of which occupies its own
place in space, betrays the intention of competing with
nature where space is filled with such objects. Moreover,
as far as conjecture is possible, all the most ancient
modeled or sculptured objects known to us represent
animal or human forms. In any case, it would be arbitrary
to claim that the mimicry natural to man has not played a
decisive role in the origins of statuary. Without wishing to
make a bald assertion on the basis of what after all is an
unverifiable supposition, it seems at least reasonable to
glimpse a degree of kinship between the first modelings
and the almost instinctual movements with which listless
fingers model the bread crumbs lying on the table into tiny
animals. Primitive sculptors perhaps simply yielded to the
same tactile and muscular urge. Anyhow, mimicry seems
essential to statuary in the sense that the sculptor or
modeler, himself surrounded by things, yields to the desire
to add to the objects surrounding him other objects of
which he is the maker and, specifically, the cause. Even
today when sculpture has freed itself from the urge to
imitate to the point where it flees from it rather than goes
in search of it, the artists representative of this tendency
publicly declare that their intention is to make sculptures
which are actually “things” among things and which can
be left on the ground of a garden like a stone or a rock.
But making a “thing” is still an imitation of reality.
This basis of statuary in imitation is a salutary warning
against overdoing the systematization of philosophical
reflections on the fine arts. It is possible that all the arts
tend to liberate themselves progressively from imitation,

! 102!
but some of them cannot achieve this goal completely
because their origins lie in imitation itself. We can even
ask ourselves whether, in the case of some arts, the
concept of matter should not be divided in two, so that it
can include the imitated form itself. As we can imagine it
in its beginnings and as, in any case, we see it reproduced
in all sculpture workshops, the sculptor’s operation
consists in imparting a form to a matter sculptured or
modeled by analogy with the form of a given natural
being. It is a commonplace that the artist never plans to
copy the model exactly. Even if he is working from a live
model, as the phrase goes, his purpose is not slavishly to
reproduce a human body, since all he would need for that
would be a cast. It has been shown on occasion that some
sculptors have done just this (like Clésinger for The Woman
Bitten by a Serpent), but it is never meant as praise. One
point on which everybody is agreed is that the art of
imitation aims to go beyond the level of imitation and that
the inventiveness of the artist is to be measured by the
transformation he imparts to the model in order to guide
its natural form to the plastic perfection of the work of
art. As was suggested at first, if we consider all its
determinable elements, including its natural form, as the
matter of the work, it seems reasonable to include in the
same notion the very model from which the artist works,
in addition to the material which he models or sculpts.
The sculptor who sculpts a man or a horse submits the
form of his models to the determinations which his mind
imparts to them as authoritatively as his hands mould or
sculpt the matter of the statue. Assuredly, to sculpt a man

! 103!
is tantamount to giving the stone the form of man, but it
is also tantamount to giving the form of the real man the
form of the statue of man which is fitting only to the work
of art. The very possibility of statuary as an art requires
this. In this sense it becomes conceivable that an art as
intimately related to imitation as is statuary is,
nevertheless, a genuine art. The fact is that what it
includes of imitation in itself is only matter, even if it is a
form which is to be imitated.
This sort of primal destination of statuary to the imi-
tation of living beings, from which it disengages itself with
great difficulty and at the cost of efforts not at all natural
to it, exercises a deep influence on the plastic quality of its
works. Let us repeat once more that the artist is free, that
we can scarcely talk of rules in these matters, even barely
to the extent where the question of exceptions could arise.
What is at stake here, as is always the case with the
philosophy of art, is to extract by reflection some ideal
essences in relation to which the works will find their
place. Each one of them is beautiful if it achieves the
perfection of what it wills to be; those which find their
beauty in a proper conformity with the essence of their
own art are not necessarily more beautiful than others, but
their beauty is of a specifically different kind. Any sculptor
knows what it is for a statue to be pure sculpture; any
musician immediately recognizes the tone of pure music;
any real poet infallibly perceives the tone of poesy, in
Racine, La Fontaine or Mallarmé. Art is pitiless toward its
practitioners; good intentions are worthless, final success
alone counts, and all that can be said is that fidelity to the

! 104!
essence of its art always confers upon some work a
particular dignity which, if the work is beautiful, can only
ennoble its beauty.
Thus there is a pre-established harmony, one that is
easily discovered by man, between the distinct unities, or
living beings, situated in space and the existence of blocks
of solid matter also situated in space by means of which
such beings can be represented. In conformity with this
prime purpose, statuary in principle prefers to produce
unique beings, that is to say solitary or isolated beings. The
great majority of statues that fill the museums depict only
a single personage. Some depict groups of two or more
personages, but besides the fact that the proportion of the
latter is not very high with respect to full-round
sculptures, the impression they produce on the beholder is
accompanied by a specific feeling of disquiet. Two, three
or four personages grouped in a single work must either
be arranged so that they are perceived as one, as is the
case with all beautiful statues depicting Mary mourning the
crucified Jesus, like Michelangelo’s Pietà in St. Peter’s,5 or
the work breaks up into juxtaposed figures each of which
is set apart from the others and demands to be seen as
such. Despite the consummate harmony of the
arrangement of the figures in Rodin’s The Burghers of Calais,
they are not wholly unified to the point where this
obstacle is overcome. This is due to the fact that when
statuary represents, or creates, discrete objects in space, it
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
5 Let us mention further
the genre “The Entombment”, so
popular toward the end of the Gothic Age. Some criticize the
particularly dead aspect that “tableaux vivants” often present.
! 105!
cannot avoid juxtaposing them in the void. This is not the
case with real objects given together as a group; in reality,
which painters luckily can follow more closely in this
respect, individuals are linked to each other by the forms
and lines of objects against which they are profiled as
against a stage backdrop. Statuary does not have this
resource at its disposal; its personages must by themselves
compose a definite space in which they take their place
but which itself is suspended in the void, or they must be
set side by side like full solids, juxtaposed in the void with
no formal intermediary relationship, no bond uniting the
whole.
The situation changes when we go from full-round to
low-relief in which sculpture juts out against a
background. The artists of the great Greek epoch knew
how to utilize the background to good advantage,
arranging friezes in which the personages, though distinct
in space, nevertheless form a whole within it and are
endowed with a certain unity. But the problem subsists
even here, for the undifferentiated background of the
stone or marble does not allow a link between them
through intermediate forms. We often delight in the
ingenious devices to which the artist at that time had
recourse in order to avoid this difficulty as much as
possible. Here personages form a group while another
who precedes them turns to face them, as if leading them;
here all one of them has to do is to look backward to unite
himself with those whom his movement designates. In
another case, through a new slackening of the very idea of
statuary, the artist sketches on the low-relief a kind of

! 106!
background composed of trees or buildings which brings
the personages together in the unity of decor and
consequently of form. This genre reached its peak of
perfection in the famous doors of the baptistry at Florence
in which each panel constitutes a sculptured painting, or a
picture in relief. Ghiberti’s dazzling art abundantly shows
that the less pure modes of art do not necessarily produce
the less beautiful works, but there is a hierarchy of purity
between these modes and the eye is not deceived. Going
from Ghiberti’s doors to the Throne of Aphrodite at the
Termi museum in Rome, we experience the sensation of
entering a sphere in which beauty wills to strip herself of
all incidental ornamentation; when the statue stands apart
and alone finally in the sufficiency of its perfection, its
beauty is that of sculpture grasped in conformity to its
proper idea. It is in this sense that we can place such
works in the first rank of their art.
Another observation on sculpture draws its inspiration
from the same principle. We have already noted that this
art is alien to movement. Not all sculptors gave up the
idea of expressing movement, of course, and here again
we cannot censure them in the name of any principle. The
artist has the right to attempt everything for the simple
reason that if he fails he will be the only one to suffer
from his failure. It is therefore conceivable that an artist
can be tempted, in default of being able to do more, to
grasp and to reproduce some special moment of a
movement in the process of being accomplished. It is a
known fact that he can even invent the figuration of one
of these movements and substitute for the real position of

! 107!
the legs and arms of a man in motion an imaginary but
synthetic position whose effect on the beholder is to
suggest a man walking, as in Rodin’s statue, L’Homme qui
marche. Actually, the man is not walking at all, and no
effort of the imagination enables us even to imagine it,
beginning with the actual position of his limbs, that is to
say what this position would be in the following instant: if
he were walking. The beauty of a statue of this kind
depends on the spectator’s aptitude to perceive it as a real
immobility, and as enduring as that of stone or bronze.
The best that the sculptor can hope for is to represent the
motionless instant of an uninterrupted movement. For the
success of such an enterprise it is important that the
spectator, instead of imagining that he sees a movement—
which he cannot really believe—must content himself
with thinking that he is grasping one of its successive
moments on the wing. Thus it can be maintained without
paradox that far from wanting to compel what is
motionless to represent movement, statuary tries to impart
to movement the appearances of immobility.
It is not always easy to convince the spectator of this.
The very nature of the statue militates against this. Too
many props remind him that the arm of the Discus Thrower
threatens to break under its own weight and that the two
forward legs of the prancing horse threaten to fall back on
the ground, in which case the statue will be no more. But
the problem is posed earlier and on a less material plane.
By its very form, the solid is an enemy of dispersion, of
fragmentation and of the appearance of movement. It
“hates” movement which displaces lines. This is why the

! 108!
statue, alone, one, immovable, which desires to cling as
closely as possible to its essence avoids even the
appearance of gesticulations. It concentrates itself, so to
speak, in space, like the charioteer who, standing on his
chariot without stirring, his hands closed in front of his
body, to this day drives invisible horses. If it is necessary
to have an appearance of movement, the sculptor most
often will try to include an infinity of successive positions
in the unity of a circular form. India knows the secret of
endowing some of her deities with motion in this way.
Here there are neither laws nor rules. Generations of art
critics and estheticians have halted before the famous
Laocoön Group in the Vatican Museum as before the loftiest
achievement of statuary. Indeed, it is a beautiful work in
its fashion. It materializes the idea of what sculpture can
offer when it handles subjects which are as incompatible
with its essence as can be imagined. The Laocooön Group is
an anecdote told in stone, in which two monstrous
pythons, while strangling Priam’s son and his children,
hold them together in the unity of a single group. It is a
well-wrought work and admirable in its order for those
who find this kind of problem-complex of interest.6 It is
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
6 The name of the
Laocoön group sculpture evokes the title
of Lessing’s book, but it did not treat of statuary. The complete
title exactly describes the subject: Laocoön, or the limits of painting
and poetry (1766). Lessing was very concerned to know whether
the author or the authors of Laocoön were directly inspired by
Homer or rather by Virgil. A good question for archeologists and
philologists but one of no interest to statuary itself. Lessing
moved in the wake of Winckelmann and of the painter Mengs,
! 109!
not of the order of pure sculpture which is less rhetorical.
Michelangelo’s David does not hurl his stone; he is content
to hold his sling, a motionless and concentrated threat
within the unity of a simple form against a Goliath who is
not even there. This is great sculptural art.
With statuary, our analysis of works whose substance
is an inorganic, solid volume and whose form totally
occupies a definite space, comes to an end. The primary
competence of the sculptor, as of the architect, is the
imaginative conception of volumes. Both must “see in
space” and, if it can be said, “think in space”. It is no
disadvantage that the one uses plans and the other
drawings or sketches, provided that these auxiliaries of the
imagination come after the fundamental act of directly
imagining the future solids which will project and balance
their masses in the air in the play of the ceaselessly
changing light and shadows, so geometrical by nature that
they will enliven their surfaces. The preview of the volume
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
who contributed to the taking over of the plastic arts by the
university by taking them back to everything that one can say
about them when one does not practice them oneself. For
example, Winckelmann thinks that the object of art is to express
corporeal beauty; in consequence, to reproduce the supreme
beauty of the body is the supreme object of art; now this
supreme beauty of the body is found in the human body and, for
man, it exists only in the form of the envisaged idea; therefore the
proper object of art is the representation of the ideal form of the
human body. This conception of art is altogether reasonable and
it responds to a certain moment of Greek statuary, but we can
clearly see what it neglects, even in statuary, and for greater
reason in art in general.
! 110!
sculptured in the stone must precede and determine the
sketches in which the future status strives for self-
realization. From the moment in which the factorial order
tends to reverse itself, the two arts stray from their
essence. They can still produce beautiful works which are
not only charming but powerful. We have said that in art
success alone counts. Therefore it suffices to justify
everything, but it remains for philosophical reflection to
seek the particular relation of the works to the art which
they belong to and which they illustrate, each in its own
manner. The time of judging them comes inevitably later,
but then judgment judges itself. And once this judgment
becomes aware of its principle, it also, at the same time,
recognizes its justification and its limitation, as is shown in
the unwavering tolerance of those who, knowing why they
like what pleases them, also know why others like what
they themselves do not like. Even the intolerance that
some exhibit in matters of esthetics is easily intelligible to
them, which makes them particularly insufferable to
impassioned absolutists. But this is not proper either to
architecture or to sculpture. Painting and music offer a
preferred battleground to these personal certitudes.
It is only in very recent times, indeed in our day, that
statuary has produced works wholly in keeping with its
proper essence, by setting itself the aim of obtaining a
purely formal beauty free of any imitation of natural
objects of any kind, save that of the ineluctable necessity
of being an object. This observation does not imply any
esthetic judgment whatsoever on the works of non-
representational sculpture. Their greatest merit in the view

! 111!
of some persons of taste is precisely that which
disconcerts the taste of many others for whom formal
beauty ceases to be perceptible when it presents itself
alone, without the support of some natural form of which
it is an interpretation. What we are here discussing is
simply a fact, but one that is extremely important. After
having worked for centuries in so many schools and trying
so many different styles in order to extract a formal beauty
in its pure state from the matrix-ore of natural forms
which contain its principal elements, the Western world in
the twentieth century has tried to bring the experiment to
a close by inaugurating a sculpture free of any
representation.
It is not certain that this phase is destined to last,
because we cannot know whether a large enough public
will be formed to encourage the production of works of
this kind. No art is more costly than statuary. Many more
statues would be made if there were more art-lovers
willing to defray the costs. The existence or the absence of
a public directly conditions the possibility of the practice
of an art, and this fact is all the more brutal the more
expensive the art in question. If it should pass never to
return, the present phase would remain crucial for the
philosophical interpretation of statuary. The fact that a
non-representational sculpture was possible at once
discloses the unity of this art and the principle of this
unity. Let us recall that sculpture has existed, in an infinite
diversity of styles, in all times and in all countries, to the
measure in which men strove to create. in space solid
objects whose forms would be beautiful to behold, that is

! 112!
to say, the sight of which would be desirable for its own
sake. Herein lies the essential element, the presence of
which in any work makes sculpture of it. A Zeus, a Christ,
a Buddha, an African fetish, all belong to the art of
statuary if the beholder desires to prolong his view of
them and to renew it when the object is no longer before
him, independently of what they represent, provided only
that the artists subjected the material on which they
worked to the requirements of formal beauty.
All these statues, however, represent living bodies,
particularly human bodies. There must be some reason for
this rooted in the very nature of statuary, for even if, as we
see it today, it is possible to make a statue which
represents nothing, the fact remains that for centuries, or
rather for millennia, statuary has represented living beings,
preferably man. By defining it as the “chosen imitation of
living forms”, the classics of the philosophy of art assert
an indisputable fact.
A prime reason for this fact is that living beings have
their natural beauty, hence it is inevitable that sculptors
draw inspiration from them to create objects endowed
with a beauty proper to them. An animal is the preeminent
type of a distinct being, situated in space and whose being
is defined, inasmuch as it is the object of a possible
perception as a plurality of parts arranged in the unity of a
form. Pigeon, bull, or man—the living being is an organic
unity given all at once. Thus we can imagine that an artist
should conceive the project of creating forms, solids like
those of living beings, and like them endowed with a
distinct unity with proportions that are pleasing to the eye.

! 113!
It is more difficult to say why man, among all living
beings, should have enjoyed a marked preference. It is
tempting to assert, for example, “free through its
movement, superior through its beauty, the human form,
of all the living forms, is the only one capable of fully
manifesting the idea.” Above all, if we admit that statuary
is an art of expression and of signification, it is natural to
think that man by preference imitates the human body “to
arrive at expressing his own thoughts”. Indeed, to
represent a man who experiences or personifies human
thoughts or human feelings is the natural way of
expressing them. But the problem assumes a different
character if the object of statuary is the creation of
beautiful forms. We can easily find in nature living beings
whose plastic unity is at least as manifest as that of the
human body. But it is not so easy to let forms such as the
trunk, the members and the head of a human body really
“hold together”. The head and the neck, Ingres would say
peevishly, “never mesh”.
Sculptors therefore have not found the ready-made
model of artistic beauty in the human body. To explain
the preference which sculptors have shown in this regard,
it must be recalled that man above all is an intelligent and
talking animal. Now man tries to talk in all possible ways,
in words, gestures, attitudes, actions and operations whose
products speak for him. Speaking is not the function of an
art of the beautiful, but man naturally avails himself of it
for this end, and sculpture can be of service here. Since
man is that which most interests man, sculptors have
represented him, in one or the other sex, in all attitudes,

! 114!
performing all the acts, fulfilling all the functions of public
or private life. The artist found therein the double pleasure
of imitation itself and of the imitation of human life, to
which he is attached by his deepest instinct. All this was
only indirectly related to the production of the beautiful,
but it has been within this frame that the arts of the
beautiful have progressively recognized their proper
object. It took a very long time and seemingly it is only in
our day that this search has finally identified its object.
By placing man at the center of its interests, the art of
statuary found itself led to interpretations of the human
body such as would satisfy its taste for plastic beauty. It
was not enough to search in nature in order to discover
corporeal beauty that would also be a thing of beauty for
art, for beauty was abundantly found in nature and in all
varieties. Human bodies are principally made for life and
health, not for beauty. Nature has produced different
human types according to the different great races of man,
and even a great number of varieties within each race;
every human family secretes its own beauty. Statuary has
done the same. A history of the nude7 in art clearly shows
the variations undergone by the canon of typical beauty in
Greece, in Rome, in the western Middle Ages, in the
Renaissance and in our day. Scholars and academies have
vainly tried to fix an artistic canon of the human body, of
the face and of the members, that would have a universal
validity. Experience has shown that the genius could
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
7 Herbert Read, The Art of Sculpture, vol. 3 (New York:
Bollingen Series, 1954).
! 115!
violate every canon of this kind with impunity. Statuary
created the beauty presumed natural which it needed for
the ends of art.
Whatever the reason for this choice, once it is made
there remains nothing else for the sculptor to do but to
draw out from the human body the form of art which it
has the vocation to assume. The permanent danger
presented by the nude is the error to which the statue-
maker is exposed as much as the spectator, which turns
the interest of art toward sexuality. The esthetic-sexual
ambiguity of the nude is coessential to art. Some think that
under the circumstances the average taste has hardly any
chance to be mistaken; on the other hand, we can ask
whether in reality it is not mistaken rather easily on this
score since one of the difficulties which the artist has to
overcome is that of inducing the average spectator to view
the nude as a work of art. And much could even be said
on the value of natural taste itself. Many consider as
artistically beautiful the sculptured body whose living
model they would consider captivating and desirable if it
existed as such, but natural beauty has its order as it has its
ends, which are not those of esthetic beauty. All Venuses
are not desirable, all those who trade on their beauty are
not Venuses. Even the kinds of beauty found in the
gabinetto oscenico are at times artistic, but only by accident.
By using natural beauty as material for a possible
artistic beauty, statuary remains in the line of beauty. The
same is not true of the various utilizations of this art
having ends in view specifically different from its own.
The art of the sculptured portrait, or the bust whose

! 116!
proper end is to represent a personage as he was, is the
most difficult to distinguish from pure statuary. The art of
making medallions, including that of striking coins, which
is allied to sculpture, is naturally connected with that of
the statue-portrait. We immediately see that it is a very
great art, but it once again confirms the assertion that the
purest forms of art are not always those which give the
spectator the most intense or the most complete esthetic
pleasure. We cannot look upon a bust without asking
ourselves what kind of a man the model was. The classic
Greek statue, pure sculpture, seems cold to many
moderns; it is “expressionless”. The representation of
individuals such as they are or were, or would like people
to believe they are, necessarily includes elements of
imitation. This approach does not exclude pure plastic
invention; we know of busts or of medallions of living
personages, genuine works of art, which nevertheless are
“bursting with truth” as the saying goes. It is no less true
that the concern to achieve a likeness limits the plastic
freedom of the sculptor by forcing him to seek the beauty
of form within an ensemble of given volumes whose
curves and proportions are to be respected, at least to a
degree below which there is no longer a likeness nor a
portrait. This other end, which is added to that of the
plastic art as such, and which threatens to replace it, is the
representation of a human face or body as expressive of
an individual personality. It could be that the model may
no longer be living at the time the artist sculpts the bust or
the statue; in that case he strives in the beginning to create
an image resembling a type fixed by tradition and

! 117!
expressing the characteristic commonly attributed to the
person being represented.8 The same applies to statues
designed to represent a type rather than an individual:
Man, Woman, The Boxer, The Thinker and others of the
same kind. In a sense such “subjects” leave a greater
freedom to the artist by virtue of their very generality, but
he is still caught between two dangers, one of which is to
lose himself in the vagueness of some symbol whose
banality leaves a feeling of unreality, and the other—which
aims to avoid precisely this danger—is to make the
portrait more or less a faithful likeness of some individual
gratuitously raised to a type or class of the species. The
greatness characteristic of Greek and Renaissance statuary
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
8 Sculpture sometimes
creates artistic types which serve as
historical types about whom we know nothing: Jesus Christ, Saint
Peter, Saint Paul and others. While writing these lines I am
thinking above all of the extraordinary ancient busts of illustrious
personages whose photographs are reproduced in Jérome
Carcopino’s Profils de Conquérants (Paris: Flammarion, 1961).
Compare Caesar and Pompey on page 143; without knowing
whether they are historically faithful, we could no longer picture
the models to ourselves otherwise. The most curious thing is that
the remark would be true even if the modern attribution of busts
to this or that model was not made by the artist but by some
modern museum curator. The Brutus and above all the Cato on
page 302 suggest similar remarks. This reminds me of the remark
of my distinguished teacher Lucien Lévy-Bruhl who one day,
while showing me some photographs of statues on one of the
portals of Chartres, exclaimed: “What psychologists these
sculptors!” In fact, one does not exclude the other; many
essences can be united in a single concrete entity.
! 118!
is attributable to its discovery of a middle way between
these extreme dangers. Its exponents knew how to create
human types of an unsurpassable plastic perfection while
giving the impression that they were working from nature,
as though in reality Apollo and Venus had been their
models. Greek statuary has been much imitated; to this
very day it still represents to the great majority classic art
par excellence, and rightly so, for it found the secret of
producing statues in which likeness, reduced to the role of
being the simple material of the work despite its extreme
perfection, is completely dominated by plastic form. The
spectator, blind to art, enjoys the pleasure of believing that
he responds to it because he takes the beauty of statuary
for that of nature, which the statue imitates, by leading it
to its perfection. The triumph of Greek art rests, to a
certain degree, upon the most felicitous of
misunderstandings.
Starting from the pinnacle, only a decline was possible,
but when a decline begins from so great a height it can go
on for a long time without sinking into mediocrity.
Innumerable statues are dedicated to propaganda of all
sorts. That they often pursue ends that are not specifically
artistic does not prevent them from being works of art, at
times even of the highest quality. Let us discard the mass
of kitsch that encumbers the churches or claims to adorn
public places. Taking into consideration only statues in
which artistry is dominant, we will have to recognize that
art is not the only element involved. The statue of a god, a
saint, or hero belongs to statuary proper in the degree to
which the creation of a plastic form has known how to

! 119!
utilize as material, in addition to the natural forms imitated
by the artist, the religious or patriotic emotion associated
with the memory of the personage whom the work
intends to represent. In such cases (the Pietà in St. Peter’s,
the Moses in the church of St. Peter-in-Chains, the Colleoni
equestrian statue in Venice) the formative power of the art
so visibly dominates the material (marble or bronze in the
body imitated, the scene depicted, the emotions evoked)
that no doubt is possible; art is so manifestly the dominant
factor here that we ask ourselves whether religion and
patriotism are still involved. It is very difficult to be stirred
by the image of Jesus Christ when we stand before
Michelangelo’s Pietà. The esthetic emotion occupies too
much place to leave much more for the religious feeling,
unless the very opposite occurs and a Christian heart is so
moved at the very remembrance of the Passion of Christ
that it no longer is concerned with the masterpiece.
The religious feeling in that case plays a role similar to
that of natural beauty in other works; the emotion which it
engenders is taken for esthetic enjoyment of the beauty of
art. And this is all to the good, for while the art-lover
enjoys the work of art in his own way, the faithful enjoys it
in his, and no doubt most people find in it this mixed, but
often intense, gratification of a sensibility divided between
its religious faith and admiration for the sculptured
masterpiece which places the object before him. There is
no measuring instrument to determine the proportions of
such mixtures. A phenomenology of esthetic experience
would perhaps find in it material for many interesting
observations, for it would seem that statuary, having little

! 120!
confidence in its power to hold the attention of men by
itself, sought in subjects of all kinds something with which
to ensure itself an emotional involvement on the part of
the spectator which plastic beauty hardly has the right to
hope for. Here again misunderstanding reigns, but it is the
soil from which the art of the beautiful bursts forth now
and then in its pure or nearly pure form.
The artist comes up against this problem only from
the point of view of his poietic activity; he alone knows
what he would like to do, what he is permitted to do in the
concrete conditions in which his art is brought to bear—in
short, what he can in fact realize of that which he desires
to accomplish. This explains why some masterpieces are
still but compromises between the demands of art and
those of the causes that an artist must serve in order to
ensure his livelihood. The artist cannot live on
commissions rejected by those who assign them to him
and who pay for them. But here the poietics of sculpture
is without resources; being philosophy, it has no direct
bearing on any particular case.

! 121!
FOUR
Painting

UPON APPROACHING the subject of painting the


reflective mind immediately senses the haunting presence
of the notion of another art, poetry. Ut pictura poesis :
poetry is like painting and, inversely, painting is a kind of
poetry. It would be easy to compile a book of writings
devoted to this subject; indeed a whole series of books
would be necessary were we to add to such a compilation
writings whose authors labored hard to compare the
dignity of these two arts.
To the degree in which considerations of this kind cite
Horace as an authority, which they do all too frequently,
they are just so many commentaries on a
misinterpretation. Let us say, rather, that they comment
on three words whose meaning it is impossible to
misunderstand when read in their context. In this passage
of the Epistle to the Pisos Horace perceptively remarks that
poetry is akin to painting. As is the case with some
paintings, some poems should be read from close up,
whereas others are best appreciated from afar; some court
the shade, others endure scrutiny in full light unfearful of
the demands of the most penetrating criticism. Setting

! 122!
aside Horace’s personal preference for this second kind of
poetry (and of painting) the fact remains that his verses do
not authorize any assimilation between the ends of
painting and those of poetry, nor vice versa:
Ut pictura poesis. Erit quae, si prop ius stes,
Te caPiat magis, et quaedam, si longius abstes;
Haec amat obscuram, volet haec sub luce videri,
]udici argutum quae nom formidat acumen;
Haec Placuitsemel, haec deciens repetita placebit.
Therefore this precedent can be ignored; it is wholly
imaginary, but it is impossible not to take into account
what these three words by Horace have suggested to the
imagination of critics and philosophers. We come upon
the doctrine in its perfect form in the Réflexions critiques sur
la poésie et sur la peinture by Abbé du Bos, one of the forty
“Immortals” and permanent secretary of the French
Academy. The seventh edition is dated Paris, 1770. The
success of this work dearly shows that, in matters of taste,
it was in keeping with the aspirations of the age. In any
case, the Abbé’s doctrine is exemplary in that it compiles
and arranges ideas which in fact conjure up each other and
which a logical mind refuses to disassociate.
Let us first of all note that painting and poetry are here
treated jointly as two arts which, though using different
means of expression, have the same end in view.
The stand taken by du Bos can be traced back to the
following principles: poetry and painting aim at stirring the
emotions of the spectator and pleasing him; the principal
means of being pleasing which they have in common is

! 123!
the imitations of objects naturally capable of stirring
human emotions and of being pleasing. Above all it is
important never to in a poem or in a picture that are not
by nature interesting. “The imitation would not be able to
move us if the object itself is incapable of doing so.”
Hence the conclusion common to the two arts: “Poetry is
akin to painting and the imitations that poetry makes of
nature stir us only in proportion to the impression that the
object imitated itself would make on us.”
The consequences of this perfect poietic art of
painting as a pure intellectual pictures it to himself
becomes apparent in the judgments on taste which it
inspires, or better put, which are deduced from it. First of
all, art is declared incapable of matching nature in the
power to please the human eye and to stir human
emotions. Quintillian gives the reason for this in his
famous treatise on the training of an orator. Quidquid alteri
simile est, necesse est minus sit, eo quod imitatur (X, 2). Indeed, if
works of art are homogeneous to those of nature, being of
the same order but consecutive to the former, they are
necessarily inferior to them. Secondly, since their efficacy
depends upon the interest inspired by their models, it is
the personal interest that we entertain for their models
that becomes the rule of our judgments. Thus, in
agreement with Louis XIV and almost all his
contemporaries, Abbé du Bos set a very low value on the
art of the minor Dutch masters, such as Teniers and
Wouvermans, whose work could not affect us very much
because “there is nothing in the celebration of a village
feast or in the coarse pastimes of a group of foot guards
! 124!
that could stir our emotions.” Communist criticism in our
day would condemn a favorable portrayal of bourgeois
manners exactly for the same reason. In both cases the
judge would say with Abbé du Bos: “We praise the art of
the painter for his excellent imitation, but we must
reproach him for having chosen as the object of his work
subjects which have such little interest for us.”
A final consequence of this primacy of the imitation of
natural beauty is the essential superiority of so-called
history painting in which the human figure always
occupies an important place and often the first, over
landscape painting. Indeed, we do not speak with trees;
they say nothing, nor do they express any feelings,
emotions or thoughts. “The most beautiful landscape,
even if painted by Titian or Carracci, would not interest us
any more than the sight of a dreadful or delightful country
district: there is nothing in such a picture that talks to us,
so to speak, and since it scarcely affects us, it does not
hold our attention very much.” Abbé du Bos must be
given credit for his consistency and logic. He does not
deny that the artist’s achievement can interest us, but he
contends that “imitation never makes an impression on us
greater than the imitated object would be able to make.”
Moreover, he has a criterion for the appreciation of a
beautiful painting: the time spent by the spectator in
looking at it; and since this time is proportional to the
reflections which the subject suggests, assuming an
equality of artistry, we would tarry less before the
landscape of a picture by Poussin than before the
personages whom he has placed in it, and less before a

! 125!
representation of a basket of flowers than before one of
the Seven Sacraments.
This view of art prevailed in the history of French
painting, as well as in that of some other countries,
practically up to the beginning of the nineteenth century.
In the name of these principles a painter as accomplished
as Chardin was for a long time considered to be a
second-rate artist. There is no assurance that this
philosophy of art is dead in all minds, but few understand
the error upon which it rests. Starting out from the
primacy of natural beauty which dominates it, it
necessarily follows that the painted image imitating it
cannot have a greater value than the model from which is
draws its substance. Hence the fidelity of painting in its
imitation of natural beauty is the measure of its beauty.
It is impossible to introduce more coherence in this
confusion, for everything here is bound up with the initial
error which by substituting natural beauty for artistic
beauty fatally condemns the artist to the role of being the
more or less faithful imitator of a ready-made model
which nature suggests to him. This initial error involves
him in numberless complications which are all the more
superfluous because they are without object. It is this
notion that makes him despair of ever being able to match
nature and gives him the impression of a failure which he
really has not undergone. In fact, it is quite natural that he
should not succeed in this enterprise because art’s
essential purpose is not the imitation of nature. The
matter of ascertaining whether or not natural beauty
surpasses artistic beauty is not in question here, for they

! 126!
cannot be compared; what is important is that the beauty
which the artist pursues, such as he can produce with the
means available to his art, is something specifically
different from that which nature produces with her own.
The nature of this difference is made very clear by an
experience familiar to all of us. After walking through
endlessly long galleries and enormous rooms filled with
masterpieces of the art of painting, our gaze suddenly falls
upon a young couple making a tour of the same museum.
Our hearts are stirred by a very strange emotion: a feeling
that our musings have been disturbed mingles with a
feeling of relief as when we arrive unexpectedly at the end
of a search unaware of its real aim. Living creatures, at last!
In this instant of clairvoyance granted by chance, who
would not give all the painted beauties in the museum’s
collection for the beauty of these two real faces where
nature seems effortlessly to have found what so many
artists have vainly pursued? But this is an illusion, far
nature is as incapable of producing a painting by herself as
the painter is of creating a living being with colors and
brushes. If the work of the painter should come to life like
Pygmalion’s, it would constitute a total defeat of his art,
far it was hardly necessary for him to bring into the world
the living beings surrounding him. To console himself far
a nonexistent failure, the artist thereupon embarks an the
pursuit of an “ideal beauty” destined to remain
inaccessible to him, since in order to bring it into being he
would have to effect the contradictory synthesis of natural
and artistic beauty. It can be called contradictory not
because the one is opposed to the other or because the

! 127!
beauty of art cannot fruitfully be inspired by that of
nature, but far a much deeper reason: in the last analysis it
is a question of two orders which can only subsist if each
respects the specificity of the other. Among the
proliferating bastard arts the art of make-up makes it quite
clear that by dint of painting a face we cannot make a
natural beauty of it, but neither can we create a
masterpiece of the art of painting unless, of course, [we]
confuse painting and daubing.1
The irrepressible vitality of the doctrine of art as
imitation is attributable precisely to the fact that it
occupies two terrains at once and, by seeking refuge
according to the situation in one or the other, it seems to
justify the espousal of an order of factivity which could
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
1 As far as I know
only Baudelaire has treated the subject
seriously, “In praise of make-up”, in Curiosités esthétiques, XVI, 11
(Paris: Pléiade), pp. 911-914. Note, by the way, the poet’s
remarks on fashion (pp. 912-913); on the specificity of the end of
make-up, p. 913 (woman fulfills a kind of duty “in applying
herself to appearing magical and supernatural. . . an idol, she
must adorn herself in order to be adored”); and above all the
remark following (p. 913): “Thus, if I have well understood, the
painting of the face must not be employed for the vulgar,
unconfessable purpose of imitating beautiful nature and of
competing with youth.” “Who would dare to assign to art the
sterile function of imitating nature?” (p. 914). Baudelaire is very
right to disdain those who would judge him to be unduly grave
on such a subject. Truth with respect to art depends entirely on
each of the particular truths that refer to it. Paul Vuillard, in his
décors for the Théâtre des Champs-Elysées (Le maquillage), has well
illustrated the magic feeling of the operation.
! 128!
compete with it for the reason that it would also be the
order of natural fecundity. The awareness that there is
something incongruous about this position becomes
apparent in the attempt, the reverse of the previous one,
to exploit art’s presumed self-styled power “to embellish
nature”. This is the same illusion but in an opposite sense,
for the painter can neither embellish nor disfigure nature
for the simple reason that he does not produce nature but
paintings. The most beautiful of painted nudes will always
arouse misgivings in the mind of an anatomist. 2 The
possibility of cooperation between the two orders
presupposes the respect for their specific distinction. If we
were to proceed here from the philosophy of art to
esthetics the same remark would apply to the respect that
must be accorded to the necessary distinction between the
two orders in the principles that should preside when
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
2 We know what
liberties Ingres took with anatomy: added
vertebrae, disproportion of members, etc. No one, however, has
preached more convincingly on the duty of following the model,
and along with it, nature. But he was more subtle than that: “The
ancients never corrected their models,” he said; but he added,
“by that I mean that they did not denaturalize them.” That’s a
difficult margin to measure. “The principle and the most
important part of painting is to know what nature has produced
that is most beautiful and most fitting to this art, in order to
make a choice following the taste and the manner of feeling of
the ancients.” And further: “One is always beautiful when one is
true.” But true in relation to what? To given reality, or to the
choice exercised according to “the manner of feeling of the
ancients”? And which ancients? And, if the manner of feeling of
the Greeks, of which Greeks?
! 129!
pronouncing judgments upon a painter’s work. What
mishaps occur in both directions! All the cosmetics of the
world will never do more than postpone the moment in
which the most beautiful of real faces will have to fall back
on its natural beauty exclusively, in regard to which the
beauty of art is an illusion, though real in its own order.
The only honorable way out of this confusion is to
return to the true principle, that is to say to the very
essence of the art of painting such as it is in itself. By this
we understand that essential element without which
painting as one of the fine arts is not possible, neither
more nor less. If other determinations can be added to it
they will not be , excluded if they qualify this art as one of
the possible modes of painting, and do not constitute it as
such.
Reduced to this essential, a picture is a solid surface
which the artist covers with colored forms whose
arrangement is pleasing to the eye through the unity of the
form, the harmony of the parts and the perfection of the
execution.
The art of painting therefore produces material objects
located in space like the creations of statuary; but even
though the painted wall, the painted wooden panel and
even, in a sense, the painted canvas are solid, painting is
concerned only with their surface. Painting does not even
capture the surface save to the extent that it is visible, so
that pictures, precisely as works of art, offer themselves to
view in space as objects endowed only with the
dimensions of length and breadth, but without depth.
Pictures, being inorganic bodies, are immovable like

! 130!
statues. Practically speaking, they are two-dimensional
solids. The achievements of modern technology have
made this truth clearly evident. The currently practiced
technique of recanvasing a picture shows to what extent
the substance of a painting can be reduced to a thin film
of pigments. When a painter represents tri-dimensional
solids on a two-dimensional space, he embarks on a path
wholly different from that of the sculptor. Convention
plays an initial role in it as a foregone conclusion. As in
the theatre where it is understood in advance that nothing
that transpires on the stage is real, any normal viewer of a
painting will unquestionably grant that the artist has no
intention of letting him take the image of a man for a man.
In this sense the trompe l’oeil represents an exception, but it
rarely aims at producing a complete illusion which, even if
it is successful, hardly lasts.
Painting is abstract by nature, for it abstracts from one
of the dimensions of our space; and in another aspect it is
inevitably conventional in the sense that, if its aim is
imitation, only lines, curves and colors are at its disposal
for the representation of solids. Either it must apply itself
to illusionism to create the impression of depth—
necessarily absent—through relief and perspective, or
deliberately practice a painting that is indifferent to the
third dimension and freely reduces volumes to surfaces. It
is only very recently, that is to say with the advent of
so-called abstract (non- representational) art, that we have
seen the appearance of pictures which, by going beyond
mere decoration, claimed to be what any painting
essentially is. Maurice Denis, who never practiced abstract

! 131!
art and who did not even know of its existence at that
time, correctly defined it when he came up with his now
famous definition of a picture: a plane surface covered
with colors arranged in a certain order. A picture exists
from the moment these simple conditions are fulfilled. If
Maurice Denis was right, painting by definition is abstract
and not representational. What is even more remarkable
about painting is that like sculpture it has almost always
been representational. The origins of this art are lost in the
mists of time. Its date is of little importance; when we
speak of fifteen thousand years before our era, a few
millennia more or less do not make much difference. On
the other hand, one fact should hold our attention:
whatever the date may be when painting was first
produced, those who have left us the most ancient
attestations of the art confront us with an art that is
already fully established. Its representational character is
already evident. Painting, like sculpture, was born of
imitation, perhaps even more obviously. Moreover, these
painters or other artists were also sculptors. The admirable
bisons of Altamira, and of the grotto of Font de Gaume,
and those of the Lascaux caverns in particular confirm the
existence in these remote times of painters who could
draw stylized animal forms, compose groups and paint
them with the aid of simple but lasting colors, and arrange
them on broad surfaces whose irregularities, curves and
planes they knew how to put to good advantage by
making them serve the ends of their art. A frieze of deer,
with antlers erect, who seem to be emerging from a stream
or a lake, one behind the other; a horse depicted falling

! 132!
into a hole because a real hole is there and suggests the
image of a fall. After them, it is hard to see what there
remained to invent in the art of representing solid forms
on a plane surface by means of lines and colors arranged
in a certain order.
As far as is known, given the present state of our
knowledge of prehistory, no art of painting has ever
existed without imitation. Indeed, it would appear that
man imitated before writing, for writing does not figure in
these grottoes except in the form of elementary symbolic
signs of whose meaning we are not certain, and the
immense variety of painted forms at that time by far
exceeds the number of signs known to us. But this is not
the most surprising feature. What is particularly striking is
the fact that by inventing an immovable art, exactly in the
same sense as sculpture, these first artists were already
obsessed with a desire to represent the appearances of
movement. The deer of the Lascaux caverns gallop; the
horses walk, trot or jump; the cows and bulls assume
varied poses and move in many ways. To suggest solids in
motion by means of immovable spots was a doubly
paradoxical enterprise. We cannot go into finer detail here
on these facts which are outside a philosopher’s sphere of
competence but we must add this supplementary question:
why did these men, already masters of the art of stylizing
animal forms, who drew bisons worthy of the greatest
Chinese painting, seem to be indifferent to the human
form, or unable to draw it? The human beings in these
paintings resemble the crudely drawn figures produced by
children: a tube surmounted by a ball and flanked by two

! 133!
lines at the end of which shorter ones protrude. We
cannot help but wonder about the plastic poverty of this
human form, the exploitation of whose formal
possibilities required the advent of Greek genius.
Reflection upon these facts can lead only to the
conclusion that, from the beginning, man the artist
proceeded as though he had read Ingres. He chanced
upon art in imitation itself: in the construction of a figure,
he did not “proceed piecemeal” but “drew the whole”.
Finally, in the same spirit with which he first grasped the
whole, he already dealt with the “breadth of form and
breadth of form again”, for in Ingres’ own words form “is
the foundation and the condition of all things”. The
painter of the black bull in the Lascaux caverns already
presented it in a full run; indeed Ingres himself who was
so primitive in his own fashion might have painted it. On
one occasion he voiced the deep meaning of this wholly
spontaneous decision on the part of the artist: “When
sketching a figure, apply yourself above all to determining
and fully characterizing its movement. I can’t stress too
much to you that movement is life.”
Indeed nothing interests man as much as life and the
movement which is a sign of it, or resembles it. Let our
gaze roam over a vast plain and the least thing that stirs in
the landscape makes us fix our eyes upon it. Animals
perceive the surrounding world in the same way. Here
again we are face to face with a prime fact, beyond which
we cannot go. From it we must deduce that painting, like I
sculpture, works on a two-fold material substance
constituted by the canvas with pigments of which pictures

! 134!
consist, and on the ensemble of natural forms which it
submits to the artistic form born of imagination. Whether
directly or indirectly borrowed, whether from the organic
or inorganic world, all the lines and forms employed by
the painter derive from natural objects and beings. Among
I the latter, living beings hold his attention first and
foremost. At least it would seem that such was the case
with the artists who decorated the grottoes of Vézère and
elsewhere. Their paintings are the creations of hunters,
like all the paintings since then which have been inspired
by that pre-eminent hunter, Eros, the god of desire and of
love.
Of this two-fold material substance, that from which
the artist extracts the very substance of his art is
inseparable from the technique of art about which the
philosopher has no experience and consequently knows
nothing. Like everybody else he knows that this matter,
through its natural forms, exercises a determining
influence on what the finished work will be. A drawing
will have a beauty all its own, which is not that of an
engraving or of an oil; a painting will also have its own
beauty, though the beauty of an oil painting will not be
that of a fresco.
Thus each work will find itself classified in a genre, in
a family or in a definite species among which all possible
varieties are to be found, including highly individual
creations, depending upon whether the draughtsman uses
this or that charcoal or pencil, and treats his pastel in this
or that manner which can be personal to him. For in the
last analysis every artist is a distinct person and his means

! 135!
of expression belongs to the world of nature in which
everything that exists is particularized.
The material of the painted work differs from that of
the statue by virtue of a remarkable characteristic. In
painting, the material of the work of art is itself a human
creation.3 The sculptor must choose the piece of wood or
the block of marble upon which he intends to work;
certainly in making this choice he thinks of the form that
he plans to impart to it but he does not produce the
material of the future statue, contenting himself with
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
3 In consideration
of the “formal vocation of material
substances,” demonstrated by Henri Focillon, the invention of
new pictorial material, like that of oil color by the same token,
opens a new era in the order of formal invention. This platitude
in the history of art is recalled here only for its principle. If styles
are closely related to techniques, the history of techniques
presides over that of styles. At a certain level, these notions are
confused with each other. The philosopher, however, cannot fail
to observe that the painted work has progressively escaped from
the initial plenary authority of the painter in the measure that the
fabrication of color escaped him. In the beginning it was almost
the whole of art. We owe to the enigmatic monk Théophile
(eleventh century A.D.) a Diversarum artium schedula in which the
manner of mixing and applying colors according to the subject to
be represented occupies the foreground. See the Traité des divers
arts (Paris: Emile-Paul, 1924), particularly Book 1. Let us note in
passing that this very rare bird, a theoretician of the arts of the
beautiful in the Middle Ages, gave himself the pleasure in his
Prologue to the First Book (the beginning) of outlining a
theology of art. A Greek source seems to have been at the origin
of the work.
! 136!
taking it just as nature offers it to him. Even terra-cotta
and bronze, which are artificially fabricated materials, were
not first made with artistic ends in view. The artist may
use the techniques of iron and copper but he utilizes them
pretty much as though they were materials that would be
offered to him by nature whose ingenuity in this respect
he does not find essentially distinguishable. Artistic
creation begins earlier in painting, for although the colors
used by paleolithic painters seem to have been simple
natural oxides or charcoals, those used by their successors
had first of all to be deliberately produced with future
coloring and painting operations in view. At the beginning
of modern painting, the substitution of the fresco by the
oil, and that of mineral colors by vegetable colors, placed
at the artist’s disposal a whole range of new materials
expressly conceived and produced with an eye to his
specific purposes. At the present time the oils, gouaches,
and pigments of all kinds, not to mention the glosses,
lacquers and other products equally necessary to the
painter, as well as those required by the art of engraving
and of drawing, are furnished by specialized industries at
the service of these different arts. This is even true of
colors, for the separate preparation of the three
fundamental colors, red, blue and yellow, such as the
painter needs to find in their pure state so that he can
proceed, if he so desires, to the preparation of
fragmentized tones, is itself the object of an industry
expressly created to service the art of painting. In painting,
even the material of the work of art is an effect of art.

! 137!
The notion of form4 common to all the arts assumes
its prime and proper meaning, which is that of visible
form, when it is applied to painting. There it belongs to
drawing which many consider as a distinct, self-sufficient
and definable art in itself. This is a legitimate approach
which it would not be difficult to justify, or at least uphold
with sound arguments, for the domain of drawing goes
beyond that of painting in all respects. There is line
drawing, architectural drawing, sculptural drawing; in
short, there is drawing whenever the representation of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
4 The excesses to
which the notion of “form” lent itself
formerly in the interpretation of nature has afforded much
amusement; it is just as comical to see fine minds, who intend no
malice, riddle it with their sarcasms, as though they were
Descartes or one of his contemporaries. “Doubtlessly Claudel
has become a prisoner of of the scholastic notion of form as many
passages of his works will show,” recently wrote an excellent
literary critic. The notion of form, which goes back to Plato and
Aristotle, is a common patrimony of Western thought. It was
wrong to take the word for an explanation, but what it signifies is
a reality to be explained, and in this sense it has become evident
to all minds still in our day. Andre Saint-Lague writes Le monde des
formes; Henri Focillon writes La vie des formes, not without correctly
specifying that those about which he speaks are not those of
scholasticism (and he believes it); modern psychology becomes
Gestaltpsychologie; in short, no one dreams of avoiding an inevitable
notion closely related to the notion of being and of thing of
which it defines the constitutive law. In any case, if he was ever a
prisoner of the notion of form, the author of L’oeil écoute is rather
comfortably ensconced in his prison, so that we may have no fear
of being imprisoned there along with him.
! 138!
some object is involved through the imitation of its visible
appearance by means of lines. But the role of drawing in
what are called “the arts of design”, namely architecture,
sculpture, painting and their derivates, is merely that of a
means which is not always indispensable and which can
even be harmful in these arts. At times we deceive
ourselves about the role drawing plays in them because we
fail to examine it in itself. In philosophical terminology “in
itself”, of course, will be understood to mean in its essence
and in its concept.
When concepts are in question we must always take
recourse to Socrates’ method which on the whole was
taken over by Aristotle. What do we mean here when we
say drawing? Chateau briand, whom nothing daunted, gives
a fairly good idea of it in that passage of the Génie du
Christianisme where he describes both its nature and its
invention (III,1,3). “A young girl, perceiving the shadow
of her lover on the wall, drew the contours of this
shadow.” Happy lover, happy young girl, happy
Chateaubriand who seemingly did not himself try this
operation which is not as simple as he thought! All we
should retain of this fantasy is the seemingly natural bond
which associates in the mind the notion of drawing with
that of contour. Drawing is the delineation of figures, of
contours, and the “contour” itself is “that which marks
the circumference of something”. Now the circumference
of any object, even in connection with the contour of a
solid, say a column or an edifice, can be marked only if we
trace it by means of a line. The latter does not exist in the
solid of which it is the delineation, but rather it results

! 139!
from the act of the mind abstracting from the material
mass one of the ideal limits which, by determining its
form, defines it. This is why drawing is rightly described as
the act of tracing the contours of a figure. Where this act
is sufficient unto itself it constitutes a distinct art, drawing.
Thus viewed, drawing, taken in itself, is necessarily
imitation, for tracing the contour of an object is
tantamount to imitating the appearance of this object. At
the same time, it is creation because the contour of the
object to which the draughtsman limits himself is not a
datum of reality. There are no drawings in nature and this
is why every time some are discovered after millennia on
the walls of an unexplored grotto, the inference is
immediately drawn that men once lived there in the dim
past. Like any art drawing is not a natural but a human
fact. It must be added that the act of creating an outline by
drawing it is not limited to the faithful reproduction of the
outer limit of a natural form. The mind intervenes directly
in the operation so that the outline can be made in such a
way as will be pleasing to the eye. At least this is what
happens when the hand spontaneously defers to the
mind’s suggestions. Ingres, whose memory hovers like a
ghost over every discussion of drawing, constantly
counselled the imitation of nature: “One is always
beautiful when one is true,” he said. But he was not
aiming so much at literal truth as at that of the perfect
form of which the live model is like a sketch. Every real
form attests to an ideal form which it more or less
resembles, the idea of which, however, it never perfectly
actualizes. “Health must be imparted to form,” Ingres said

! 140!
further. Drawing in this case becomes the medium of a
plastic creation and one of the arts of the beautiful.
We must pause a moment here for this seemingly
simple determination in reality assumes that we have just
made a crucial choice. Drawing may belong to the fine
arts, but not necessarily so. For there is another manner of
drawing which consists of observing the object in order to
reproduce it exactly as it is, that is to say as it naturally
offers itself to the eye. Thus conceived, drawing is the
expression of a cognition: therefore it belongs to the order
of language and no doubt constitutes the most direct
manner of signifying reality since it depicts it just as it
appears. Thus we enter into the order of the true, which is
a distinct order of that of the beautiful and where fidelity
to the object becomes the rule of the act whose end is
likeness. A moment’s reflection suffices to see that the
most exact drawing is not necessarily the most beautiful,
but it is assuredly the most true because it is the most
faithful reproduction of the object that it portrays. In such
a case the eye must limit itself strictly to observation, and
the hand must retrace exactly what the eye sees. Here the
danger to be avoided and overcome if it arises is the
inevitable temptation to neglect some aspects of the object
and to modify others in order to “impart health to form”,
which is the beginning of art. We are in the realm of
observation and of the mind’s effort to describe it. In
short, we are in the order of signification in which drawing
is irreplacable, for all the descriptive talent of a Buffon
would not suffice to give us the precise idea of “the most
noble conquest of man”, whereas prehistoric drawings

! 141!
suffice to put troops of horses under our eyes.
In practice it is impossible to avoid mixing the uses
that are made of a same technique having distinct ends in
view. Audubon’s animals (when their models existed) 5
were portraits as much as documents, and when Ingres
asserts that he scrupulously observes the human body, he
is telling the truth, but this does not prevent him from
giving a member the length, and a body the number of
vertebrae that either must have so that the drawing may be
beautiful. Thus cognition will often be blended with art,
but the artist will always make artistic use of it, and it is
precisely this that earns him the censure of the spectator
who is more oriented toward truth than toward beauty.
Once again, by reflecting upon the essence of these two
acts, we can conclude that the opposition between the
ends pursued discloses the presence of two specifically
different activities. It may be useful to stress this
distinction of essences through that of names, reserving
that of imagery for the technique of drawing whose
principle object is to reproduce as faithfully as possible the
outer appearance of a form exactly observed. As a
technique integrated with the fine arts, drawing has no
other destination save beauty. To the extent that its object
is to produce an image, drawing can certainly achieve the
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
5 Audubon, an
excellent observer and meticulous
draughtsman (he was a pupil of David), at least once amused
himself by describing and drawing a North American quadruped
which everybody generally agrees existed only in his own
imagination: the revenge that invention takes on the discipline of
observation and that art takes on knowledge.
! 142!
perfection proper to imagery, but plastic beauty is not
necessary to the perfection of this order. Without being at
all paradoxical, we could say that it is always indifferent to
it and in some cases actually excludes it.
The specific distinction between artistic drawing and
imagery can easily be discerned if we take the latter as a
.term of comparison. Photographs are perfect images by
definition. Provided that the negative and the proof are
good, the object that a photograph represents is
represented as well as is possible. This is why good
photographs are the most satisfying documents in all
spheres, whether in the sciences, history or the fine arts.
No other kind of image is more informative, no verbal
description, no artistic reconstitution of the event or of
the object which they represent can match them as regards
objective information. But precisely such images belong in
the category of information, which is the transmission of
knowledge. Thus there can be imagery without the art of
drawing or of painting. Now it remains to be seen whether
the art of drawing or of painting can exist without
imagery.
It can be said that today the question has been decided
by facts. The advent of non-figurative painting, still of
recent date, no longer permits doubt regarding the
possibility of imageless drawing and painting. The
existence of both should be enough to put an end to the
debate. But it continues no less because many confuse the
question of determining whether an art of drawing
without imagery is possible with the wholly different
question of determining whether it pleases them. It is

! 143!
legitimate to think all the bad things one wants to about
abstract art, and to say so, but after all is said and done the
fact remains that this art has been conceived, realized,
savored and preferred to that which is called “museum
art” by a considerable public which at times goes so far as
to refuse to recognize any art other than abstract art as
worthy of being called painting. All the pejorative
explanations of this phenomenon, such as the decadence
of art and taste, snobism, the mercantilism of some
intermediaries between the artist and the public, are
tenable and in part justified, but causative factors of this
kind are found at the birth of all artistic modes, good or
bad. None of them suffices to explain why in the case in
question these influences favored precisely a form of art
which, paradoxical1y, was far removed from the public
taste, especially in its beginnings.
Upon closer examination we see that the crisis was
latent at least since the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries
in the form of a basic conflict between drawing and color
painting. In the eighteenth century, Abbé du Bos, whose
perspicacity often went far beyond the prejudices of his
time, was already of the opinion that the debate could not
lead to any conclusive decision. Some people, he
observed, favored drawing, others preferred color, and no
reasoning could prove that one group or the other was
right. Should Titian be preferred to Poussin? Each one is
free to make his choice, but the choice itself is inevitable.
At the time he wrote these words, du Bos could not
foresee to what point the future quarrel between Ingres
and Delacroix would one day prove him right.

! 144!
Let us try to see why this choice is ineluctable. Those
who discuss drawing and painting as dialecticians
sometimes raise the objection that there is a simple answer
to the problem: all the artist has to do is to balance the
two tendencies, thereby sacrificing neither color nor
drawing. But this is merely verbiage. Actually, all the arts
are based on the aptitude of certain classes of sensible
qualities to move our sensibility or, if preferred, on that of
our sensibility to be touched by them. Those whom
sounds leave indifferent never show an interest in music,
and the same remark applies to colors: those who are not
affected by the simple perception of a pure color will
never take pleasure in any combination of colors. Now
individual sensibilities to color vary. 6 A person whose
mind is primarily speculative cannot live in the company
of painters, or even read the writings produced by some of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
6 By way of example,
Baudelaire’s predilection for violet. In
it he saw (as we see in it in fact) its two component colors, red
and blue fused as a qualitative unity of a new color. By itself,
violet evoked in his imagination many moving ideas: “Of violet
color (contained, mysterious, veiled love, color of a canoness).”
A canoness whose blue stilI affords the glimpse of glowing
embers. The mere perception of this color kindled a very general
notion in him: “I have found the definition of the Beautiful—of
my beautiful. It is something fiery and sad, something somewhat
vague, leaving scope to conjecture.” One could show how this
elementary reaction to a color is related in him to his ideal of
feminine beauty, to his predilection for the art of Delacroix, etc.
But the origin of all is the spontaneous harmony between a
definite sensibility and a sensible quality. For many, violet, as
some dictionaries say, is the color of the violet.
! 145!
them, without confirming how his own sensibility to
chromatic sensations and shading is inferior to theirs.
Whoever has a “painter’s eye”, especially if he is a colorist,
constantly experiences pleasure and pain—sometimes to
an intense degree—at the mere sight of the colored
objects around him, whereas the ordinary mortal watches
this spectacle without really noting it. Thus it is easily
understandable that some experience a keen pleasure at
the sight of pictures deliberately calculated to give the eye
the kind of pleasures it prefers. We cannot blame those
who do not experience this for expressing their
disapproval of a painting of this kind. In order to give
them a reasoned doubt, the most we can ask them is
whether they do not judge these combinations of color
arranged in a certain order on a plane surface somewhat
like a deaf person would judge a musical work whose
effects he can neither perceive nor imagine. There is in
fact a blindness to the nuances of color just as there is a
deafness to the nuances of sound. This kind of blindness,
like the other, is in no way shameful. But those who are
afflicted with it ought to be aware of it and not base the
validation of their judgments upon it.
Here we come to the crucial point: why does it seem
as though a perfect balance between drawing and color
would be, if not impossible, at least always precarious and
tending to disruption? The answer involves the very object
of the art of painting, for it is very far from requiring that
all painters conceive the object in the same way, or that all
agree that this object is painting. For the great majority of
those engaged in painting, or those who view it, the

! 146!
important thing is not to arrange colors on a canvas in a
certain order but to arrange these colors by surrounding
them with lines in such a way so that they represent an
historical scene, a familiar event, a known person, or
merely a recognizable object. Color in that case serves to
perfect the resemblance already assured by the drawing
which represents the object. Very few people are endowed
with a sensibility so refined that the mere sight of a simple
harmony of tones is a source of pleasure to them. Hence
they and the painters who appeal to their taste seek
support in the wholly different pleasure of recognizing
represented objects and of deciphering the meaning of the
pictorial scene. We pass then from the order of pure
painting to that of imitation, representation and
signification. In this order the artist uses his technique as a
language with which he speaks to the spectator. This
wholly special language is not composed of arbitrary and
abstract signs, and bears no necessary relation to the
objects which they signify; on the contrary it is this which
confers a superiority upon it which painters frequently
have claimed for their art over that of the poet, because
painting puts the spectator directly in front of an object as
real in itself as objects of nature. When the poet says
“bird”, those who do not know the language in which he
writes will not know what he is talking about. But the
painter simply paints a bird of any kind on the wall and
everybody understands. By directly representing the
appearance of visible reality, the painter uses a language
composed of natural signs intelligible to all.
The sole condition required for effecting this kind of

! 147!
communication is that the spectator must already know
the meaning of the signs that are being used, that is to say,
he must already know what the painter is representing.
This is why so many painters choose their subjects from
historical events that are known to a broad public, such as
those taken from religious or natural history. As the
memory of these events fades, the images representing the
chosen episodes lose their meaning, which it then
behooves scholarship and iconography to restore to them.
When painters worked for a learned élite steeped in the
classics, the mythology and the history of ancient peoples
were the inexhaustible reservoirs of the “subjects” of
paintings; nowadays most of the subjects of this kind have
no meaning for the great majority of spectators unless
they are explained. But why go so far back? Who among
us, without being informed beforehand, would understand
that one of the first canvases painted by Degas depicts the
queen Semiramis supervising the construction of the
ramparts of Nineveh? Having never seen Semiramis or the
ramparts of Nineveh, we would be unable to surmise this.
But neither had Degas seen them.
On the other hand, once we are alerted the nature of
the problem undergoes a change. The painter in that case
communicates to us information concerning a possible
scene, representing an event that is at least believable, and
the “meaning” of his picture consists in furnishing us with
the necessary elements so that we may be able to picture it
to ourselves. From this moment, the spectator’s role is to
“understand” the picture, that is to say, to interpret the
whole and relate the details to the subject which the work

! 148!
represents. The principal accomplishment of the painter in
that case becomes what formerly was called “poetic
composition”, understanding by that the choice and the
arrangement of personages and objects to the extent that
they contribute to the good representation of the subject
chosen. Everything counts for those who espouse this
conception of painting: the choice of figures, their
attitudes, their facial expressions—differing in accordance
with the nature of the emotions or feelings which they are
supposed to be experiencing—as well as the characteristic
costumes of their time, and of their people. In short it
involves both expression and local color. It is no longer
enough to be able to identify Jesus, St. John and Judas, in
the representation of the Last Supper; far too many
conventional signs easily permit us to guess; we must still
be able to explain why each personage expresses the
particular emotion depicted on his face, why such an
object is painted in a certain style. The critics in such cases
never fail to do for the painter what they have done a
thousand times for Corneille and for Racine: namely to
object that their personages did not live at the time in
which the author situates them, that he endows them with
a language they did not speak or with customs that could
not have been theirs. When a picture cannot represent, it
changes into a rebus, marking the triumph of allegory
which prevails in all the arts of drawing. By signifying the
Nile through a statue whose head is enshrouded by a veil,
says the good Abbé du Bos, Bernini “nobly designated
that the Nile wished to conceal its source.” So be it! But
today when the sources of the Nile are known, this veil

! 149!
would lead the spectator into error, were he to ask the
question.
The most striking feature of the comments made on
pictures by those who judge them from the viewpoint of
poetic imagery is that, valid or not, they bear no necessary
relation to the art of painting and would apply just as well,
or better, to an historical essay on the events depicted.
This is a sure sign that the artist and the critic have
surreptitiously shifted the problem and substituted
knowledge for art.
It is from this starting point that the celebrated
conflict between color and drawing finds an intelligible
meaning. All that is required to discover it is to listen to
the painters who have given thought to their art. The
more the painter inclines toward historical painting, the
greater importance drawing has in his works. This is a self
evident proposition for the reason that so-called history
painting (religious, national, ancient or mythological) is
necessarily representational and nothing can be
represented without drawing it. Why does this necessity
force color into second place? Naturally, it is not a
question of abolishing color, since color perfects imitation
and resemblance, but in a genre as essentially
representational as history, whether it be anecdotal or
merely topical, credibility imposes itself with such absolute
necessity that the painter must stay approximately within
the limits of the natural colors that to the eye are
characteristic of objects. To follow the play of color for
pure optical pleasure is to make use of it against likeness
where color, on the contrary, ought to lead to its

! 150!
perfection. In this case, color, like drawing and form, is
compelled to imitate nature; it cannot be an end in itself,
and there is no reason to invent one.
Both painters and drawers of historical subjects have
clearly understood this fundamental aspect of the
problem.
“Avoid too ardent color,” said Ingres, “it’s anti-
historical. Fall into grey rather than into ardent tones if
you can’t make it just right, if you can’t find an absolutely
true tone.” Such words are revealing if interpreted in the
light of this spirit of submission to the real and the
credible which characterizes this genre of painting. Again
Ingres: “The historical tone leaves the mind tranquil; have
no more ambition on that score than on any other.”
Should we underline this marvelous phrase, historical tone?
A kind of color that knows how to be inobtrusive because
it is the color of things themselves! “According to many
persons,” wrote Ingres, “Raphael was not a colorist. He
did not use color as did Rubens or Van Dyck. I certainly
agree, indeed he guarded himself against it very well!”
Here then it is not the reflection of a philosopher but
that of a painter upon his art which sets two principles of
painting against each other, each one of which tends to
dominate the other and finally to exclude it. As often
happens, the most beautiful accomplishments, or at least
the ones we savor most, have always been compromises.
In Ingres we desire no color but his, and in Delacroix no
other drawing but his; the latter, through his painter’s
drawing responds to the former’s draughtsman’s coloring.
We would betray a poor understanding of the astonishing

! 151!
evolution of modern painting if we did not see in it an
almost necessary sequel to the duality of tendencies
inherent in the traditional notion of painting. Ever
wavering between two possible arts, imagery and painting,
which for a long time he was content to combine into
different proportions, we have seen the modern painter
engage himself in compromises that he himself did not
have the patience to endure. The beginnings of “Fauvism”
are instructive in this respect. The sight of the first trunks
of trees painted blood red or raw green provoked hilarity
among some and indignation among others. These
painters protested against this reaction, but neither reason
nor art were entirely on their side. They had the right to
represent trees, but if this was their intention why did they
retain the form of this representation without the color?
They likewise had the right to place red or green streaks
on their canvases, but if color alone interested them why
give it the form of trees? They or their immediate
successors sided with one of the solutions to the problem:
Vlaminck returned to landscape painting and to its
naturally grey-green tones while Derain went back to
classicism with an obstinacy which his first admirers have
often regretted. The partisans of color liberated it no less
from form but also from the imitation of natural forms to
which painting had always more or less strictly compelled
it. Whence stems the non-figurative art of today, whose
mere existence constitutes a convincing answer to the
second question that we posed: if imagery is possible
without painting can we say that painting without imagery
may be equally possible? The answer is yes and the

! 152!
objections that have been raised to this answer up to now
are rooted more in emotionalism than solid fact.
The common fault of these objections is that they
discuss art from a viewpoint other than that of its essence.
For example, personal taste has no role in the discussion
of this problem. Those who tolerate only non-
representational painting pontificate as arbitrarily as those
who refuse to consider it painting at all. Tastes are free,
painters are free. Colors arranged in a certain order on a
plane surface always constitute a painting, whatever the
colors and this order may be. Whether or not the result is
pleasing depends not only upon the artist but upon the
spectator as well-and if there are many people who cannot
endure the sight of abstract canvases, there is no lack of
those who shrink at the mere thought of seeing some of
Horace Vernet’s compositions again. To argue about such
matters is a complete waste of time.
The objection drawn from the very nature of art in
general is more subtle and takes its point of departure at a
much higher level. Art is declared to be all the more lofty
the more its operations fully utilize the ensemble of the
resources at the disposal of the human mind. Indeed it
cannot be denied that painting, by achieving an increasing
awareness of its proper essence, has considerably lowered
its former requirement. By recognizing the essential nature
of its proper good with an ever greater clarity it has
progressively lost the remembrance of the techniques
formerly practiced in the ateliers and allowed to perish its
manual skills and the perfections of method to which we
owe the greatly admired beauty in the art of the old

! 153!
masters. It has been said that an exceptional general
culture of the gifts of mind and hand was necessary to
conceive work such as those executed by Veronese,
Tintoretto or Tiepolo, in which the artist proved his ability
to create a world of human beings, of gods and of
goddesses, not to speak of the palaces they inhabited, of
the objects with which these palaces were furnished, and
of the animals who graced them. This is incontestable, and
the virtuosity of the technicians who knew how to execute
these works with almost infallible mastery attests to the
perfection achieved at that time by an art that perhaps will
never find it again.7
If, however, we persist in conceiving of the art of
painting in terms of its proper essence and idea we may
doubt whether all the perfections of these pictures were
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
7 A position defendedseveral times by Paul Valéry and
which is certainly justified in its order and on its plane. But the
art of this or that artist includes a great number of elements that
merge with the fundamental art from which his work derives. To
paint like Veronese, Tintoretto or even like Tiepolo at Stra, is
manifestly to testify to an ensemble of cognitions and to the
mastery of necessary techniques which imply a human perfection
which is difficult to attain and which will probably never again be
equalled. In the past there was one country. Italy, where geniuses
of this kind found all the artistic and social complicities favorable
to their flowering. Such an art in effect is difficult and very lofty.
But in another sense, an art so simple in appearance which has
bequeathed us Vermeer’s The Lacemaker or Watteau’s The
Indifferent One is at least as close as The Wedding at Cana to the
essence of pure painting.

! 154!
the perfections of painting. By judging it as a harmony of
forms and colors arranged on a plane surface, this or that
predella by Sarsetta or this or that tiny interior by Bonnard
or by Vuillard holds no less perfect joys in store for the
spectator than the contemplation of so many enormous
compositions ideally suited to feed the descriptions of
them purveyed by writers and the commentaries of
historians or of guides. Historical knowledge,
psychological penetration, ingenuity in the conception and
arrangement of the parts are so many precious perfections
in themselves: their importance grew to the degree that
painting further assumed the functions proper to imagery
and poetry and undertook to represent or tell a story. It
was then that this creator of immovable visual
appearances willed to give the illusion of movement and
that this great silent art aspired to speak. In order to
compete with history it had to compose “scenes”
conceived as so many talking images which as a result
have become numerous subjects for explanatory texts and
lessons. Is it really so surprising that this admirable
figurative technique, priceless in its order and worthy of
the sincerest admiration, has in fact been neglected and
lost in a time like ours when the least interesting thing
about a picture is the subject matter? We can therefore ask
ourselves whether this decadence of technique is also a
decadence of painting. This does not require us to draw a
conclusion, but to effect a disassociation of ideas. 8
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
8 Writers have a weakness
for this part of the art of painting
because on this particular subject they are as or more competent
than the painter himself. Nobody reads Diderot’s “Salons” today.
! 155!
Neither does it require us to pronounce judgment, inviting
us rather to reflection.
The evolution of modern painting forcibly poses a
final question. To speak of non-representational,
non-imitative or abstract painting is not to speak of an
amorphous painting. No painting is more abstract than
Mondrian’s, but this geometric painting is also the most
formal of all. Like formal logic itself, it is form without
content. Everything which preceded effortlessly
accommodates itself to a painting of this kind, but a later
development has led our contemporaries to eliminate even
form from painting. We hesitate to describe works of this
kind, which seem to be reduced to colors arranged
without apparent order on a plane surface. Some of these
paintings look like wall panels covered with a layer of
almost uniform paint, without any diversity save that of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
He was strong on the description of the subject of pictures. But
we can still see him, in the anthologies of his writings, giving
Pigalle a lesson on the manner in which the sculptor should
conceive and compose the Monument de Reims. The passage is
grandiose in its unconscious presumption: “Pigalle, my friend,
take your hammer and break this group of bizarre beings into
pieces for me” (Diderot, Essai sur la peinture, in Oeuvres (Paris: La
Pléiade), p. 1181. The preface to the first edition (1798) entirely
shared this feeling. In this essay, according to the preface, it will
be seen “what help the arts can draw from this perspicacity of the
true man of letters and the reflections of the philosopher.” This
incredible pretention has not ceased to show itself in some men
of letters, but we can hope that philosophers will be more and
more inclined to obtain instruction from artists and less and less
inclined to lord it over them.
! 156!
the brush strokes. It could be that this is still painting, but
we can no longer be certain that it is art. The objection is
not that the sight of these panels arouses no feeling of
pleasure, for they must give some pleasure to their authors
and no doubt also to those who buy them.9 The question,
rather, is to determine whether this pleasure is that of a
pure apprehension of color, hence natural, or of the
apprehension of a work of art proper in which pleasure is
born of the intelligibility of a form made perceptible to the
senses through its material. There is no work of art
without matter, and the cognition of artistic beauty is
always essentially a perception, but in order to be an
apprehension of the beautiful, this perception must
necessarily be that of a matter intentionally impregnated
with intelligibility. Art and the beauty proper to it
disappear along with form and order. The pleasures of
matter are all that remain, stirring to be sure and rather
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
9 As determined as
I am not to attribute any privileged value
to my personal esthetic experiences, which for that matter are in
detail so unstable, I must, however, recognize that these recent
developments have somewhat disconcerted me. In 1963, in
Washington, a very enlightened lady art-lover placed me before
some canvasses where I saw only a form similar to that deposit
of dust that spontaneously settles on the top of some radiators.
In the face of my all too obvious dismay, she charitably left me as
a hopeless case. In the same city, an admirable private collection
placed me in the presence of large colored panels which bore not
the slightest trace of a line or spot. Why judge? Would Baudelaire
perhaps have been happy before a beautiful violet panel? True
enough, the canonesses in that case provided him with some
distractions.
! 157!
too much than not enough, but they scarcely lead beyond
the level of animality. An ethics of art, perhaps, would
seek purification of the ever confused emotivity of our
sensibility passively subjected to material stimuli of all
kinds. Art in that case would have the function of
furnishing the sensibility with objects worthy of it, that is
to say the sensibility of an intelligent being.
Painting is found only rarely in a pure state, but what
an artist introduces into the conception and execution of a
painting is what authorizes the work to lay claim to the art
of painting. For a great number of spectators, probably
the great majority, painting can only be taken in small
doses, and they prefer the elements of imagery,
sentimentality, romanticism or anecdotes found in it. The
remarks which were made on statuary in this connection
are scarcely less true with respect to painting.10 This kind
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
10 In Baudelaire’s
Salon de I846 we come across a chapter title
which promises much: “Why sculpture is boring.” The promise,
however, is imperfectly kept. The fact itself is hardly contestable;
in a museum or at an art exhibition when we want to breathe
better than we do in the picture galleries, all we have to do is to
go see the sculpture. The first reason that Baudelaire gives for
this is rather disconcerting. Sculpture, he says, “is an art of
Caribbeans.” All peoples knew how to sculpt long before they
could paint (he did not know Altamira); sculpture is closer to
nature than painting, and this is why “our peasants who rejoice at
the sight of a sculptured piece of wood or stone remain in a state
of stupor in the presence of the most beautiful painting. Therein
lies a singular mystery which we cannot put our fingers on”
(Oeuvres complètes, Pléiade), p. 671. Let us admit that we see
nothing here which can make sculpture boring to the public. A
! 158!
of art triumphs principally in the form of mixed modes
which achieved their peak of perfection among the
masters of the Italian Renaissance, among the first
Flemish masters and those who perpetuated their tradition
in different countries. It would be all the more bad grace
to criticize them because it was probably by offering us
doses tolerable to our weakness that these admirable
painters progressively led modern man to the discovery of
a pure form of their art. In admiring their works the
important thing is not to let the admiration lose itself on
the ore, but to concentrate on the gold.
The discernment of works of art is the province of art
criticism; the philosophy of art has but one general rule to
set forth in these matters: everything which enters into the
composition of a picture, not only the materials, the tools
and the traditional techniques of execution used, but
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
more serious attempt at explanation states that sculpture “brutal
and positive as nature, is at the same time vague and ungraspable
because it shows too many faces at once.” We can read other
reasons in this particular chapter, in which the conclusion is
drawn that “it is as difficult to be knowledgeable in sculpture as it
is to make bad sculpture” (p. 672). But this assertion also would
lead us to expect that we take pleasure in looking at it. The real
question, perhaps, is that the incontestable fact, which is the
point of departure, is itself ambiguous. The multitudes perhaps
go to see pictures for the sake of the imagery rather than for the
sake of painting; without the charm of color, deprived of
anecdotal interest which for many spectators constitutes the
principal charm of the picture, sculpture proper is perhaps no
more or no less faithful than pure painting. Baudelaire, obviously,
does not seem to be of their number: non omnia possumus omnes.
! 159!
further the model, the subject, the obvious meaning or the
symbolic signification, in short everything therein, forms
part of the material of the work, except for the plastic
form which the painter has conceived and progressively
imparted to these different elements in order to integrate
them into the unity of an object the sight of which would
be desirable for its own sake. What is involved in this case
is an object which is called beautiful, that is to say a
sensible object whose intelligibility is in some way visible,
as something wholly impregnating a material for the
exclusive purpose of embodying it.
Hence it is always to be feared that the material may
seduce the spectator away from the form, all the more so
because the plurality of forms seems to be the rule in the
order of art in contrast to what occurs in the order of
nature. In art the higher form does not replace the lower
forms which it takes possession of; all it can do in its
supreme determination is to unify them without
suppressing them. Therefore each form remains present,
animated by a natural tendency to self-assertion, not
without some danger to the unity of the whole.
Virtuosity in the technique of execution can tend to
affirm itself for its own sake; indeed it is natural for it to
do so because it is a good thing, constitutes an art in itself
and can legitimately pursue its own beauty. Skill in imita-
tion, which is also an art, can tend to seek its own
satisfaction in an increasingly perfect imagery, up to the
perfection of a reproduction or even of trompe l’oeil; this
too is an art capable of achieving beauty of its own, and
we see no reason why we should deprive ourselves of it,

! 160!
or even simply limit its rights. Above all, natural beauty is
permanently present as an irresistible invitation to the
artist to carry it over just as it is into his work, which will
thereby turn out fully wrought. He can certainly consent
but on the condition that he does not believe that the
copying of a beautiful landscape is the same as making a
beautiful painting, nor that painting a beautiful live model
is by the same token the painting of a beautiful nude. The
artist is less exposed to this danger than the spectator, for
one of the surest means of purifying the sight of a living
beautiful body is the effort that must be exerted to make
of it a picture whose beauty will be that of art, its very
own, and not that of nature which is that of the model.
The spectator most often judges only the result: an artistic
beauty, obliging complicities, which lets itself be admired
as a natural beauty. It is in the nude that the art of painting
achieves the most complete triumph of form over pictorial
matter by proceeding to a kind of purgation of the
passions; but it is also the terrain of its most frequent
defeat, for it is scarcely possible to fashion an art free of
all sexual complicity with an object so closely bound up
with sexuality. Eroticism is the shoal on which painting,
which deliberately makes the natural beauty of the human
body its subject, runs the risk of foundering.11
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
11 The history of
modern painting since Cézanne offers a
very important subject of reflection to the philosopher. It is the
artists, not the philosophers, who by their investigations have
demonstrated the non-imitative character of plastic art. The
painter Ozenfant’s book, Art (Paris: Jean Budry, 1928), is rich in
philosophical reflections on this point. This book, which has
! 161!
All the other “subjects”, depicting emotions, passions,
history, patriotism or religion, are of another nature, but
their effect is similar. Each time the artist stirs the spec-
tator’s emotion through the subject matter, it is not art
which moves him but the subject. Each time that he
proceeds this way the artist cheats, but since it is the
spectator who often demands to be tricked and becomes
indignant if painting is offered to him instead of the
pictorial, sentimental or anecdotal imagery that he expects,
it would be bad grace to blame the artist who seeks a
compromise, inasmuch as the artist himself often desires
it. It can be truly said of the art of painting above all that it
is useless to try to prod nature out of sight, for she makes
a quick comeback. This is the bastard condition in which
the art of painting has lived and endured for centuries. It
seems doubtful that it could ever live differently, save for
the brief periods during which it wages a heroic struggle to
realize itself in the purity of its essence. The example of
our time abundantly shows how little recognition painting
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
been out of print in France since 1930, unfortunately has never
been republished. I first learned about this book through its
American edition: Amédée Ozenfant, Foundations of Modern Art,
tr. by John Rodker, new edition (New York: Dover Publications,
1952). I quote, nearly at random: “The Cubist attitude; the effort
to evoke emotions without resort to representational form” (p.
51). “One definition would be: Cubism in painting conceived as
related forms which are not determined by any reality external to
these related forms” (p. 76). “Cézanne gave us pears and apples
that owed nothing to Eve; it was a brutal interruption to a flesh
diet” (p. 82).
! 162!
attracts to itself by an effort of this kind, but since
universal art must nourish itself on its lessons later, it is a
good thing, indeed it is necessary that, from time to time,
some artists have the courage to repeat it.

! 163!
FIVE
Music
!
!
!
SOUND IS THE MATERIAL of musical art. Since noises
are also sounds, the term “musical sound” is used at times
for greater precision to mean the sensible quality or
impression produced on the nerves and auditory centers
by the vibrations set up in the atmosphere, whose
frequency ranges between sixteen and sixteen thousand
double vibrations per second. The numbers of these
vibrations can vary slightly according to individuals.
Acoustics is the science of sounds as optics is that of
colors; in both cases art has preceded science and, with
even greater reason, philosophy. The latter takes the
properties of musical sound into consideration only
insofar as they directly affect the essence of music.
The three principal qualities of musical sound are
pitch, timbre and intensity. Their importance is
attributable to the fact that these qualities, taken together,
make it possible to identify a given musical sound. The
existence of distinct sounds identifiable by their pitch,
timbre and intensity ensures the material possibility of the
very existence of music because it enables us to distinguish
sounds and to combine them without the possibility of
! 164!
confusion. In this respect musicians are more fortunate
than painters, for if the distinction between lines is clear
that between forms and colors is much less so. Delacroix
deplored that the average spectator was not as capable of
perceiving tonal harmony or discordancy in painting as he
was aware of those qualities in music. Indeed, sounds
seem to be the most distinctly differentiable of sensible
qualities; whence derives the possibility of the unconscious
calculus to which the ear spontaneously surrenders upon
perceiving them and which is the basis of the pleasure we
take in music.
Although no sustained experiments have been made
to prove it, it would appear that on the whole
sensitiveness to the emotions aroused by the perception of
sounds is more widespread and keener than sensitiveness
to forms, lines and colors. This is not to say that a
monument, a statue, or a picture cannot intensely and
deeply move some spectators endowed with a special
sensitiveness to visual images. If painting were not so
commonly confused with imagery it would be easily seen
that the number of those who love painting for itself is
relatively small; thousands of visitors spend pleasurable or
painful hours in a museum and leave it without suspecting
that they know nothing about the real nature of painting.
On the other hand, nobody is ever mistaken about the
nature of music, for it cannot be confused with any
imagery. As to its effects, all we have to do is compare the
crushed air of patrons leaving a museum with the shouts,
even the howling, that greets the end of many concerts to
convince ourselves that music can unleash violent

! 165!
reactions of an emotion of the most obvious visceral
character. Those who are visibly annoyed by this wild
disorder and who do not give vent to their feelings are
exceptions and are exposed to the hostile glares of the
other concert-goers. Perhaps this is the secret revenge that
noise takes against sound! In any case, the sudden release
of an excess of emotion repressed during a musical
performance sufficiently confirms the intensity of the
emotional states normally associated with sounds. Painting
unleashes no such uproar. If we look daggers at someone
in a museum, our disapproving glance is much more likely
directed against the visitor who has given vent to a soft cry
of delight upon a sudden encounter with beauty.
Just as painting at the start requires a void of visual
forms, music likewise can be created only in a void of
sonorous forms. Imperfect as the traditional formula esse
post non esse is when applied to the creative act, it is justified
here. First there is silence, then the song which the lonely
man invents to fill his solitude, or the music suddenly
released by the conductor of the orchestra after he has
obtained almost total silence from the audience.1
The analogy ends here. The forms which the architect,
sculptor or painter create in space are forms proper,
visible and endowed by their creators with a total and
simultaneous existence which is also definitive for as long
as the material out of which these forms have been
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
1
! The minute of silence in the darkness demanded by
Wagner before the beginning of every musical drama at Bayreuth,
can serve as a symbol here.
! 166!
fashioned lasts. In fact, the mode of being and of duration
of a work of art are those of its material. Sound is not a
solid; it is caused by a sonorous vibration, hence by a
movement in the atmosphere, and its duration is that of
the movement causing it. Actually, this is not altogether
correct for a sonorous sensation in its unity already
combines a multiplicity of elementary physical movements
that have been set off in the atmosphere out of which they
make a single sound. Below sixteen double vibrations, the
ear perceives only discontinuous pulsations, the elements
of a potential sensation which our ear does not perceive,
being unable to bind its elements together into the
continuity of a definite single sound. We sense we are on
the threshold of this transition, on the very border
between sound and noise, when listening to an organ pipe
32 feet in length.
This is why music is called an art of time in contrast to
the plastic arts whose works subsist in space. The
distinction between the arts of time and the arts of space
is certainly a meaningful one, even though all the arts by
virtue of their materials are dependent simultaneously
upon time and space, as has already been noted, for where
are sonorous vibrations produced if not in space? And
where do the temples of Egypt endure if not in time? But
the true meaning of the distinction lies elsewhere. Sound
has no physical substance of its own, it does not continue
to subsist by itself after being produced, rather it ceases
and is heard no more.
The consequences ensuing from this fact deeply affect
the structure of musical compositions, for they would

! 167!
vanish into discontinuity like the physical elements of
vibration if sensation did not grasp them in the unity of
sound. Sounds likewise would be lost in the void of
discontinuity, as Saint Augustine pointed out fifteen
centuries ago,2 if memory did not harbor and measure
them so that the mind, aided by the imagination, can
arrange them into distinct groups each one of which
constitutes a sonorous form. This form passes away in
turn and dissolves, when upon reaching its limit the
sonorous images of which it is composed fade away and
their order escapes the memory. The fluid and successive
being of musical substance entails its intellectuality since
the work, inasmuch as it forms a whole, requires that it be
structured in the memory by the mind. Thus, the mind
affects the totality of this art in all its aspects and its
minutest details. Music is essentially an art of time in the
specific sense that it has no actual physical existence save
during the time of its actual execution. The sculptor
sculpts, the painter paints, the architect builds in time; they
leave behind a work which lasts and subsists without
them, sometimes for millennia. The singer sings and each
note dies as it leaves his lips. Not only is it an art of time,
but an art of the moment, whose existence as art is of the
same nature as that of the dance, poetry, the theatre. The
unity of these actions is but that of a duration whose
elements would fall back into the void of silence as they
fade if memory did not forget this unity by endowing
these elements with at least a temporary subsistence and a
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
2 Augustine, Confessions, Book XI, Chapters 27-28.
! 168!
mode of intellectuality.
Music, being essentially ephemeral, is the art of that
which is to die, but it is also the art of that which wills to
be born and its victorious ability to affirm the being that it
creates is inseparable from its essential resignation to its
own demise. Music not only accepts passing away, it
aspires thereto; its parts must fall back into nothingness
one by one so that the whole, of which they are the
elements, can come into being. There is no point in
stressing the intimate relationship with the human
condition whose unceasing changes, as Saint Augustine
frequently noted, are so many successive deaths. Nobody
knows this better than the musician. He never ceases to
annul the sound which he has just produced by producing
another which cancels its predecessor. He simply cannot
fix musical sound in an immobility of any duration. There
are sustained notes, of course, and chords whose
prolongation seems to want to impart a feeling of stability,
but they announce a change unless they serve him only
like the pedal notes as a support for their very immobility.
Absolutely motionless music would be like the music of
the celestial spheres, the ear would cease to perceive it.
Therefore, from the beginning of our reflection upon this
art we must accustom ourselves to the fundamental notion
of musical occurrence. Music is essentially a sequence of
sonorous occurrences which the artist perforce creates
without let-up so that the substance of his art may exist.
He knows well that his listener will live in the expectation
of the unexpected, in default of which even the return to
the expected would not be possible. Music therefore is an

! 169!
art of time to the same degree that it is an art of change
and of becoming.
Its material is sound, as we have already said. By virtue
of this it is the creator of its own material, for strictly
speaking there are no musical sounds in nature. All we
hear in nature are noises, that is to say sounds generally
produced by irregular vibrations without a definite timbre
and without a pitch that is exactly locatable on any
recognized scale. In this sense everything is created in
music, even its material, for noise is merely the material of
the sound which itself is the material of music. But now
for the first time since the beginning of these reflections
we must confirm the existence of a human artistic material
all the elements of which are furnished by the human
body in its natural condition and functioning without the
help of any artificial means. In this sense, music introduces
us to a new order which we can call that of the arts of
man. The human voice is the first of all musical
instruments; most musicians are also agreed that it is the
most beautiful of all of them. This is understandable in
view of the sounds that it is capable of producing, its
flexibility and the perfection of the most varied sonorous
forms that it can be made to execute at the price, naturally,
of considerable effort and well-directed training.
The body is the singer’s instrument. We can very
rightly say this of the body, for even the parts that do not
directly contribute to forming the voice play a role, even if
only as a sounding board. Vocal music because of its
material is the most moving of all forms of musical
expression. The listener to whom a human body addresses

! 170!
itself responds to this call through his own body. Nothing
which makes of him an animal body remains indifferent to
this experience. If we restrict ourselves to voices taken at
the peak of their development, at their optimum age (there
are young voices and old voices, like the bodies they
inhabit), and disregard the numberless individual or racial
variations distinguishing them, human voices are divided
first of all into the voices of men, women and children of
both sexes. Voices have a sex, indeed to such a degree that
the removal of the sex of some adults resulted in the
creation of a special type of voice, that of the castrati, some
of whom had brilliant musical careers. The disappearance
of this type of voice brought the end to a definite type of
musical beauty. The part of Orpheus in Gluck’s opera is
most often played by excellent artists, expert in the art of
bel canto. Whether they are contraltos or counter-tenors
these remarkable singers leave many listeners dissatisfied,
although they are in no way to blame. What is missing is
the vanished “treble-singer”, a representative of the breed
of Guadagni for whom Gluck had written the part and
whom he himself could not listen to without weeping.
These asexual voices, first subjected to twelve or fifteen
years of study, no longer exist. In contrast to musical
instruments, every human voice has a sex and it is
probably useless to maintain that the physiological relation
between singer and listener in no way affects a musical
performance.
The case of singing offers an exceptionally favorable
occasion to pose some problems and to understand the
answers to them.

! 171!
First of all it helps us to give its true meaning to Keat’s
poetic utterance “a thing of beauty is a joy forever”—itself
so beautiful. Indeed it is this for as long as it lasts and we
last to behold it; but we pass on, works of art fall into ruin
and their very ruins perish. Innumerable beautiful
creations no longer exist for us save as names of musical
compositions. They are no longer performed because
there are no longer any artists such as the ones for whom
they were written nor, of course, a knowledgeable and
appreciative public to listen to them.
From this follows a second observation. Singing
assumes a singer and this becomes the source of problems
in the musical art that do not arise in painting. The painter
is his own executant, he is his own virtuoso and his work
is uniquely his own in a sense in which that of the
musician’s is only rarely—perhaps even never. In music,
the actual existence of the work depends most often on
some person other than its creator; now the art of
execution is distinct from that of composition, it is
learned, acquired and displayed separately. A
contemporary reproached Liszt for “playing the piano”
and recommended Chopin to those who wanted to “hear
music played”. In part he was right, yet it must be
admitted that the two arts are closely related, whence the
source of the problem of the virtuoso that inevitably rises
in all orders of the musical art, for the executant must
acquire the virtuoso’s skill to be able to play the musical
works that are entrusted to him. It is not necessarily the
problems of a difficult execution that are in question. The
way one strikes a keyboard or a violin by itself permits an

! 172!
almost infallible forecast. One must be the master of an
instrument in order to be truly able to play music.
Listeners do not always know where to direct their
attention, nor to what to address their admiration or
criticism. Most of the time they focus their attention on
both at once, that is to say on the execution in the music,
or inversely since the execution is the actualization of a
potential music which would not exist without it. A great
number of aesthetic judgments are misdirected because
the actual addressee is not clearly identified.
This initial imprecision affects a vast sector of music
in the case of singing. By its very tradition, opera is
inseparable from the art of singing. Italian opera of the
eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, up to Rossini and
perhaps Verdi (minus Falstaff), can be more or less
accurately described as an art of bel canto as much as an art
of music. We cannot read a history of this opera without
constantly coming upon the names of some male or
female singers for whom some operas were written to
measure, that is to say by taking into account the
individual particularities of their voices. For even in the
class proper to them the voices of men, women and
children are distinguished by their texture, ranging from
the absolute soprano to the contralto for women, and
from the absolute tenor to the deep bass voice for men.
Given the same texture, furthermore, the voice of each
individual is distinguished from others by characteristic
qualities such as power, richness of timbre, the brilliance
or volume of the sound. Vocal instruction, the study of
which is a world in itself because of the great variety in

! 173!
methods and aims, results in the production of voices
whose intrinsic perfection constitutes the material of a
distinct art. We speak of singers such as Elisabeth
Gafforini, Adelaide Melanotte, Marietta Mariolini (for
whom Rossini composed l’Italiana in A 19ieri), and further
of Pisaroni, Judith Negri (Madame Pasta), Alboni,
Malabran and so many others as artists “placed at the
service of music by the art of singing”. The very opposite
is true. These are the names of artists for whom music was
placed in the service of the art of singing.3 The score was
written for the singers and the singing itself took into the
greatest consideration the quality of each voice, even the
quality of the chest or head notes of this or that female or
male singer, as well as the transitional notes, so important
for ensuring the consistent quality of voices. It is merely
an expression of taste to say that the opera at that time
was a false genre and that the scores of Jonelli, Piccini,
Sacchini, Trajella or Hasse betray a distressing musical
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
3 The fact strikes
the reader of old theatrical criticism in
France, for example, written in the second half of the nineteenth
century. See the criticism in the Revue des Deux-Mondes; Paul
Scudo, Critique et littératures musicales (Paris: 1852, 2nd ed.), in
which chapters are dedicated to the “art of singing in Italy”,
“Angelica Catalani”, “Henriette Sontag”, “Story of an
opera-singer” (Rose Niva). The same author’s L’art ancien et l’art
moderne (Paris: Garnier, 1854) comments on Grassini, Celeste
Coltellini, Faustina, Caroline Duprez, etc. In Les écrits de Paul
Dukas sur la musique (Paris: Musique et Musiciens, 1948), the
selection of criticism stretches over the period from 1892 to
1932; I noted that there was not a single article dedicated to a
singer, male or female.
! 174!
poverty. This judgment may be correct in itself, but it
neglects the fact that works of this kind were written with
the art of singing as such in view, and for a breed of
singers now extinct whose names no longer mean
anything today. Who remembers the eunuch Farinelli, the
tenors Babbini and Babbi? Yet it was their art of singing
which in their time served so many operas nowadays
wholly out of fashion. Their art died with them. What is
particularly striking is that it was killed by composers, first
because of their persistent demand that the singers sing
the music exactly as they had written it and then because
they wrote music conceived with its own beauty in view
rather than with that of its execution. Mozart, perhaps,
began to open up this path, not without running into a
resistance from singers which continues to this day;
Wagner led the trend to its limit by personally teaching his
own singers how his music was to be sung. This endemic
conflict between the art of music and the art of singing
merely illustrates the specificity of the creative arts and of
the performing arts, which in themselves entail a degree of
creativity in their own sphere. When we say that a work
was “created at La Monnaie” in Brussels, we thereby mean
to fix the place of its first performance. A certain kind of
art of singing had to die in order that a certain kind of
music could come into being. Nothing else distinguishes
the difference between them more clearly.
The same observation could be made in connection
with any performing musical art. The case of vocal art is
simply the first one that offers itself to scrutiny, but the
eternal quarrel between composer and virtuoso has no

! 175!
other meaning. It is, perhaps, no mere accident that the
age of Italian virtuosi singers was also that of the virtuosi
of the violin: the singing instrument. Yet in this golden
age, and perhaps because of the possibilities inherent in
the instrument itself, the virtuosi were often composers:
Corelli, Martini, Paganini are names still laden with
musical associations for us. In the field of instrumental
music, Paganini would be the counterpart of the singer
whose artistry is virtuosity itself. Ingres was already wary
about this, and today when a young violinist announces
that he will play a concerto by Paganini, whose artistry
formerly was enough to overwhelm audiences, we
understand that his intention is to prove to us that he too
is capable of executing it.
The voice and its music constitute a class apart,
specifically distinct from the ensemble of sounds
produced by the instruments that were invented, perfected
and constantly multiplied precisely for the purpose of
producing such sounds. Singing is the living music of the
human body; like the body it is animated by an intellect
which commands the emissions, the inflections, the
variations of intensity and, as is said, the slightest
“expressive” nuances. Whatever its nature and range,
which can be extremely broad or almost nil, the
instrument introduces an inorganic intermediary between
the musician and his music. Therefore he does not
command the sound like a singer, who as the master of his
voice animates its inflections from within. This duality of
nature between vocal and instrumental music is reflected
in the musical works themselves. Broadly speaking, it can

! 176!
be said that some composers write for instruments, others
for voices. More exactly, some of them treat voices as
instruments, as Johann Sebastian Bach did so often,
whereas others do the opposite, as did Mozart, many of
whose orchestral themes ask only to be sung. This is
indeed why Bach’s music, as beautiful as we know it can
be, is always inhuman (non-human) whereas Mozart’s is
essentially human. 4 Mozartean music is always human
because it always sings; it is impossible for the musician to
play it without singing it.
Any material that can set off regular vibrations in the
atmosphere perceptible to the ear is a musical instrument,
or can become one. The classification into three main
families is well known: wind instruments, string
instruments and percussion instruments in which perhaps
we can separately classify some instruments whose strings
are struck into action, such as the piano.5 The history of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
4 Mozart can give
proof of cruelty toward his singers, and
perhaps even more towards those of the female sex. At times we
sense in him an intention to do so, but more accurately it is a
cruelty which brings itself to bear on singing as an emission of
the human voice, not as a substitute for an instrument.
5 Electric music, improperly called “electronic”, enables us

to assist at the birth of a new musical building material. Here


what is at stake is the creation of new instruments, in which
sound is produced by oscillators, by photo-electric cells, etc.
Electronic organs, the “Martenot waves”, have taken their place
in the curricula of the conservatories. A considerable musical
literature has already been written especially for electric waves.
This is a particular case of the problem, general in the fine arts,
which consists in determining whether a new technique involves
! 177!
instruments is part of musicology; psychophysiology
studies the different ways in which each kind of
instrument affects the listener’s sensibility; the knowledge
of their characteristic textures and timbres is answerable to
the science of orchestration which presupposes such
knowledge although it is not reducible to or deducible
from it. The philosopher is most interested in the fact
that, regardless of the instrument, the sound produced is
already a musical creation. The painter’s colors are also
human products, but they have their models in nature
where we find reds, blues, and very bold yellows as well as
the broad spectrum of their possible combinations. It is
much more rare to find ready-made musical sounds in
nature; sometimes the songs of birds contain them,
especially to the ear of a musician. The sound of drops of
water falling one by one in the silence of the night is not
organized into a melody except by those who are already
knowledgeable about music: 6 it would require remote
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
new forms. Architect Lloyd Wright’s remark: we have building
materials for which we do not yet have forms, is valid in all the
arts.
6
! Experiments are actually in progress to introduce noise
into music, or even to compose music with noises (typewriters,
explosions in motors, or noises artificially produced ad hoc). Any
experiment is legitimate in art; its success or its failure with the
public alone will decide the fate of “concrete music”. We will at
least point out that the case is not the same as that of so-called
abstract painting because the concrete element of which the
building material of abstract painting is composed is still the line
and the color which imitative painting makes use of. Noise, on
! 178!
analogies to find in natural noises anything resembling the
sounds of a violin. Men have invented musical
instruments of all kinds for the purpose of producing
sounds that are the very material of music.
This inventiveness continues. There is no end to
imagining new ways of producing musical sounds of a new
type which themselves suggest the invention of new
musical forms. The history of music confirms this. Bach is
inconceivable without the organ, Chopin without the
piano, Mozart without the violin, and the ensemble of
modem symphonic music without the string, wind and
percussion instruments that make up a large orchestra. If
its details were known, the history of the invention of
musical instruments would perhaps make us see more
clearly that there has been a frequent exchange between
the imagination of composers in search of new sounds
with which to structure new musical forms and that of
instrument makers who by creating new sonorities opened
and revealed unsuspected formal possibilities to
composers.7 Who can say what modem music owes to
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
the contrary, is not a sound. The tom-tom produces sounds, not
noises, hence it is put into music; a percussion orchestra is a
genuine orchestra, it plays music. Not only does noise not lend
itself to the construction of musical form, but it prevents it from
being born or destroys it. Noise is the enemy of sound. But
artistic invention consists precisely in drawing the possible from
the impossible. The philosophy of art does not enable us to
predict its future.!
7
! The remark that without the bass clarinet one of the
preludes of his opera Fervaal would not exist, has been attributed
! 179!
Adolph Isax who, in the period between 1840 and 1845,
invented the family of seven instruments which quite
rightly have been called “saxophones”. Conversely, the
way in which certain composers employed new
instruments in their works made them so particularly their
own that it is practically impossible for anyone else to use
them later without appearing to imitate them. It is difficult
to assign a bare theme to tubas without seeming to
plagiarize a passage from the Wagnerian tetralogy; no
sooner do we hear tubas by themselves, some Valhalla
seems to be crashing into fiery ruin. In short, the very
possibility of musical forms is closely related to the
existence of sounds created by man with these forms in
view. There are no conceivable limits to the possibility of
new musical sounds, but there are to the constant training
of new artists to produce them since performing artists do
not like “their fingering to be changed.”
The details of the problems connected with musical
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
to Vincent d’Indy. If this remark is correct, it well illustrates the
fruitfulness of the creation of instruments, since it invites
composers to create new sonorous forms. Let us note in this
connection that the formal vocation of a particular instrumental
sonority is indestructible. Eliminated for a time by the piano, the
harpsichord tends to resume its place; not only is it being
manufactured again, but music is composed for it (M. de Falla,
Concerto for harpsichord and five instruments; Francis Poulenc, Rustic
concerto for harpsichord and orchestra). A more modest example is the
flageolet which, considered to have been definitively eliminated
by the German flute, begins to be played again in many countries
(recorder in English). The fact is that its timbre has never been
replaced.!
! 180!
forms are of a more complex character, but the only one
that the philosopher can pose in regard to them concerns
the meaning of the very notion of sonorous form. We can
talk about it only by way of analogy with visual forms.
Whereas it is easy to conceive a principle of unification
arranging a plurality of simultaneously given points in
space, it is more difficult to imagine how we can unify and
arrange a plurality of elements whose characteristic feature
is precisely the fact that they are not given all at once since
they follow each other in a temporal sequence. Yet the
simplest of songs, followed by its refrain, unquestionably
solves this problem. All we have to do is reflect upon the
theoretical conditions that ensure the possibility of this
solution.
If musical sounds fade into the nothingness of
oblivion at the moment of being heard, no relation
between them would be possible. Saint Augustine long
ago observed that the perception of a single sound
requires the intervention of memory: how could we
perceive that it lasts, that it is the same if we do not
already remember it at the moment the ear perceives it?
Like the relation of a sound to itself, the interval between
this sound and another assumes that, in some way or
other, the two successive sounds are simultaneously
present in the hearing. In the case of a simple melody, the
perception of the interval between two successive sounds
therefore implies the persistence in the memory of the
previous sound when the subsequent one supervenes.
Thus the possibility exists of a kind of sonorous space, in
which successive sounds coexist in a certain way thanks to

! 181!
the imagination which is itself the most immediate form of
the memory of sounds.
The confused awareness of this truth explains why
music is so often described as a purely intellectual and
immaterial art despite the fact that its instrumental body
can achieve a considerable mass—what are the
dimensions of the organist compared to those of the
organ? Like all the arts, music consists of sensations which
are produced only in the mind. The very setting in which
sonorous sensations are produced has neither
substantiality nor extension. Sounds, like thoughts,
succeed one another in the mind where they determine
their relations, arrange themselves without letup, and
finally set up orders in the process of breaking up and
reforming. In this respect music, like poetry, is truly an art
that is intellectualized even in its material. In a sense this
most stirring of all the arts is also the most intellectual of
all. For as soon as we proceed a bit further with the
analysis of its material we find a structure composed of
mathematical relationships whose intelligibility had been
perceived by the sensibility long before the reasoning of
the ancient Pythagorians had discovered it. The birth of
musical form requires matter which, in this case, exists
only in memory; hence it requires a mind.
Space permits the orderly arrangement of distinct
elements by fixing them in an orderly relation to each
other or, more simply, in relation to the same center of
reference. Music is also not possible unless there are
sonorous elements that are audible and arrangeable by
virtue of some law. The principle of the discernment of

! 182!
sounds is what is called pitch. From the cradle, the infant
shows a capacity to produce a multitude of sounds of
different pitch, even more than he will be able to produce
later. The infant’s “warbling”, like that of a bird, is
characterized by the fact that it does not contain fixed
intervals, and we would be quite surprised to hear a
regularly structured melody come out of a cradle. Thus for
singing to be possible it was first necessary to create
musical sounds distinguished by intervals separating them,
by way of simple definition. What we know today about
the musical systems prevailing among different peoples
suffices to make it clear that the imagination has enjoyed
free reign in this domain. The distinctions approved in our
musical system between whole notes, half notes and
quarter notes are the product of a collective education.
This education has led to a variety of listening habits,
capable of perceiving the same sounds. This first formal
invention was of considerable importance, since we owe
to it the possibility of a common musical language whose
terms are identifiable and linked to each other through
identical relationships by all those who listen to them. The
possibility for each one of us to produce definite sounds,
maintaining determined relations among them which are
the same for those who produce them as for those who
hear them, is due to this condition. The frequency of a
sound wave determines the pitch of the sound that it
produces; hence any variation in the frequency of
vibrations causes a difference in the pitch of the sound,
and is called an “interval”. A sound remains the same as
long as it is not distinguishable from itself; the perception

! 183!
of an interval, no matter how short, produces another
sound. Therefore the elements joined together by
sonorous forms are these units which, above all, are
distinguished by their different pitches.
How are these elements to be arranged? A major fact
to consider if we want to understand the problems posed
by the music of our own time is that there exists no
absolute necessity for constituting groups of musical
sounds arranged according to this or that order of definite
intervals rather than any other. This indetermination,
which modern music considers as its most valuable
discovery, seeing in it the foundation of its freedom, was
not favorably viewed at first, but rather it was seen as a
serious difficulty from which it had to extricate itself. The
very possibility of a music art was a stake. Any sonorous
order presupposes that a choice has been made among a
certain number of distinctly identifiable sounds, and that
the sounds thus chosen can be situated in an orderly
relation to each other on a common scale, constituted by
the ensemble of these sounds on which they can then be
assigned a definite range or, as is said, a “place”. A “tone
scale” is necessary. The extreme limits of this scale are the
octave intervals which nature herself imposes, but the
intervals can be freely chosen within the octave.
Moreover, the intervals chosen can be arranged
differently, starting from any determined sound or note.
Since antiquity, the different groupings of regularly
constituted intervals permitted the arrangements of
musical sounds by situating them in a place determined by
their pitch within the group. These were the different

! 184!
Greek “modes”, whose study is the concern of the history
of ancient music. After being later replaced by the actual
tone system established on a diatonic scale, they are
progressively resuming their place in musical creation,
thereby giving modern music a freedom of language of
which the tyranny of tonal music threatened to deprive it.
Today all the known modes, practiced by all peoples and
in all times, have regained their right to be heard, even
though all may not enjoy the same success with an
audience. The reason for this is simple. A habit must be
created before a sonorous order perceptible to the ear and
recognizable by the mind can be instituted; it is possible
for several different habits to coexist, but beyond a
(certain limit the multiplicity of orders gives the
impression of disorder. Different sonorous systems get
into each other’s way once they are no longer simple
modifications of the others. Hence the feeling of
strangeness we get upon hearing systems fundamentally
alien to our own systems of scales, tones and modes. But
they are no less viable since they exist, and legitimate as
such since there are auditors who find their sounds
pleasing. The only problem they pose is that of the
possibility of coexistence with respect to the same musical
sensibility. It is hard to imagine that any answers other
than particular ones can be found to this problem which is
a personal one by definition. We all know what music we
like, but none of us knows what music we could develop a
liking for.
The question is posed in an acute form in our day.
Ever since Claude Debussy demonstrated to the Western

! 185!
world that any musician who is master of his art can use
all possible modes, an inexorable logic has led musicians
to ask whether it is necessary to be restricted to any order
arbitrarily chosen in order to structure a musical
composition. Music thus arrived at the concrete
formulation of a question of the highest philosophical
interest. Just as painting that is wholly formless and
reduced to a mere juxtaposition of colors, hues and
shadings, makes us wonder whether painting may not
have ceased to be an art by renouncing not only imitation
but any form at all, so does the “atonal” music of our day
which contents itself with juxtaposing the intervals of the
diatonic scale, pose the question as to whether a musical
art is still possible in the absence of all objectively
necessary formal elements. The philosophical import of
the problem is considerable for it comes back to the
question: is the form of the sensible quality necessarily
required for art to be possible? Now the determination of
form is ultimately intelligible. Therefore we raise the final
question: is art possible without intelligibility?
In keeping with what we have said about art in
general, our answer to this question can only be in the
negative. If artistic beauty is an intelligible entity posited in
sensible apprehension, the beautiful would disappear with
the intelligible, and since intelligibility offers itself to the
sensibility only as form, without it artistic beauty would
disappear. Yet we would not dare to resolve a question of
fact with purely a priori arguments. There are many more
real things in the world of art than are dreamed of in our
philosophy. The recent history of musical art fortunately

! 186!
provides us on this point with an almost experimental
confirmation of the impossibility of art without
intelligibility. A completely atonal music has been
conceptualized and tried. Tonality has been abolished, that
is to say the choice of a note whose absolute pitch
determined the relative pitch of the other notes. Since all
the diatonic or chromatic intervals could be equally
utilized as the musician pleased, the result was complete
sonoric freedom.8 The formal frames of musical thought
ceased to exist at the very same time that these restraints
were lifted. By losing the laws which it had imposed upon
itself, precisely so that it could exist as form, music seems
to have experienced great difficulty in being. Therefore it
has restored frames. “Serial music” has decided to choose
freely each time a series of notes previously deduced from
the diatonic and chromatic scale without any other
obligation—but a strict one—than that of employing
them always in the same order.9 The philosopher as such
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
8
! Whence the name of “dodecaphonic” music given to this
kind of music which is based on the systematic and deliberate use
of twelve half-tones.!
9
! Dodecaphonic music can also be called “serial” music, but
for a particular reason that is of the greatest philosophical interest
because composers had to look for a formal principle of order
other than the tonality which had been rejected, so that a
sonorous structure perceptible to the senses could again become
possible. In other words, it was necessary to emerge from pure
atonality and re-invent a new system to replace it. This is the
series. This is the name given to the sequence of the twelve
successive sounds on the chromatic scale; the order of the
! 187!
has no opinion on the experiment’s chances of success,
but to him it is the visible sign that music cannot exist
without some formal structure perceptible to the ear. Only
the future can tell how far this freedom can be pursued
without leading music back to the void of forms from
which it emerged thanks to the musician’s art. While
waiting, it appears that the rejection of a certain number of
conventions has at least had the effect of destroying the
common musical language which all Europe heard and
understood since the sixteenth century and which, beyond
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
retained sounds is chosen by the composer; once chosen, the
order remains the same from the beginning to the end of the
composition; however, a note can always be replaced by its
octave (since it is the same); in addition, the classic procedure of
variation (multiplicity in the unity of the form) remains applicable
to the series, but in a discipline that is much more strict because
the musician cannot go back to the first note without first having
let all the others be heard. Hence they are not variations except in
the mode of presentation of the series. The latter can be
presented in a direct form, in an inverted form, in retrograde
form, in an inverted retrograde form. Inasmuch as the series of
twelve sounds can be treated in four different forms, it is
conceivable to obtain forty-eight possible forms from it (R. de
Candé, Dictionnaire de la musique, art. “Dodecaphonisme”). These
elementary notions suffice to illustrate the important
philosophical fact that the pure negativity of atonality taken by
itself has made it necessary to invent new laws of composition.
The name given to the series by the musician Hauer, Grundgestalt,
admirably illustrates the necessity of a new formal element in the
art of sound. The transition from atonality to dodecaphonic
series that has occurred in Schoenberg’s work is an event of
primary importance for the philosophy of art.!
! 188!
Europe, has been heard in all civilized countries. Finally,
we can ask ourselves whether music that is good only for
the person who has composed it may not be as legitimate
as that whose language is known by millions of listeners?
But this question brings us from poetics to aesthetics and
although there is a close kinship between the two orders,
they are different.
Assuming a sound scale whose intervals are definite,
included within a gamut of some kind and arranged
according to a tone, mode or series, the succession of
sounds must still form discernible unities composed of
intervals of which the ear approves and even desires to
hear again. Such a sequence of different sounds,
perceptible as an apprehended sonorous whole, is a
“melody”. No music is possible without melody, except
pure rhythm which irresistibly calls for melody, and which
we shall discuss later. Any melody whose notes are
retained in the memory can be heard as a harmony since
the ear has a spontaneous loathing for sounds in close
succession which it would not like to listen to
simultaneously. Melody and harmony are creations of the
mind inventing rules which are in keeping with the
physical nature of sounds and the structure of the human
ear which perceives them. Modern Western music,
established as an art since the sixteenth century and as a
science since Rameau’s Treatise on Harmony (1722), is based
on a melodic and harmonic language whose fruitfulness
confounds the imagination and which is by no means
exhausted. The effect of the rules of this language is to
impart a formal consistency to musical sounds enabling

! 189!
them to be joined in sonorous structures endowed with a
distinct unity and which start out from a life all their own.
But this is not all. Inasmuch as sounds succeed each
other in time, they share in the properties of motion,
notably velocity, measure and rhythm. All three properties
contribute to the formal determination of the musical
sound. The fundamental distinction of velocities are
designated by the vague but expressive words which
Western music borrowed from the Italian to signify them:
lento, adagio, andante, allegro, and presto. The imagination not
only retains the memory of the pitch of sounds but of
their duration as well. This makes it possible to form
groups of sounds of an equal duration. Hence in music
there is a “measure” of time as there is one of space in
geometry. Moreover, the time measure can be symbolized
by agreed upon divisions of space: each group of notes
forming a unity of duration is called a “measure”,
distinguished from the preceding and following one by
drawing a vertical line called a bar. Finally, each note
within the measure or series of measures is distinguished
from others by its characteristic duration and forms, with
some of them particular groups or musical phrases proper
which are the very stuff of which music is made. A
musical phrase is a form, a compound of sounds which
succeed each other at a determined velocity (tempo),
according to a definite measure (quarter time, triple time,
etc.) and whose characteristic rhythm is attributable to the
succession of long or short durations as well as to their
variable stress in strong or weak beats.
The musical phrase is the pre-eminent sonorous form,

! 190!
complete and perfectly defined. The plurality of its
constitutive elements, the ever open possibility of
imparting individual variations to them which, beyond the
notation, even modify the execution, ensure this seemingly
strict system of formal determinations with a flexibility
that confounds the imagination, and at times the ear. To
symbolize the complexity of this problem, it is useful to
picture to ourselves the reader of a musical phrase,
complete in itself and furnished with all the required
indications—notes, key, bar lines, general indication of the
tempo—being reduced to guessing at the form of this
phrase because he has not also been furnished with true
indication of the manner in which the sounds are to be
grouped. The first phrase of Beethoven’s Sixth Symphony
(“The Pastoral”), in itself so simple, changes character
depending upon whether we read it in an edition in which
all its notes are legato, emerging smoothly as though out of
the same mould in the tradition of Kalkbrenner, or in an
edition that makes a staccato note of the “C” of the
second measure and which, by detaching it in some way,
imparts a different articulation and sonorous form to the
phrase. Any consonance can be altered and re-established,
any movement can be accelerated or retarded, any
measure can be slowed down gradually (but at the same
time stressed) through syncopations and breaks of all
kinds, any musical phrase can be transformed through a
simple variation of its rhythm and through the shifting of
one of the accents around which the other sounds group
themselves and receive their total unity and intelligibility as
a musical phrase. The amazing complexity of these formal

! 191!
structures is seen in the simple inspection of a score, in
which the sonorous order is expressed in the form of a
visible spatial order. It has been rightly said that music
must even be beautiful to look at.
The essential fluidity of musical substance explains the
continuous invention of procedures of all kinds
accumulated by musicians in order to endow music at least
with a relative consistence, solidity and stability without
which it could not have form but which its nature,
however, seems to refuse. The whole history of music can
be summoned to testify on this point: the repetition of the
motive, of the passage (da capo), imitation, the canon, the
major and minor variation, the use of the musical theme
up to the invention of the cyclic form as well as the
creation of the major genres of musical composition. All
these, as Schumann rightly observed, have a virtue of their
own. In fact, for the composer they define forms ready to
receive his ideas, and often they are even invitations to
think musically so that these forms may be given the
content they are waiting for in the suite, with its
international dance styles, the prelude, the fugue, the
sonata and its three movements, and the symphony which
is merely a sonata for orchestra. Within each of these
forms, the artist’s inventiveness is ceaselessly working to
press into service the play of tones, the modulations and
infinite resources of orchestration. This attempt to impart
the maximum formal coherence compatible with the
maximum variety and freedom is truly the musical art
itself, taken in the totality of its history, which is here in
question. Even the art of improvisation has its forms and

! 192!
rules; its apparent license is made up of formulas and
tricks of which the musician’s inventiveness makes skilful
use. The very possibility of creating music is at stake here.
Hence there is no reason for taking a tragic view of the
revolt of each generation of composers against forms
bequeathed to it by the previous generation and against
the restraints that such forms imposed. Forms are vexing
only to those who lack the genius to fill them or to subject
them and bend them to their personal requirements. If
Bach were still living, he would continue to invent fugues,
Haydn and Mozart would still find unprecedented themes
in the hackneyed intervals of the scale, and even more
probably they would invent new forms. This is the whole
problem. The musician is free to reject forms bequeathed
by the past, provided only that he create others in their
place. What is inconceivable is a music without form,
because this would be a music without being, and one
which has reverted to the status of noise. Noise can also
have its charm for a while and by chance, but noise is of
the order of nature, and music is an art.
This analysis seems to neglect all too much music’s
power to stir the emotions and to signify. It is a problem
that must be dealt with inevitably, for music by its very
nature is at the very center of the controversy on the role
of imitation in the fine arts. Those who believe that
imitation is not essential to art gladly invoke the example
of music to buttress their thesis; on the other hand, those
who contend that there is no art without a certain measure
of imitation labor hard to prove that imitation exists even
in music, for if it can be found there it will certainly be

! 193!
found everywhere else.
The problem partially bears on questions of language,
which is a matter of convention, and anyway does not
confine itself to strictness in the use of terms. In contrast
the philosopher must be demanding toward his use of
them. Therefore if musical sound does not exist in nature
as we have said but is a creation of art, neither could a
natural musical beauty exist. The beauty of a bird’s song
belongs to the order of natural beauty, not to that of art.
The ear hears it. Attempts have been made to pitch the
song of a nightingale to orchestral music but the two
registers remain alien to each other: the orchestra
furnishes only a kind of sonorous background which is
not even an accompaniment. This is why the attempts of
musicians to insert natural noises, or their imitation, in the
web of a musical discourse merely end up as anecdotal and
picturesque curiosities. The genius of the artist is not here
in question; all that is at stake is to determine whether
noise and sound can be mixed without creating
incongruities. The distinction between the two orders is so
obvious that in our day there have been increased
attempts to compose music out of sound effects, which
would replace music itself. However the ear may react to
this music, which would be a problem of aesthetics, the
mind could not disapprove of a separation in keeping with
the distinction of essences. Imitation will be better served
by noise than by music because there are noises in nature,
whereas even if music likes to make use of them it can
only do so after it has first fashioned them into sounds.
The case of so-called “imitative” music is a corollary

! 194!
of the previous one. The reproduction of natural noises
rarely goes further than the imitation of a rhythm, such as
that of the gallop of a horse, or the thunderbolt of
lightning suggested by the violins. Immediately we see that
no real formal imitation is involved, but only a more or
less remote analogy of which the listener would not even
be aware if the composer and the program did not tell him
by a literary title or an explanatory note what he was being
invited to imagine. Actually, music succeeds only in
imitating itself: it imitates a hunt by sounding French
horns, the fanfare in Siegfried is a fanfare, a peasant dance
is a dance piece, etc. The rest is a matter of convention
and complicity acquiesced to by the listener. The storm
being the domain of noise, composers have often written
“storm” music, but it requires a great deal of goodwill to
take even the storm in the Pastoral Symphony seriously at
the level of simple imitation. As for the Royal Hunt and
Storm staged by Berlioz in “The Trojans”, the composer
was manifestly hoping to kill two birds with one stone,
and even his orchestral imagination could only suggest to
him remote analogies of rhythm and noise in regard to the
imitation of nature. On the other hand, the fanfares of
hunting horns with the help of French horns are a real
imitation of musical themes which real hunting horns
would have found very difficult to execute.
It is much more difficult to realize that music’s
function is not to signify or express anything anymore
than its function is to imitate something in nature. The
difficulty derives from the fact that visual imagination and
intelligence never stand still; it is practically impossible to

! 195!
hear any kind of music without it making us “think of
something”, from which we conclude that since it makes
us think of this something, it therefore is an expression of
it. Implicitly we concede that this is what the music “wants
to say”, but the fact is that music “says” nothing because it
does not speak and it-is not a language.
It is not a language of ideas. Language indeed
expresses ideas inasmuch as it is made up of words or of
conventional gestures attributed to the expression of
certain concepts. Moreover these words are grouped
among themselves according to rules fixed by usage,
which permit the signification of the relations established
by the mind between the objects or actions which the
words signify. Each “part of speech” fulfils a precise
function which contributes to the definition of the
meaning of words and of the sentences that make up
language. Nothing of this sort exists in music. There is no
“musical language” proper. First of all, there is no system
of musical sounds whose function is to signify definite
concepts or feelings. We cannot say father, mother, nor filial
love in music. Consequently, even if such a dictionary of
sounds existed, the relation of the signs between them
would be so different in music from what it is in language
that we would have no trouble in seeing that musical
sounds do not have a signifying function. The notion of
“sentence”, a musical period formed by two phrases, is
equivocal in language and in music. Molière unwittingly
gave a decisive proof of this. No matter how we may
recast and rephrase M. Jourdain’s sentence “Beautiful
marquise, your lovely eyes make me die of love”, it will

! 196!
always be the same sentence. The meaning is the same.
On the other hand, we cannot change the order of sounds
in a musical motif without making it into a different motif.
If it was originally the theme of a fugue, it will be a
different theme and you will have a different fugue. In fact
the musical motif consists of its form and this form
consists of the order and of the very relationships of the
sounds by which it is structured.10
These observations are confirmed by experience. The
hearing of a symphonic work presented as pure sound
does not offer an intelligible meaning to the mind. If the
composer is thinking about something while writing his
music, he is as incapable of expressing it as the listener is
of understanding it. This is why music, when it undertakes
to address itself to the intelligence, enters into a
partnership with written, spoken or sung language, and
from the moment words are involved there is intelligible
language and signification. In this case there is no question
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
10
! On this question see Susanne K. Langer, “On Significance
in Music”, Philosophy in a New Key, A Study in the Symbolism of
Reason, Rite and Art (New York: New American Library, 1948),
ch. VIII, pp. 174-208. The problem is viewed here in all its
aspects. The book is rich in insights and moves with a remarkable
ease through the vast literature on the subject. See in particular p.
178: “Music, on the other hand, is pre-eminently non-
representational.” Let us note from this moment that insofar as
poetry is music, hence a formal art, it does not tolerate any
change in the order of the sounds of which it is composed. In
that case one would be treating it like prose, and it would cease to
exist.!
! 197!
of exceptions. Just as painting cannot expect to find a
great number of spectators sensitive to the pure plastic
quality of forms and colors but must seek the vehicle of
the characteristic beauty that it wills to create in the
imitation of nature, likewise music, though perhaps with
less inevitableness, does not always dare to present itself
alone with the hope of being loved for itself. Hence it
looks for the complicity of the word, to which it commits
itself ever more deeply by proceeding from the song and
the ballad to the Lied;11 or to that of the song wed to
spectacle in which case it becomes theatre, free to
organize itself according to the system of leitmotif. In this
way it becomes a kind of language and makes possible a
musical lexicon in which sonorous forms signify
personages, situations, objects and even intelligible
notions such as “the curse of gold”. Music often joins
with the dance even though in this case it is the dance
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
11
! Everything that has been written about music belongs to
the history of music, and rightly so, because history perforce
must seek music where it is; now music has gone to take up its
abode everywhere, but evidently it is in its pure form that it
reveals its essence. From the moment the word is mixed with it,
or the program, or any sensible emotion linked to what is
something else than musical form alone, the object of the
aesthetic experience is, if we can say so, music +x. The study of
these hybrid forms constitutes nearly the whole history of music,
and how many the masterpieces that we owe to them! We can see
how captivating the history of these mixed genres is by reading
one of the most modest treatments of this subject: “Esquisse
d’une histoire de la romance, depuis son origine jusqu’à nos
jours,” in P. Scudo, Critique et littératures musicales, pp. 282-312.!
! 198!
rather which needs music for reasons which shall be
pointed out later in their proper place. Whatever the
particular form of association to which it consents, or
which it desires to produce, music never enters into it on
the strength of being a language which by itself is capable
of signifying any intelligible notion. This is what is meant
when it is said that music does not speak, or that, by itself,
it says nothing.12
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
12
! The classic exponent of this truth is the former celebrated
professor at the University of Vienna, Edouard Hanslick, Du beau
dans la musique: Essai de réforme de l’esthétique musicale, tr. by Charles
Bannelier, 2nd ed., revised and modified according to the 8th
German edition (Paris: Ph. Maquet, 1893); later sold by
Fischbacker, the work is out of print in French and in German.
Paul Hindemith has assured me that at present (1961) the work is
simply not to be found. Hanslick wrote against the one generally
accepted opinion that “music should express feelings” (p. 9). “I
don’t have to trouble myself moreover about the fact that one
may see (in this essay) the doctrine of an absolute negation of
feeling in music. The rose emits a fragrance, but the expression of
the idea of fragrance is not inherent in it; the forest spreads a
shady freshness, but it does not express the feeling of shade and of
freshness” (ibid.). “A positive proposition corresponds to the
negative one which I formulate thus: the beauty of a musical work is
specific to the music, that is to say it resides in the relationships of
the sounds, without any connection with a sphere of alien,
extra-musical ideas” (p. 10). Hanslick has made the most
felicitous usage of the decisive yet only slightly effective
argument that is drawn from the indifference that music
demonstrates it has toward those feelings that it is supposed to
express. Boyé, a contemporary of Gluck, “presumed to point out
that the melody could be equally fitting, and even more so, to the
! 199!
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
following utterances which say the very opposite, ‘I have found
my Eurydice!’, ‘Nothing equals my happiness!’” (p. 36). Naturally,
the mimicry of the singer can change all that, but it is not music.
Another example: Winterfeld has observed that several very
religious portions of Handel’s Messiah are taken from a collection
of “very secular, indeed erotic” duets composed by Handel in
1711 and 1712 for the Princess-Electress Caroline of Hanover
based on madrigals by Mauro Ortensio. The music of the second
duet: No, di voi non vo’ fidarmi,/ Cieco amor, crudel Beltà;/ Troppo siete
menzognera,/ Lusinghiera Deità! passed without the slightest
modification into the chorus of the first part of the Messiah,
which is especially popular: For unto us a child is born” (pp. 38-39).
“And did not Sebastian Bach put into his Christmas Oratorio
madrigal-like snatches borrowed from his secular cantatas?” (p.
39). In fact, André Pirro informs us, for example, that in the
Christmas Oratorio, the alto’s aria of the second part “comes from
The Choice of Hercules. It was already a lullaby in this work; here the
mother of the child sings it near the crib. It has been pointed out
that Bach transposed this melody through which Pleasure sought
to seduce the young Hercules into a more solemn tonality. In
addition he added the oboes and a flute which plays one octave
above the voice. The coloration of the accompaniment thus
becomes more sombre, and the voice wed to the flute assumes
an almost supernatural character” (J. S. Bach, Paris: F. Alcan,
1910), p. 191. Thus Pleasure is metamorphosed into the Virgin
Mary thanks to a flute and two oboes. Let’s change the subject,
but I must confess that the example of Handel affects me
personally. I heard The Messiah for the first time in my life in
Toronto many, many years ago. The annual performance of the
work there is a rite. I distinctly remember that this chorus was an
enchantment from the very first note; what especially struck me
was the childlike happiness which this exquisite page breathed. But
this is not all, each time that I hear it again, I succumb to the
! 200!
As inevitable as it may be, this proposition naturally
leaves the mind in a state of disbelief; consequently it is
joined with a corrective asserting that music is not the
language of ideas but that of feeling. Nothing would seem
to be more obvious at first sight, for is not music
according to the circumstance gay or sad, passionate or
stirring? In short is it not made to express the affective
states by which man is ordinarily moved? Indeed some
theorists go even further and point out that music has the
gift of expressing a thousand nuances of feeling which
language, and the words of which it is composed, cannot.
As proof of this they point up the fact that nobody has
ever been able to describe exactly in words the gentle or
violent emotions, in any case ceaselessly changing and
infinitely nuanced, with which music affects the listener’s
sensibility.
This is correct, but while music may not express these
feelings, it causes them. The storm, the sea, the mountain
do not express the emotions engendered in us when we
behold them. These natural phenomena affect us with
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
music. “Blind love, cruel Beauty,” the child Jesus each time
receives the homages first destined for the Princess-Electress of
Hanover. Only the words have changed. Hanslick is correct, but
even those who approve do not believe what he says. A different
thesis, expounded with as much ingenuity and penetration, will
be found in the writings of Susanne K. Langer; for example, in
her Problems of Art (New York: Charles Scribner’s Sons, 1957), pp.
80-81; notably this definition of art which the author suggests:
“All art is the creation of perceptible forms expressive of human
feeling” (p. 80).
! 201!
multiple, fleeting or durable impressions, endowed with
characteristic affective tonality which the word is
powerless to express. This is why so many writers begin
their descriptions of these “spectacles of nature” by
frankly declaring their inability to depict in words the
emotions they experienced. Yet, if expression is at stake,
this noble role falls to them because they, at least, say
something about what they see, whereas nature allows
herself only to be seen: she herself says nothing. The same
holds true for music. Besides its formal plasticity it has
naturally the power to stir the emotions of most people;
indeed with some of them it wields an almost unendurable
power over their affective states. A composer, if he so
desires, has the right to use the power over the emotions
of his listeners that sound gives him. Richard Wagner,
who handled this affective power of sounds with
sovereign ease, knew how to retain much pure music in
the most impure of musical genres. Each time music
addresses itself principally to the emotions, whether by
itself or in connection with other arts, its own
contribution is not of the order of signification but of that
of efficient causality. The composer in that case draws on
the reserve of tones, modes, musical instruments and
rhythms at his disposal,13 in short on all that which can
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
13
! Everything essential on this point has been said, and
better than I would be able to do, by a musician who has deeply
reflected upon his art: Roland-Manuel, Sonate que me veux-tu?
Réflexions sur les fins et les moyens de l’art musical (Lausanne: Mermod,
1957), particularly ch. II: “The Fourteenth Fauteuil.” In it I found
what for me was a discovery, penetrating and sprightly
! 202!
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
observations on the ideas of Guy de Chabanon, Observations sur la
musique et principalement sur la métaphysique de l’art, Paris, 1779 (no
author’s name is given). De la musique considerée en elle-même et dans
ses rapports avec la parole, les langues, la poésie et le théâtre, quoted by
Roland-Manuel, op. cit., p. 50. I have not had this latter work in
my hands, but I was able to find in addition to his Observations,
the Mémoires sur les problèmes d’Aristote concernant la musique ... in
Histoire de l’Academie des Inscriptions et Belles-Lettres ... tome 46 (Paris:
Imprimerie Nationale, 1793), years 1779, pp. 285-303; 1780, pp.
304-325; 1780, pp. 326-335. Autobiography: Tableau de quelques
circonstances de ma vie. Précis de ma liaison avec mon frère Maugris ...
Paris, 1795 (posthumous, published by Saint-Ange).
Roland-Manuel elsewhere cites an article by Mathis Lussy,
“Chabanon précurseur de Hanslick” in Gazette musicale de la Suisse
Romande, May 7, 1896. I do not know this work. Let us note
Roland-Manuel’s observation (p. 50): “Chabanon is apparently
the only practitioner of the musical art who has ever succeeded in
piercing the defenses of the French Academy.” This is true. The
French Academy to this day remains a group of men of letters
and personalities who feel no sympathy at all for artists. His
election to the Academy in 1780 was greeted by a chorus of
witticisms. No other musician, as far as I can see, replaced him:
Berlioz, Saint-Saëns, Debussy, Dukas, d’Indy, and still others,
have at one and the same time honored their art and the French
language; it seems that tlle Academy has never given them a
thought. Without asserting it, I must say that I see only one
painter accepted among its members, Albert Besnard. Neither
Poussin, nor Ingres, nor Delacroix were members. Delacroix had
enough difficulty in piercing tlle defenses of the Académie des
Beaux-Arts. Many personal attempts to interest some colleagues
in the possible candidacy of some artists met only with
indifference marked by a touch of astonishment. Since he is no
longer with us, and moreover never knew it, I can now say that I
! 203!
engender in the listener’s sensibility an emotional state
attuned to those in keeping with the words or situations
on which his music comments. The language of such
worksfurnishes the meaning, whereas the music furnishes
or reinforces the appropriate emotion. Moreover, the
music can remain clear by itself, even when we do not
hear or understand the words. It is clear each time, while
acting fully on its own, that it imposes its authority upon
the sensibility of the conquered listener. Whatever his
emotional state may have been during the musical
composition) the artist does not try to make us privy to it,
but rather to engender in us the feelings that he wants us
to experience.
Where, then, must we look for pure music? Wherever
it presents itself, whether by itself and for the sake of the
beauty of the constitutive sonorous forms, whether in
association with other arts but in a way that preserves its
full autonomy therein and where while playing its role it
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
tried to arouse some sympathy for André Lhote as a likely
candidate. The author of several works such as La peinture, le coeur
et l’esprit (Paris: Denoel et Steele, 1933), or De la palette à l’écritoire
(Paris: Correa, 1946), would not have disfigured a society of
servants of the French language; the last person to whom I spoke
replied drily, “He’s a pretty bad painter!” The question was
settled then and there. To know how to talk is to know. The
traditional recruitment for the French Academy is a concrete
experiment in favor of the real distinction between the fine arts
and the arts of language. Among the latter, the modest place
assigned to poetry attests to the same direction. Mallarmé entered
the Academy through the efforts of the charming person of
Henri Mondor.!
! 204!
nevertheless pursues its proper end. Less abstractly, let us
say that we can witness the unfolding of the purest
musical beauty when for the first time we look at the
libretto of the Marriage of Figaro without hearing its music.
Never has so much tonal inventiveness, winged grace, or
aural seductions ever gushed forth so abundantly from
such an unpromising beginning in terms of potential
musical material. To achieve a proper awareness we must
try to place ourselves in this musical comedy libretto just
before the moment when Mozart’s genius, “music itself”,
fused this dust of insignificant words into the unity of
sonorous form with which they have become inseparable
for us. This necessity, created by the artist, masks for HS
the total contingency to which it succeeded at that time
and which it will eternally preserve as long as there are
musicians to play this music and listeners to hear it. Music
is pure to the degree in which, existing only for its own
sake, it is at one and the same time its own cause and its
own end.
This truth is equally valid in cases where music
presents itself alone. It is easier to discern this clearly
despite the fact that music of this kind is not the most
popular. For this very reason all we have to do is turn our
thoughts to the superiority of the string quartet in the
order of symphonic music. The composer has at his
disposal for the creation of beauty only four
homogeneous instruments, covering the entire scale of
sounds from which he must write his music without
recourse to the charm of the diversity of timbres, the
resources of orchestration, or the suggestions of the voice.

! 205!
String quartets are grey, dismal, in a word boring, to those
who do not find sufficient satisfaction in the pleasure of
listening to musical forms emerging into chiselled fullness,
breaking up and ceaselessly being born again under the
fingers of the artists, or rather of the artist in four persons,
who brings the sonorous structure conceived by the
composer into temporary being. But for the listener whose
intelligent attention in some way keeps ahead of the
composer’s intentions, the string quartet clings as much as
possible to the very essence of music. Art gives to each
only that measure of it which he can receive. Moreover
music contents itself with a single listener, who can be the
executant himself; it is in that case entirely present,
provided that it is accepted as it is. The Well-Tempered
Clavier is an outpouring of sonorous intentions, rhythms
and melodies of which a knowledgeable ear never wearies.
Yet these preludes and fugues do not aim at pathos and,
when this effect is obtained, it is that of pure formal
beauty whose presence ends up by stirring the heart.
Hence the emotion is born of the mere presence of an
object which transcends the order of simple nature and of
a material made exclusively for the purpose of satisfying
the demands of the mind of whose expectations it is the
climax. Yet these forms express nothing, and say nothing
else but what they are; indeed, they never give as much
pleasure as when they are listened to for their own sakes
more than for the joy we expect them to give us.
Everything transpires there in the order of pure spiritual
gratuitousness. To the question “What after all does music
contain?” Edouard Hanslick answered simply, “Nothing

! 206!
else but sonorous forms in motion—tönend bewegte
Formen.” 14 It would be a waste of time to attack the
opposite opinion. Even for the creative genius, music is
never anything else except what he can do; all the more
reason then for the modest listener to content himself
with receiving it in the form that is accessible to him.
There are many kinds of music. No doubt it is even a
good thing that there is a kind for all tastes, for the
changing moods of each taste and for all of life’s
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
14
! E. Hanslick, op. cit., p. 49. The notion of form being
derived from visual sensations, it is not applied to sonorous
sensations except as pure metaphor. Since they contain no
meaning, they resemble “words denuded of meaning”. At times,
therefore, we say that sonorous forms are “empty forms”.
Hanslick seems to have foreseen the criticism: “The idea of form
is realized in music in a wholly special way. Sonorous forms are
not empty, but perfectly filled; they cannot be likened to simple
lines limiting a space; they are mind which is embodied and
draws its embodiment from itself” (op. cit., p. 51). A musical
“thought”, a musical “phrase” is a musical form, that is to say an
ensemble of sounds whose relationships are such that the ear and
the mind perceive them as a unity. In this sense, “music, among
all the arts, is the greatest user and destroyer of forms, and in the
least space of time. Modulations, cadences, melodic and
harmonic successions are so used up in a period of fifty or even
thirty years that the composer who is anxious to avoid platitudes
ends up by not being able to make use of them and all his efforts
tend toward the discovery, element by element, of a new musical
phraseology. Without being unjust to a mass of compositions
placed well above the average of their time, it is permissible to
say that they were beautiful” (op. cit., pp. 58-59). Hanslick speaks
of “the plastic quality of the relations of sounds” (p. 72).!
! 207!
circumstances. No kind of music ought to be excluded,
for in the measure that they exist all are legitimate.15 The
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
15
! Hanslick, beyond reproach in his notion of pure music,
made the mistake of wanting musicians to write no other. He
blamed Liszt’s program symphonies: “Since then, we have also
had Tristan and Isolde, The Ring of the Nibelung and the Wagnerian
doctrine of infinite melody, that is to say the absence of form
erected into a principle, the intoxication of opium in the singing
and in the orchestra, for the worship of which a temple has been
especially erected at Bayreuth” (op. cit., p. 10). It would serve no
point to discuss it. Wagner revenged himself by representing
Hanslick, it is said, in the features of the pedant Beckmesser in
the Meistersinger. He was also mistaken and in the same way,
because both confused music and musical drama. Musical drama
includes its music, but it is there as an integrating part of the
drama, and in view of its proper end. The Ring is certainly not an
opera, but it is a Buhnenfestspiel, and where there is a stage, there is
theatre, actors, decors, represented action. Wagner was extremely
aware of it; the musician in him is inseparable from the man of
the theatre, and to wish that theatre music be pure music is a
contradiction in terms. Hanslick rightly states: “It is in pure
contemplation (Anschauung) that a listener enjoys a musical work”
(p. 18), and to define the latter as “the act of attentive audition,
which is nothing else but an attentive consideration of musical
colors”; but Wagner above all desires to interest the spectator in
the whole drama (“Lettre sur la musique”, in Oeuvres en prose de
Richard Wagner, tr. by J. F. Prud’homme and F. Caillé (Paris:
Delagrave, s.d. t. VI, pp. 177-250). The fascination exerted on
him by Weber, whom he saw conduct his works at Dresden,
when he had not yet heard anything of Beethoven (op. cit., p. 189),
is at the cradle of his art. Hanslick’s criticism was mis-addressed,
but he was right on the essence of music.!
! 208!
philosopher does not judge the composer’s art; he tries
only to arrive at its essence for the purpose of knowing it
in itself, such as it is.
No other art has a richer phenomenology. In truth, it
is inexhaustible and its detail goes to infinity. The reason
for this lies in the ambiguity that surrounds the ontological
status of the musical work. Its sole stability comes to it
from the system of written signs which symbolize it. By
writing in an agreed upon language the artist indicates the
sounds that must be produced so that his art may exist as
a tonal fact.16 Incapable of executing it by himself since it
often requires more than one executant, he would even be
incapable of doing so with the desired perfection even
when one executant suffices. Musical thought must
therefore be embodied in human voices, each one of
which reflects a certain personality and marks the work so
deeply with its imprint that we never again find it as it was
at first, when the “creator” of the role revealed its beauty
for the first time. Often, this will require instruments
which are different even within their species. Even more,
differences will exist to such a degree among the
performers who play them that the great executant leaves
a unique mark on the work which he interprets,
sometimes even on the instrument. I think of the special
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
16
! Just as literary art, in its fully developed form,
presupposes the invention of writing, musical art calls into being
a musical notation in order to fix forms and to transmit them.
For the medieval origins of modern musical notation see Histoire
de la musique (Encyclopédie de la Pléiade, I, pp. 689-716); bibliography,
p. 716.!
! 209!
quality of “Louis Diener’s piano”. If it involves an
orchestra, there must be a conductor, without whom the
orchestra hardly exists, but who in turn does not exist at
all without his orchestra. We do not dare to dwell with our
imagination on the fragility of these ensembles endowed
with an intermittent existence, each member of which is a
human being dedicated to the practice of a certain musical
instrument. Such ensembles are formed or dissolved
through many economic and social contingencies in
response to the decision, itself born of the desire that
certain virtual kinds of musical beauties accede to the
actuality of being. A concert or an opera requires listeners
who, motivated by a similar love, set out at the prescribed
hour, interrupting their professional activities and
suspending their family life for a few hours to go to the
place where the music they love to hear will come into
being, thanks in part to the modest financial contribution
which they will make on their own volition. At the
moment the performance is scheduled to begin, we
observe the extraordinary spectacle presented by a concert
hall or an opera house peopled with men and women who
have left everything to take part in a wholly useless work.
“Peopled” is indeed the right word, for they do constitute
a people, temporarily but intimately joined together by
their common love for beauty and united in the
disinterested homage they render to it. This social
grouping, fortuitously brought into being, lasts for two or
three hours, it lives a communal life and expresses its
emotions and passions, after which it breaks up and
disperses in a kind of devout silence, still full of the music

! 210!
which has just died away and with the hope that it might
be reborn again someday. Music is social by essence,
vocation and destination.17 That music which is bought
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
17
! Such was not Kant’s feeling. Music makes noise; in
making music for oneself, one obliges others to listen to it just as
the person who takes a scented handkerchief from his pocket
obliges others to smell it. In 53 of the Critique of Judgment there is
a priceless observation on the impertinence of those who sing
spiritual hymns in their homes, during their family devotions,
without considering the noise they inflict on their neighbors.
Here we would be entering the domain of aesthetics. Let us
merely note the necessary consequence entailed in the traditional
conception of art as expression when its champions come to
judge musical art. Kant recognized that music is the most
agreeable of the arts, but it is enjoyment rather than culture
(“mehr Genuss als Kultur”); judged from the point of view of
reason, its value is less than that of any other art of the beautiful
(53). In that case we enter the domain of aesthetics: “Like every
pleasure it demands frequent changes and does not endure being
repeated many times, under pain of leading to satiety.” The art of
sound is “the language of affective states.” Hence Kant has the
great merit of seeing that since music involves neither concepts
nor definite ideas, its form is that of combined sonorous
sensations, which is the pure truth, but precisely for this reason:
“If we measure the value of the fine arts against the culture
which they impart to sentiment, and against the enlargement of
the faculties which must be combined in judgment for cognition,
then music immediately passes into the lowest place among the
fine arts ... because it brings only sensations to bear” (ibid.). In
addition to the lack of urbanity which we have just talked about,
and which is attributable to the noisy nature of the instruments it
uses, music therefore is sure to see itself despised by those who
! 211!
on records, and which is reproduced mechanically without
even leaving it a chance to make a possible
mistake—which is the mark of life or worse still, that
which is purveyed at home to idle and distracted listeners,
none of whom would make the least personal effort to
participate in the solemnity which is a public musical
performance, is only a shadow of music. Here poetics
must halt at the threshold of aesthetics and even of the
phenomenology of musical life. Let us bear in mind,
however, that the vast mobilization of human lives, of
persons, of talents, of material resources answerable to the
most diverse orders of the economy, industry and finance,
is the concrete result of sonorous images invented in an
earlier time by a Bach, a Mozart, a Beethoven or a
Wagner, and which are still being created today by those
through whom the tradition of the masters is perpetuated.
The fact of Bayreuth is unimaginable, but it is
incontestably real. It would be difficult to find in nature a
more striking image of this creative impulse whose matter,
Bergson said, lies in its wake like a fallout of the mind.

!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
judge art by knowledge. As Voltaire said: “One sings what is too
silly to be said.”!
! 212!
SIX
The Dance

MAN’S OWN BODY is one of the materials that he can


press into the service of art, and it was one of his first
discoveries. The dance brings us to a wholly special order
of the arts whose aim is to impart a formal beauty to the
human being himself: to his body, his soul, or to both
taken together. Arts of this sort raise special problems for
those who practice them as well as for those who merely
enjoy their creations. Man is universally viewed as
something more than the other creatures in the world, and
somehow he is, because he is an object of respect or ought
to be. Man cannot be played like a piano, nor can he be
turned against a wall like an unfinished canvas, and if what
was hoped for is not obtained from him he is not a rough
cast to be smashed into pieces with a hammer, as
Michelangelo used to do at times. The matter of all the
arts of man, as defined in the last chapter, is a living being
which alone would suffice to distinguish them from the
other arts, but it shares the special dignity that is bound up
with the nature of a being endowed with intelligence and a
consciousness whose destiny, according to philosophers,
is in a sense unique, and who has the right, as Kant

! 213!
asserted, to be treated always as an end and never as a
means. These considerations need not necessarily be
explicitly present in the mind of the practitioners of the
arts of this kind; an arcane instinct unfailingly apprizes
them of it.
The infant begins to move around in space as soon as
he is able to do so; it walks, and the grown man continues
to move around in a like manner in order to go from one
place to another. If he is in a hurry, he runs, if the object
to be taken is out of reach, he leaps towards it from where
he stands; he jumps forward to clear an obstacle, or turns
around and goes back to his point of departure. All these
are natural movements and they can be improved in terms
of speed and precision by practicing sports, but they are
alien to art and to the dance because their end is utility,
not beauty.
The same movements can be made for the simple
pleasure of doing them, as can be seen among young
animals, and often among children, not to speak of adults
whose only interest in sports consists in reading the sport
pages. Nothing is more pleasurable for a youthful or still
agile body than to bring all its latent possibilities to bear.
Even the spectator enjoys the sight of a sudden leap which
clears the hurdle. But all this still belongs to the natural
pleasure that follows upon exercise and the easy
performance of a natural function. It is not yet art.
We are much nearer to art, and perhaps have already
come upon it, when we see a child play at moving itself in
a certain manner and instinctively calculate the
movements it plans to make in such a way as to take

! 214!
pleasure in them. The streets of Paris abound with tiny
ballerinas who, while their mothers are chattering away,
sketch the pas de fuite, with a battement on the right, a
battement on the left, and a yanking of the held hand after
which the choreography starts all over again.1 Rarely do
children run without embellishing their course with
fanciful steps invented at pleasure and for pleasure’s sake.
All the games related to hopscotch, and they are legion,
are as many miniature ballets involving their effective
entries, exits and sequences of movement regulated by a
law. At times we even wonder whether some children,
seemingly absorbed in themselves, attain altogether by
chance this immobility and this perfect carriage of the
head where, their faces bent forward and lit up with an
almost imperceptible smile, the eyelids seem to fall like
veils over some secret. Nothing is lacking to make of it a
dance except that all these patterned movements must be
willed, sought for and found, having in view the beauty
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
1
! I recently watched a girl, about five years old, invent a
dance step while her mother was engaged in a conversation in
front of the steps to a large post office. She placed herself in
position on the bottom of the first step, then she stood on the
toes of her right foot; at the very moment that her foot resumed
its normal position, up came her left foot which she placed flatly
on the step; once more she stood on the toes of her right foot, as
her left foot again hit the ground. Then she stood on the toes of
her left foot, with her right foot on the first step, etc. Only a film
could show the successive attempts which the little girl made “to
perfect” this step which she had invented. A simple game, to be
sure, but it contained the material of a possible dance.!
! 215!
proper to them.
The dance is the art which orders the natural bodily
movements by imparting to them a form which is pleasing
in itself, independently of any other end. There are
religious dances, war dances, erotic dances, but it is not in
terms of their ends that they can be art; when they are it is
only as dances. Even those dances that are performed
almost everywhere as artful accomplishments for social or
worldly ends remain alien to the order of the fine arts
regardless of how perfectly they may be executed or the
pleasure they may give, for there is no art without
pleasure, or without pain, for that matter, but the only
pleasure of art as such is the pleasure of the beautiful.2
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
2
! Here I should like to express my appreciation for the
chapters in Système des beaux-arts in which Alain reviews “the
dance and all its varieties: namely politesse, acrobatism, fencing,
horsemanship, and in general all the arts that rid us of timidity,
fear, vertigo and of bashfulness.” These “arts of motion” are
those which “regulate the human body according to ease and
strength, first of all for its own sake.” They are “arts of mimicry”,
thus called “because imitation is the principal means.” (Les arts et
les dieux, Paris: Pléiade), p. 245. Alain is obviously following a
wholly personal path here which it would be useless, and slightly
ridiculous, to discuss. But what does he mean to say? That
imitation is the principal means of learning these arts? Indeed,
but this is true of any act of learning. To learn is first of all to
imitate. Or does he mean that the very substance of these arts
(we mean, what they are) is imitation? But horsemanship doesn’t
imitate anything, one simply rides a horse. Politeness doesn’t
imitate anything, it merely manifests respect for others through
agreed upon acts and attitudes. We teach a child to remove his
! 216!
It is easy but futile to speculate about the origins of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
hat, but once the habit is instilled, he is no longer imitating
anyone, he bares his head, etc. This does not prevent chapters
such as II, ch, 2, “On equestrian art and others”, to formulate
remarks that are correct, penetrating and worthy of reflection.
There is an art of horsemanship, and even several. Elements of
the useful and of the beautiful are found in it (as in fencing);
these arts therefore belong to esthetics (to which all the beautiful
is answerable; but the beauty of the riding-master is that of
horsemanship in its most perfect form; it is this perfection which
is desired for its own sake, beauty being given only into the
bargain. Alain takes no account whatsoever of this fact, but he
perceived it, and this is why any discussion would be futile. Alain
even observed with perfect accuracy that in horsemanship the
spectator must often make something of an effort to discern the
hidden elegance “which at first sight often seems awkward and
ugly” (p. 250). To which, by digging deeper into truth, he adds
these profound observations: “The same difficulty will be found
in mime and in studied dances, where it happens that one first
gets a painful impression. And that is proper to this kind of art
which is a spectacle only by accident, and in which the man who
dances or acts is the best judge; therefore we should never judge
a dance unless we dance ourselves. This genre of art has for its
object the human body, and as a spectator the very person who
dances or practices” (ibid.). Alain seems to be thinking of the Bal
de l’Ecole normale, but the dance as an art of the beautiful is “a
spectacle only by accident”, and its spectator, in the strict sense,
is not the dancer himself. We understand Alain’s conclusion at
the end of ch. V: “There is nothing more silly, anyway one looks
at it, than the person who watches dancing.” From this correct
observation it follows that the dance which Alain has in mind is
not one of the fine arts.!
! 217!
the art of dancing. As with the other arts, all we know
about the dance is what it has become, particularly in the
West where its technique has been enriched with all the
perfection that the creative genius of generations of
dancers and dancing masters have bequeathed to it. The
latter deserve special mention, for teaching and the
schools playa decisive role in the creation and the
preservation of the art of the dance. This teaching also
explains the local, national or continental character of the
forms of this art. Western dance is a natural subject for
the considerations of a philosopher living in the West, but
in no way does it exhaust the possibilities of the dance.
The European dancer, or the dancer of European
tradition, dances mainly with his legs; the dancers of Asia
instead dance primarily with their arms, hands and fingers,
but everywhere dancers tend toward a complete art which
would be a dance involving the whole body.
Since the body is the dancer’s instrument, the choice
of a body with an aptitude for dancing plays the same role
and has the same importance as that of any material in any
art. The sculptor carefully chooses his stone, his marble,
his wood with the work to be wrought in view; so a dance
is not executed with a body chosen at random, and dances
that are different in style will be obtained from different
bodies. Here, as elsewhere, the material of art exists with
the form in view and in turn determines the latter.
It is useful to recall that the art of the dance requires
an ensemble of exceptional physical qualities: strength,
speed, suppleness and endurance which will enable the
dancer to exert the efforts demanded by this art in which

! 218!
the spectator sees only facility, grace, ease of movements,
and absolute mastery over a body free to move at its
pleasure. The Radio City Music Hall Rockettes, famous
for their perfect precision, are never on stage more than
twenty minutes which in effect represents a considerable
physical strain, especially on the part of a group in which
no individual failing is permitted. A doctor’s advice is
required in connection with the choice of a future dancer,
male or female, and his advice and at times his
intercessions will all too often be necessary in the course
of a career in which accidents are to be expected. It is not
enough to want to be a dancer in order to be able to
become one. Here the body has the first and final word.
Different bodies make possible different dances. To
avoid going into detail, which would be interminable since
it involves individual differences, we shall at least note the
primary difference which sex introduces between the art
of the male dancer and that of his female counterpart.
Some men have an almost feminine suppleness and grace
and some women, especially by dint of hard work and
training, can equal or surpass some men in strength, but
the general rule is that the male dancer excels in efforts
that require power, vigor and solidity in terms of balance.
If he moves, he will excel in the leap, or ballon, and most
often will be what is called an “elevation” dancer. All this
can be briefly described by noting that the role of
“porteur”, so frequently assigned to the male dancer, has
no equivalent among female dancers. As a general rule
there is no “porteuse”, and manly strength is always used
to show womanly grace, not inversely. Despite all the

! 219!
reservations that we may make, it must be recognized in
the end that the physical differentiation of bodies entails a
corresponding differentiation in dances.
The same observation applies to individuals. Although
natural beauty is a useful asset to the dancer,3 it is not
indispensable; certain defects can even be advantageous
provided they facilitate the effort and movement proper to
the dance. A feminine dancer with a fairly small head on a
fairly long neck, with legs and arms that are longer than
the average can achieve effects that would be otherwise
impossible. But we also see male and female dancers with
small builds who turn the particularities of their physique
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
3
! On the contrary, natural beauty doesn’t harm; but it is
neither enough nor necessary. The “danseuses” Degas so cruelly
but so perceptively reproduced give rise to the notion that a
woman is not a “danseuse” except when she is dancing. Marcelle
Bourgat, herself a dancer, has stated that while examining those
who are gifted for the dance “one observes that they do not
always have a well-proportioned figure, but that they are
endowed with special qualities” Technique de la danse (Paris: Presses
Universitaires de France, 1946), p. 13. The following remarks,
however, leave nothing more to say: “Njinsky had a below
average build. In soul and body he was professionally deformed.
His Mongol-type face was tied to his body by a very high and
large neck. The muscles of his legs and those of his calves
stretched the material of his trousers and gave him the
appearance of having legs arched backward. His fingers were
short and as though cut at the phalanges. In short, one would
have found it hard to believe that this little monkey with sparse
hair ... was the idol of the public ...,” etc. Jean Cocteau, La
difficulté d’etre (Monaco: Editions du Rocher, 1957), pp. 73-14.!
! 220!
to good account. We should especially bear in mind that
here bodily movement outweighs bodily structure. The
most beautiful Apollo must also be beautiful in motion if
he wants to be a dancer. The history of the great artists of
the dance could provide us with numberless examples of a
fact which everybody has been able to observe, no matter
how slight his interest in this art may be.
When we say that the body in motion is the material
of the dance, we must not forget that a human body is in
question. Intelligence therefore is another requisite of the
would-be dancer, and the gifts of the body must be
complemented by the gifts of the mind. In the first rank
of these gifts must be placed a particular kind of plastic
imagination which enables the individual to see in his
mind the exterior aspect of his body in each of its
movements and each of its possible attitudes. This gift
must be common to the body as well as the mind in order
to ensure its effectiveness, the body being capable of
patterning itself according to the wishes of the mind, as
the latter is of picturing to itself the attitudes and
movements that it wills to obtain from the body. But
language is too analytical to make a faithful translation of
reality. The dance is pre-eminently the domain of the
union of body and mind, or as traditional philosophy—
ever so close to reality—expressed it: their “substantial
union”. The born dancer thinks with his body the way he
dances with his mind. No other art is so completely and
integrally an art of man, understanding thereby the human
being in the organic unity of all his constitutive material
and spiritual elements. This is the reason indeed why there

! 221!
is no human activity which the dance cannot honor with
its contribution. David dancing before the ark is man
offering himself in homage to God. To any degree that he
possesses this gift of imagining his body in space, and
even that of inventing in his mind new plastic forms and
new movements possible from it, the born dancer, homo
saltator, is in the highest degree that soul which “makes use
of a body” mentioned by Plato, or that body which moves
like a soul thinks, as Aristotle put it, because all is mind in
an intelligent being. Like any other art, the dance can be
prostituted, but in the eyes of the philosopher nothing can
strip it of what its essential nobility confers upon it. It is
pre-eminently the art of the human structure as such, or to
express it more simply, the art of the whole man.
Every dancer is a distinct human being and his art will
necessarily bear the imprint of his personality, his body as
well as his soul or his mind. By electing to dedicate himself
to the art of the dance, and in consequence to a life of
arduous training and increasing effort—not without its
rewards, to be sure—the artist nevertheless cannot even
imagine to himself that he will ever dance as he would like
to, but only as he will be able to. His physical and
intellectual predetermination can go just so far, and he is
wise to see it beforehand as a genuine fate. The traditional
classifications of dancers into “noble”, “character”, “semi-
character”, “burlesques” and other distinctions of the
same kind are reminders that, at least to a certain degree,
the dancer’s physique will inevitably control the
development of his career. Among dancers endowed with
eminently superior gifts, the imprint of personality affects

! 222!
the art of the dancer so deeply that it becomes well-nigh
impossible to bring two topflight artists together in the
same recital. Neither the artist nor a public could endure
the absolute dance executed simultaneously in two
different manners, in which both styles bring each other
into question through their very perfection. The history of
the dance provides frequent examples of one of these
brilliant dancers driving out the other by his mere
presence with the help, if necessary, of a generally keen
tactical sense.
Assuming all these gifts are combined in one person,
which in fact can never be known beforehand, the would-
be dancer must still learn how to make good use of them.4
The desire to be a dancer does not excuse one from
learning to dance any more than the desire to paint, to
sculpt or to write excuses one from learning the
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
4
!Here we are considering only the dance of the professional
artist, because his life is consecrated to the dance and because
beauty is the end which he pursues. But we do not at all deny that
social dancing has a beauty of its own. This was even more true
when dances called “low”, or at times “noble”, were performed,
which were only studied manners of walking or bearing oneself.
Going back only to the Middle Ages, such were the gavotte, the
minuet. etc. Even today, danced by professionals, they have a
great charm but their ends are more directly social than artistic;
they are not arts of the beautiful. It is here that Alain’s
observations on the dance as a “purification of passions” is
applicable, Vingt leçons sur les beaux-arts, “Deuxième leçon” (Les
arts et les dieux: Pléiade), pp. 484-485. In order that no truth
deprive other truths of their salience, it suffices that each one be
in its place.!
! 223!
techniques of these arts. This is the moment when the
phenomenon, well-known in the apprenticeship of all the
arts, occurs: the apparent loss of the natural gifts upon
which the hope of a vocation is based. Nothing can be
done without these gifts, but they will bear no fruit if they
are left to themselves. In order to obtain art from them a
passage must be opened to a genre of beauty different
from that of nature and which cannot be achieved without
effort and sacrifice. The person who runs, spins around or
jumps for his own pleasure does not perform movements
that enable him to obtain from his body those positions,
attitudes, and movements necessary to the ends of the
dance. The passage from nature to art requires a technique
transmitted through teaching. It was therefore necessary
to create the elements of an art of human movement
which would enable the prospective dancer to obtain from
his body the desired attitudes, positions and actions with
the minimum of fatigue and the maximum of precision.
Hence this sort of grammar of motion, progressively
invented and codified by artists and teachers, which the
would-be dancer must learn because it contains the
constitutive elements of the dance. These movements
themselves vary according to different national schools
and traditions (Balinese, Hindu, Spanish, Russian dances,
etc.) and the grammars of motion which teach its elements
vary within them. Borrowing between schools and
traditions occurs but less frequently than we might
imagine. Each part of the speech in motion, which is what
a dance is, bears the mark of a definite style which is that
of this speech itself; introduced into a different speech, it

! 224!
tends to break its style and substitute that of the school of
dance from which it derives. The constitutive motor
elements of a style of any dance share in the formal unity
of the style and do not easily lend themselves to
disassociation.
The example closest to us is the style of dance
common today to the countries of Western Europe. It can
be said that it is the joint creation of Italy, France, Spain,5
European Russia and that, more or less, all the peoples of
European civilization have contributed to it. The grammar
of this speech is represented by five elementary positions
of the feet to which as many elementary positions of the
hands were later added. They are far from being the
positions easiest and most natural to man, but experience
and study have shown that those positions, now become
traditional, are the most favorable starting points for the
execution of movements whose sequence, combination
and concatenation constitute the very substance of the
dance. A description of them can be found in the treatises
dealing with the techniques of the dance as it is practiced

!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
5
! If one were to object that the Spanish dance represents a
style all its own, I would not contest this; but in its essence,
perhaps. it has remained a popular dance and in some way natural
rather than artistic. Neither would I object if one were to add that
in this respect it is often more beautiful than the art dances.
Natural beauty often surpasses artistic beauty, but it is not of the
same kind. The “European” style of which I speak includes the
Spanish dance only to the extent that it is not a national dance.!
! 225!
in the West.6 Some examples are the battu, the jeté, the jeté
battu, the entrechat, the pirouette, without forgetting the
pointes, i.e. supporting the foot on the toes, this least
natural of all ways to carry oneself or to walk, and which
partly for this very reason is most manifestly dedicated to
art. These willed restraints are to the dance what the rules
of versification are to poetry. Whatever the school in
which the would-be dancer may be trained, a private
course, a troupe which adopts him or the quasi-official
school of a great opera house, he will progressively have
to master this gymnastic training and learn this syntax of
motion. This will require years of effort, beginning
sometimes in early childhood and extending from the age
of five or six to twenty and beyond. As with all the arts
worthy of this name, the apprenticeship of the dance
never in fact ends except at that age when the strength of
his body fails the dancer. This time comes tragically all too
soon. The violinist’s instrument improves as it ages,
whereas the dancer’s tends to grow heavy and stiffen after
a period of perfection which is coeval with its successes.
Every art of which man himself is the instrument is born,
grows, ages and dies with him.
Whoever says art means technique, and since the
means necessary to create beauty must be first acquired as
though they themselves were the end of art, they tend to
replace it everywhere. It is then that the virtuoso appears,
excellent in himself and necessary because virtuosity is the
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
6
!Marcelle Bourgat, Technique de la danse, ch. IV, “Vocabulaire
traditionelle de la danse classique”, pp. 44-84.!
! 226!
freedom to create beauty. Left to itself it ends up by
substituting the perfection of the means of execution to
that of the work. In this case the virtuoso puts the
resources of a technique, rightly qualified as
“transcendent”, at the service of futility because it enables
him to cope with any difficulty of execution, however
general it may be. The artist proper does not delude
himself on this score. Scudo counselled his
contemporaries to go listen to Chopin rather than Liszt if
they wanted to hear real music being played; although they
differed in matters of painting, Ingres and Delacroix were
both ill at ease when listening to Paganini; on the other
hand, those who knew César Franck assure us that he was
not a particularly brilliant organist, and today we are
amused by certain extraordinary fingerings which he used
in order to get by. But he was a musician.
The dance also has its virtuosi and the dancer is
naturally tempted to show off what he can do. Therefore
he does so not because the arabesque designed by his
body will be beautiful to behold but because the effort
necessary to achieve it will be crowned with success.
Hence the highest possible leaps, the interminably
repeated pirouettes and other exploits of the same kind.
They remind us of the unpleasant impression singers
produce when they manage to hold on to a high note at
the highest range of their voice or hold it for as long as
they can hold their breath. What a relief when the former
become silent and the latter breathe again! The male
dancer is more exposed to this kind of danger than the
female dancer. His normally greater strength tends to

! 227!
bring itself to bear by itself. In that case his virtuosity takes
the particular form of acrobatics. The latter is also an art
of the body in motion which has a beauty of its own, but
it is not one of the fine arts because its principal end is not
to create beauty but to give proof of skill, strength,
suppleness and courage pushed, if necessary, to the point
of rashness.7 The beauty of acrobatics, like that which
accompanies the exercise of gymnastics and sports,
belongs to the order of natural beauty. The acrobatic
dance, in which powerfully muscled men of Herculean
strength throw female dancers of average weight back and
forth between them like a ball, has no relation at all with
the art of the porteur whose object is not to display his
personal strength but rather to show, if only through a
simple effect of contrast, the grace of a female dancer
whom he can set into motion merely by lending her the
support of a finger. Acrobatics has its place in the music
hall or the circus—only fools would disdain its merits; but
it is one of the fatal illnesses of the dance which should be
the art of creating beautiful forms in motion in time and
space by means of the human body. We would not dream
of forbidding those who love acrobatics not to take
delight in them; we are merely inviting them not to
mistake as dance this legitimate object of their taste.
At the other extreme of the art the dance is beset by
the temptation that threatens all the plastic arts:
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
7
! See Alain, Système des beaux-arts, book II, ch. 3, “Des
acrobates”. In it we will find a wholly different approach to the
same problem, but one that is justified in its order.
! 228!
expression. In a time like ours in which architecture itself
lays claim to the expression of feelings, how could the
dance avoid being gnawed by the same ambition? This
desire necessarily leads it to imitation. To imitate for the
sake of expression can become the principal object of the
dance, but in that case it ceases to be itself and is
metamorphosed into another art. Mimicry, according to
Littré, is the art of expressing thoughts through gestures,
and he adds: “mimicry is a language all its own.” Some
mimes have other ambitions. They want merely to show
the beauty of natural movements through the perfection
with which they execute them and, if necessary, by
disclosing their structure through a sort of motor analysis
of the elements that make up such movements. There is in
that case a return to natural beauty which, as we have
already said, often is undeniably superior to that of art
which, we repeat here, is something else entirely. Through
its most ancient origins mimicry, as the very meaning of
the word indicates, has always been an imitative art which
belongs to that of the theatre. What results from it in that
case is pantomime, to which the silent film in the recent
past gave an unexpected development. A Charlie Chaplin,
for example, has demonstrated how creatively inventive
the language of a great mime can be. The fact remains,
however, that being a mime is not the same as being a
dancer.8
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
8
! If usage, king of common language, made law in
philosophy, we could easily maintain the opposite. The art which
the Greeks called mimos, and the Latins mimus, was held by the
latter to be a saltatio. See in this connection the remarkable
! 229!
The evidence of the facts seems to favor the opposite
thesis but it is only because the arts and the philosophy of
art do not have the same end. The latter analyzes, defines
and distinguishes in order not to confuse, whereas artists
making use of a sovereign freedom—at their risk and
peril, to be sure—join, combine, and arrange the resources
of the most disparate arts with no other consideration
save that of pleasing themselves and pleasing the public.
The dance is not mimicry, but insofar as a dancer is master
of his attitudes, gestures and, up to a certain point, even of
his expressions, he can also be a mime. The dance can be
utilized as a kind of mimicry. The dancer in that case
becomes an actor; he can be entrusted with the
representation of a dramatic action in dance form,
whereupon the dance becomes ballet. We are familiar with
the extraordinary development that has been attained in
our day by this charming genre—of which there are
engaging hybrid types—which with the so-called
“Russian” ballet ended up by forming a medley of all the
genres, of which it can be said that it is the form of dance
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
chapter in Abbé du Bos, Réflexions critiques . . . vol. III, section 13:
“De la saltation, ou de l’art du geste, appelée par quelques auteurs
la musique hypocritique.” Here it is not a question of the gesture
of the orator, which accompanies the word, but of that of the
mime which replaces it. See, p. 251, how Cicero and the actor
Roscius fought over who could say the same thing better, Cicero
through words, Roscius through gestures. When Cicero said the
same thing with other words, Roscius repeated it with other
gestures. What is at stake, obviously, is to express and to speak
but no longer to dance, despite the name.!
! 230!
preferred by those who have no real love for the dance.
Strictly speaking, one male or female dancer suffices
for a ballet. Indeed the modern development of this art
tends to make of it one to be executed by soloist virtuosi.
On the other hand tradition here favored performances
conceived as a group composition. There was no ballet
without a “corps de ballet”. Today this collective body of
dancers, where it still manages to survive despite the
prohibitive costs of its upkeep, has been reduced to the
role of a theatrical element whose patterned movements
and ranks of ballerinas with their reappearance on stage in
different costumes give the public a pleasure akin to that
which it gets from the circus. This is the “ballet” billed as
a grand spectacle which is a commercial, indeed almost an
industrial, enterprise requiring a formidable outlay of
funds, bankers, committees of wealthy patrons and
sometimes the State for its support. This composite art
pleases and this fact alone is its justification. There is
always an element of the dance in ballet but it includes
other arts in variable proportions. A ballet is a theatrical
representation in dance form: it requires a play acted by
dancers and mimes (Coppélia, Gisèle); further, it requires the
art of painting for the decor and the costumes; at times, as
in the opera-ballet, it also requires poetry and spoken or
declaimed language; and, finally, music always. The dance
proper, as a distinct art having its proper end, somehow
gets a little lost in the process, but. this is no reason for
disparaging this somewhat mixed genre. This development
of the modern dance is bound up with its history: it has
provided great artists with a public which would probably

! 231!
have been discouraged by the pure dance; the scenario or
the play let the dance get by, so to speak, and it is
impossible to imagine how artists such as Grisi, Taglioni,
Perrot, Nijinsky and so many others, now legendary,
would have been possible without the existence of ballets.
It is simply a question of not mistaking for the dance in its
pure form these spectacles which can be reproached only
for being overgenerous in welcoming all genres—
extending their hospitality even to the cinema.
Thanks to its hybrid character, however, the ballet
renders the philosopher the service of shedding light on
certain problems connected with the nature of the dance.
When we are young there are times when we feel a
desire to dance and as we grow older we long for
moments of this kind. We are thus aware of the fact that
the dance can be a personal pleasure: we can dance for
ourselves, and alone. The dancer who yields to this natural
impulse freely improvises the steps of his dance. Many
professional or semi-professional dancers do the same
thing, as happens still in many Spanish fondas, not,
moreover, without leaning on solidly established traditions
which they are content merely to interpret and vary freely.
Finally, there is no completely formed dancer and master
of the resources of his art who is not capable of
improvising to any kind of music, provided only that the
rhythm is regular and the cadences foreseeable. In all cases
of this kind the dancer is at once the author and
interpreter of his art, like the musician who improvises.
He is still both if, like the musician who executes one of
his own works, the dancer has foreseen and regulated the

! 232!
sequence of his movements in advance. The dance in this
case is one of the arts in which the artist is at once author
and executant. He conceives the idea of the work and
brings it into being.
The opposite necessarily occurs as soon as the dance
changes from an individual to a collective execution. Such
is the case when the “executant” is a group like a corps de
ballet. The executant in this case is subjected to the
directives of personages new to him, namely the
choreographer and the ballet master. The choreographer is
a composer of the dance, similar in his art to the
composer of music. His is a work of creative imagination
in that he foresees the sequence of the plastic forms
unfolding in the dance which upon being joined will
constitute the ballet. His directions can run the gamut of
extreme vagueness to minute specification according to
the nature of the imagined spectacle and the personality of
the dancers who are to carry out his project. The modern
development of ballet has progressively led to the fusion
of different systems of notations which make it possible to
compose a dance almost as one composes a piece of
music. The positions of the body and the movement of
transition do not have the precision of a tone scale nor the
exactness of musical duration, they cannot be “written”
with the strictness achieved by musical scores. Nor has an
agreement yet been reached on a system of notation
common to all choreographers. We can, however, already
reconstitute with sufficient exactness certain
choreographies which in some way bear the name of their
creator, such as Petipa, Fokine, Massine and several

! 233!
others. Thus we can also “revive” a ballet in the
choreography of this or that author. This development
perhaps heralds a time in which the plastic forms of the
dance will furnish the material of definite works, stabilized
through the resources of an appropriate score and as easily
transmittable as are musical compositions today. In
relation to the age when this choreographic repertoire will
have been constituted, as regards the dance, the present
epoch will be what the music of ancient Greece is for us:
only names will be known, but not a single work which
could be put together as an organic whole.
The ballet master seems to play a more modest role
but one that is no less necessary. Anyway, it is a different
role. He ensures the execution and the technical
pinpointing of the dance scores invented by the
choreographers. He can be both ballet master and
choreographer but not necessarily, and he does not always
have the qualities required to perform these two tasks
successfully. If the choreographer can be compared to the
composer of music, the ballet master is comparable to the
orchestra conductor. He must have an exact knowledge of
the technical resources placed at his disposal by the
particular troupe that he is to direct, and the intelligence
and plastic imagination necessary to foresee what the
forms desired by the choreographer will be once they are
realized. Often, moreover, he will need sufficient personal
inventiveness to make these forms realizable, the talent for
assigning the right role to the performers along with the
tact necessary to have them accept them, and finally
exceptional pedagogical gifts so that each performer, and

! 234!
the troupe itself, thoroughly understands what is expected
of each and everyone of them. These are the many
qualities that a choreographer does not necessarily
possess, even if he is a genius, but which the ballet master
must unquestionably possess so that the work may come
into being. Without him it would remain simply a
potentiality.
Among all the arts with which the dance can be
associated, only one is its constant companion, music.
This is not necessary however. Dance without music is
possible. Indeed an adventurous attempt has been made,
not without success, to create a silent ballet Jerome
Robbins, Moves, 1961). Moreover it is not necessary to
have seen a spectacle of this kind for us to imagine its
possibility. The spectacle of a machine in operation whose
movements are accomplished silently with impeccable
measure and rhythm, at times so fascinating to observe, is
enough to convince us that a dance can be performed
without music and without loss of its characteristic beauty.
The kinship of the two arts explains the frequency of their
association. Just as music is made of sonorous forms
succeeding each other in time, so is the dance made up of
human forms in motion in space also succeeding each
other in time. We have already noted that the division and
structuration of time through sounds is easier to achieve
and more precise than that which is achieved with the aid
of forms such as bodily movements. It is therefore natural
for the dancer to demand from sound the temporal
structure within which his dance will be inscribed. It
seems to the spectator in this case that the dancer’s

! 235!
movements participate in the strictness of the measure
and of the rhythm defined by the sounds. In fact Spanish
castanets, rattles, and even the clapping of hands with
which the spectators spontaneously accompany the
dancers attest to the common feeling of this formal
convenience. But when we see a dancer work in silence,
we know that it is an art which is sufficient unto itself and
can create its proper beauty by itself.
No general rule can be cited for the propriety of this
association. First of all it can be considered from the point
of view of the dance or of music. The dance profits from
music to the degree in which the latter has been conceived
with the former in view. This is the case with real dance
music from the primitive tam-tam to jazz and to the
orchestras of opera houses. The musician in that case
conceives his musical forms according to the model of the
plastic forms of a certain type of dance, or, if a ballet is in
question, with an eye to accompanying the execution of
classic and classified dance forms. Listening to a music
thus conceived the choreographer, and even the solo
dancer, know which patterned bodily movements it is
inviting them to execute, which step it is calling forth from
them. In such cases music profits from the dance as much
as the dance profits from music. Since all that is being
demanded of it are measures and rhythms, music is simply
being invited to be itself and to display its own resources
by putting them at the service of another art. The proof of
this is that a great number of musical forms were dance
forms at first: the branle, bourrée, passacaglia, gavotte, minuet,
polonaise, waltz, and so many others, including the round and

! 236!
the gallopade. These have become for the musicians as
many rhythmic frameworks capable of receiving and
sustaining the most varied sonorous forms. There is
nothing that we cannot expect from a tempo di minuetto,
indeed almost anything rather than a minuet!
This is not at all so when the dance, becoming theatre,
acrobatics or mimicry, strays from its proper essence and
by so doing assigns music tasks that are alien to rhythm,
tasks for which it was never made. Only special cases exist
in this respect, too. The only concern of the old comedy-
ballets was to find pretexts for their dancers to dance. In
them the dance had no other reason for being save itself,
and since the spectators often came to the spectacle only
to see the dance, it was enough for them. Campra has
defined the ballet as a dramatic action which is
represented through the dance with the aid of music; but
in fact the steps of the dance were always the same and
therefore represented practically nothing.9 The terms of
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
9
! Pierre Michaut, Histoire du ballet (Paris: Presses
Universitaires de France, 1945). Campra’s definition is quoted
(moreover, as requiring to be broadened today), p. 6. — The
following remark (p. 5) is well wrought to fix the philosopher’s
reflection: “An interpreter of music (the ballet) offers itself,
moreover, as being its physical content, this content which is not at
all lacking in painting, sculpture or architecture, but of which the
art of sounds is destitute.” We clearly see what the author means;
but sounds need no other physical content save themselves.
When the mighty chords of an organ fill a cathedral with sounds
that cause the stained-glass windows to shake, music is not
lacking in physical reality. But we will agree that the building
! 237!
the problem changed when the dramatic action, losing
sight of the exigencies proper to music, burdened the
dance with tasks beyond its means. There was no harm in
trying this, and, besides, the judgments regarding its results
exhibit the infinite variety characteristic of all esthetic
judgments. It seems reasonable, nevertheless, to assert that
it is not a priori certain that any sonorous form can be
translated in visual space into a corresponding plastic
form. The terms of the problem change from the moment
when dramatic action, losing sight of the prerequisites of
music, imposes on the dance tasks beyond its means.
There is no harm in such experimentation and the
judgments to be pronounced on the results will vary to
infinity, like all esthetic judgments. Nevertheless it seems
reasonable to assert that it is not a priori certain that any
sonorous form can be translated in visual space through a
corresponding plastic form. The arabesques performable
by the human body do not correspond to sonorous
arabesques either in suppleness, rapidity or in the number
of possible variations. It is to be feared, therefore, that by
wanting to dance to any music one may end up by spelling
the melomane’s pleasure in listening to the Sixth
Symphony, for example, at the same time that one obliges
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
material of the dance is more corporeal than that of music; it is a
solid. Consequently, it adds nothing to it, except in the mind of
those for whom pure music is not quite complete—that is the
great majority. The observation added by the same author is a
very engaging one: “Finally, as an art of allusions and
transpositions, (the ballet) has only a slight support in reality: it
supports itself on music” (ibid.).!
! 238!
the dancer to create plastic inventions whose meaning is
not in the dance itself but outside it.
The complexity of the problem shows up when it
involves music expressly written for a ballet whose subject
is frankly mimed theatre. We have seen musicians in
various times bend their art to the requirements of
representing a dramatic action. We can understand why
they agree to do so. In order to justify writing so many
operas Camille Saint-Saëns pointed out that a musician has
to earn a living! The ballet has provisionally replaced the
opera as a recipient of benefices; it likewise involves
commissions from wealthy patrons, sometimes rich ladies
tormented by the desire to dance themselves, or to mime,
which seems less difficult to them. In collaborations of
this kind the dance loses all that music gains. The less the
composer is a slave to this kind of dance, the more the
music he writes for it can be beautiful: to risk a personal
impression, Ravel’s Daphnis and Chloë gains in being heard
rather than being seen. On the other hand, the more the
musician forces himself to model his music on different
episodes of a theatrical representation, the less does he
preserve his internal creative compulsions and that
“golden thread” which Schumann called one of the surest
signs of genius. Some music-lovers feel that Stravinsky’s
Petrouchka, captivating and rich as it is in musical
substance, loses as much in not being seen as would an
opera in which the singers’ parts would be suppressed. For
this very reason, perhaps, it is the perfect modern ballet,
that is to say a charming hybrid of a dance that is no
longer altogether dance, and of a music that is no longer

! 239!
purely music. This genre has a beauty of its own which is
its justification for being, but it is good to know what we
are admiring. Concertgoers who are fully satisfied with
scores of this kind at bottom do not truly love either
music or the dance.10 But pure forms are not easily
accessible, and no pleasure that we take in art is
proscribed.
The central problem posed by the arts therefore
remains the same. By dint of trying all manners of possible
combinations, each of the arts spontaneously comes to
prefer those which favor imitation and expression to the
detriment of the formal elements which are its very
substance. Present Gounod with the first prelude of the
Well-Tempered Clavichord and he will cap it with an Ave
Maria; give the same prelude to Fokine and he will find
some way of creating a choreography for it; only the real
musician will find the musical response to Bach’s prelude,
which is to write another from it and we will have the
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
10
!Ordinarily it happens that the spectacle devours the music.
On this point the chapter “Le mimodrame” in Jean Cocteau’s La
difficulté d’être, makes interesting reading, particularly p. 258,
footnote 1. “The music chosen to accompany the action was
Bach’s Passacaglia; it was thus moreover that I saw the work. The
actors got tired of it and asked for a change; the poet decided to
alternate Bach’s Passacaglia and Mozart’s The Magic Flute. By that
he intended to prove ‘how the eye excels the ear in the theatre’. It
will be noted, moreover, that here it was not a question of a
ballet properly so-called, but of a mimodrame even with a touch
of acrobatics. Both actors, who were equally excellent, did not
really dance.”!
! 240!
intellectual Doctor Gradus ad Parnassum.11 Thus for the
dance it cannot be a question either of interpreting a
musical work, which is content to signify itself, or of
imparting to it the physical consistence which some may
think it lacks in comparison to the plastic arts whose
material can be seen, touched and weighed. Thanks to the
dance, music in this way shares in the facilities that the arts
of space offer to the imagination. It is difficult to approve
these ingenious observations except in the way they make
music endurable to those who do not like to listen to it.12
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
11
! The first piece in Debussy’s Children’s Corner suite for
piano. It is a musical portrait of a child bored with practicing who
lets his mind wander from the exercise.
12
!There are very noble impediments to the experience of the
beautiful, notably thought. Those who philosophize on art enjoy
it less purely than those who simply surrender themselves to it
completely: “Music bores me after a little while, and all the more
quickly the more it acts upon me. The fact is that it disturbs what
it has just engendered in me, thoughts, illuminations, types and
premises” (P. Valéry, “Choses tues”, in Oeuvres, Pléiade, tome II,
p. 476). Music makes some people talk, and it makes others
think; in both cases it’s good-bye to music! The same is true of
the dance and Valéry knew this well. When he shows him a
woman dancer, his Socrates asks: “O my friends, what is the
dance truly?” Valéry is amused by the question but his Socrates
continues to talk about it no less unpityingly, until the dancer
Athikté collapses as though dead. She is then restored to her
senses and utters the words with which the dialogue ends: “I was
in thee, O movement, outside of all things . . .” It is the dancer
who faints, but it is Valéry who is restored to his senses. (“L’âme
et la danse”, in Oeuvres, II, pp. 161-162 and 176). — On the
! 241!
But we cannot see what the dance gains thereby. Its
proper nature is not to give a physical content to music
which finds that of sounds sufficient. It is no mediocre
dignity to be an art of the forms of the eminently
intelligent human body in motion. The true source of the
dignity of the dance is to remain faithful to its proper
essence, regardless of the multiple alliances into which it
may be obliged to enter.

!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
philosopher and the dance, see our Introduction aux arts du beau,
Paris: Librarie Philosophique, J. Vrin, 1963), Appendix. Cf.
Susanne K. Langer, Problems of Art; I, the Dynamic Image:
Some philosophical reflections on Dance (New York: Charles
Scribner’s Sons, 1957), pp. 1-12.!
! 242!
SEVEN
Poetry

AMONG THE ARTS of which man is the material, that


which comes after the art of the body is the art of the
mind, poetry. Thought can become the material of art
only because it itself has its own body, namely language,
the embodiment of the word. It is here that we see how all
human art is necessarily carnal. Purely spiritual beings,
who could communicate directly without the means of
audible words in the form of sounds, would perhaps
possess an art of the mind, but we cannot imagine what it
would be like. Poetry is a human art like the rest only
because it first of all addresses itself to the ear. Words,
spoken, heard and understood, constitute its material.
Poetry is a plastic art, like all the others, at least if by
these words we still understand an art of form. However,
we must make an effort similar to that required by the
notion of musical plastic form. First of all the term evokes
in the imagination the genre of the most obvious forms,
that composed of visible and tangible lines and of volumes
arranged in space, solids in short. A plastic material is one
that can be modelled; in the same sense a plastic art is the
art of modelling this or that material, clay, plaster and

243
others of this kind; by extension, drawing is added to the
plastic arts, for even though it does not produce volumes,
it traces their contours and suggests them. We went even
further in speaking of musical plastic form because music
in fact seeks beauty in sonorous forms in motion. A final
extension remains as a possibility, not by taking the word
in a still more figurative sense, but rather by returning to
the most material meaning to which it is here susceptible.
Poetry is a plastic art because the material of which it
consists is suitably receptive to different, numerous forms,
and even infinitely varied forms like those of musical
sounds. We will have to distinguish the principal elements
which make up these forms, but we can be assured in
advance, as in all the cases until now in which it has been
in question, of finding therein a plurality of quantitative
and qualitative elements whose relations are apprehended
by the senses as a unity. Here more than ever we shall be
reminded that this formal unity is perceived by the sensory
apparatus of a rational being whose intellect always
reaches down into the sensibility. The senses of the man
who perceives a plastic form always constructs it, more or
less. This occurs with all the more certainty when language
is the material of the form in question. The fact remains,
however, that poetry is the particular case of poietics in
which the material of the works to be produced consists
of the sounds of an articulated language, taken together
with the ensemble of the quantitative and qualitative
relationships that make it up. Each word, each group of
words, each sentence or element of the sentence in
consequence is perceived as a sonorous form. When

244
forms of this kind are combined in such a way as to
constitute a unity whose aperception pleases and is
desirable for its own sake, the person arranging and
producing them achieves the genre of beauty that we may
expect from language. We call him a “poet” because he
has just “made” these verbal forms endowed with beauty;
indeed, without him they would not exist.
What new element does poetry add to the given
reality? To go back to an ancient formula, hackneyed but
always in order, what is it here that art adds to nature? The
poet in no way creates the substance of his art any more
than does the musician, this other artist of the incorporeal.
He finds his material ready-made in the language, whose
words, structural forms and essential rules he accepts.
There are as many poetries as there are languages. In this
respect, the poet is less master of his material than is the
musician. The latter is largely free to fashion new sounds
and to combine them in accordance with rules that he
himself has posited. If his work is not pleasing he has
failed, but his failure is always relative, for his own ear, at
least, may delight in sonorities that do not yet satisfy the
acoustic sensibility of others. In any case, nothing
prohibits him from trying. On the other hand the poet is
caught on all sides by the restraints of language with its
conventions and its traditional forms provisionally
accepted by those who speak it. He works therefore on a
material that is forced upon him; no matter how he makes
use of it, he will work only on “the words of the tribe”.
What is a word? According to Littré, it is a
monosyllabic or polysyllabic sound, composed of several

245
articulations, which has a meaning. Let us accept this
definition. What strikes us immediately is the word
meaning. In fact the essence of the word is to signify, and
we immediately think of the most obvious meaning that is
attached to it: the ensemble of intelligible notions that it
suggests to the mind. Ordinary intellectual activity, such as
that which we exercise every time we speak, consists in
developing the intelligible content of the meaning of
words, in formulating it into definitions and in structuring
these definitions into judgments, into reasonings destined
to explain or justify the thought. Language presupposes
that these operations have already been accomplished or
assumes their accomplishment as a possibility. Actually,
this is often a gratuitous assumption; whereupon comes
Socrates and his polite question: What are you talking
about? The fact is that the ordinary ends of language are
practical, and that the desire to make it express definite
intelligible knowledge is already tantamount to making a
disinterested use of it, hence not natural. Correctly
speaking, this is to philosophize. But the philosopher
makes no less use of language so that he can signify
himself; as with the ordinary man, which he is at times, as
with the orator, physician, biologist or sociologist, the
kernel of what the word signifies for him is an actual or
virtual cognition which is called its meaning. The usage of
words in the service of intelligible meaning, regardless of
their arrangement, defines the domain of prose. Since it is
a natural usage of words, it is not necessary to know what
prose is in order to know how to make use of it. If there
was a touch of the ludicrous in M. Jourdain’s

246
astonishment, let us share it with him.
But the word has a meaning other than its intelligible
signification. Being a physical fact, perceived by the ear, it
has a sound: there is a considerable variety of language
sounds within a given language, indeed it goes to infinity if
we consider the ensemble of spoken languages. Roughly
speaking, each language has its own sonority within which
innumerable variations are possible. The sound of a word
has affective resonances similar to these accompanying
musical sounds. At the heart of the concept lies the image,
or rather images, flitting about each word mistily like
summer insects around lights. These images can combine
among themselves with an almost total freedom and, at
least, independently of any intelligible necessity. Images have a life
that is not subject to logic, which some minds allow
themselves full freedom to develop for its own sake
without subjecting its play to any extrinsic end. When
words are used for their sound, for the emotional effects
of which they are the cause, for the images to which they
give rise in the present or which they evoke of the past,
and when these images are combined with the emotions
that bring them into being or which they bring into being,
they are like blocks charged with diverse energies, each
one of which can release unforeseeable reactions in the
mind. Thus understood, the word is the material of
poetry. The poet uses it before all else in order to achieve
all those harmonics on which the sensibility and the
imagination are nourished. Persons who are not sensitive
to them live and die without ever knowing what poetry is.
They can be very great minds, or even very great writers.

247
If such persons are forced to take pleasure in poetry—a
most ingenuous form of coercion—they turn against it
and define it, quite naturally, in terms of an objection that
indeed can be levelled at poetry: its lack of what it would
have to possess if it were prose, namely meaning. This
hostile reaction on their part is natural. As Claudel says:
“Order is reason’s pleasure, but disorder is the
imagination’s delight.”
The essential ambiguity proper to the word explains
the complexity of poetry and the difficulty of defining its
nature. If he uses it as a poet, the artist of language
constructs the poem, as Mallarmé said, with words, that is
to say with the word taken in the totality of its possible
meanings. Thus employed, each word strikes home and
resonances of all kinds radiate into the mind from around
its point of impact without our being able to foresee
which of these harmonics will go to seek, among those of
another word, the elected one which will let this very word
spring up along with the whole retinue of its different
resonances. To use words in this way is to make a poetic
use of them; for, this usage not being natural, the person
who applies himself thereto must himself fashion the verbal
structure in which the words will take their place. This
structure is not dictated to him by the rules of logic, no
matter how flexible one might make them; the poet alone
can discover them while producing them. This
sensitiveness to the word as such is the very condition of
the poetic experience; those on whom the word has no
resonant effects are not only incapable of creating poetry,
but of feeling it. The poietic experience is extremely rare,

248
and the esthetic apprehension of the poetical is less
frequent than is believed. Its absence is practically
irremediable, the more so since it is of its essence to be
ignorant of its self. For the conceptual meaning of the
word is included in its harmonics, and since it is the first
meaning which its natural usage imposes it can never be
completely eliminated. Essentially a word conveys
meaning, and where any meaning disappears, the word
itself disappears and any art of language disappears with it.
If poetry is made with words, it is made with all that which
they signify, including their meaning. The very building
material of poetry therefore involves the coessential
temptation to use it with its meaning in view. If the writer
yields to the temptation, he becomes a prose writer again;
if he victoriously defends himself against it, he will be
censured for it as though it were a fault. The non-poet in
that case reiterates what for him is a first principle, closely
related to the very essence of language: when we speak we
do so in order to be understood. Now, rightly, it is not
primarily for this reason that the poet speaks, but rather in
order to create a verbal structure whose real meaning is
the beauty proper to it.
The history of poetry in all countries, but particularly
in France, registers a kind of oscillation between two
poles, being diluted into prose at one extreme or distilled
into an essence unapprehendable by the mind on the
other. Two names will make this clearer. Voltaire
represents the first pole; his formula (which Sainte-Beuve
quotes several times) for ensuring himself of the quality of
French verses, was to put them into prose. Sainte-Beuve

249
added that this explains the dearth of lyric poetry from
which French classic poetry suffered until the birth of
romanticism. 1 Although he pushed the mastery of
versification to the point where this art secretes its own
beauty, fashioned of propriety, justness and polished
elegance of language, Voltaire himself never reached the
level of poetry.2 Mallarmé represents the other pole. Upon
being criticized for his obscurity he replied, paradoxically
but in all truth, that he was really perfectly lucid. Indeed,
since his poetry did not propose “to be understood” it
could not be obscure, and since it offered itself to the taste
of the reader, such as it desired to be, it could rightly
consider itself lucid exactly as it was.3 In short, it is true

1 “Voltaire gave his famous recipe for determining whether


French verse was good or bad: put it in prose! French poetry
followed this path since Malherbe up to the end of the eighteenth
century. Instead of having, as elsewhere, what one would call
sacred balconies, it had only a pavement, if we may speak in this
manner, very ably constructed indeed, but only slightly above
prose.” Sainte-Beuve, Chroniques parisiennes, LXXXII, June 6,
1845; pp. 329-330. See Les grands ecrivains français, XVIII siecle,
“Voltaire”, ed. Maurice Allem (Paris: Garnier), footnote 5.
2 Voltaire himself understood it, since he understood nearly

everything that can be understood without much ado. One day


when someone placed him on an equal footing with Boileau he
protested modestly—and I am sure sincerely—stating that this
was not so but that he did hope that he was not too much below
him. Indeed, but no matter how little below one may be to
Boileau, poetry is no more.
3 Nothing can replace Mallarmé’s very text here, a perfect

prose in which every word is just right, and signifies: “I am not


250
poetry because the problem of its rational intelligibility has
no meaning.
Like music, poetry is an art of time. This does not
mean only that it requires time to perceive a poem, for the
same holds true with respect to an edifice, a statue or a
picture; music and poetry are arts of time in the wholly
particular sense that their works do not have a total
simultaneous existence, like that of the arts of space. A
poem exists materially only in the form of written or
writable signs, juxtaposed in space like the notes of a
musical score but which are not words any more than
musical notes are sounds. Saint Augustine’s justly famous
analyses have demonstrated this. If the genuine poem is
made of words actually heard, no poem ever exists in its
material totality; only one line of poetry at a time can exist
and of this line only one word, and of this word only one
syllable or vocal emission, the whole being structured in
the memory which absorbs its elements to the degree that
the ear perceives them. What is true of the total form of
the poem is first of all true of the elementary sonorous

quibbling with you save about obscurity; no, my dear poet,


except through awkwardness or bungling, I am not obscure from
the instant that one reads me in order to look for what I have
stated above (see footnote 10), or for the manifestation of an art
which avails itself of language—granted that it does this
incidentally, the profound reason for which I know.” Letter to
Edmund Gosse, quoted in Henri Mondor, Autres précisions sur
Mallarmé (Paris: Gallimard, 1961), p. 115. Poetry avails itself of
language incidentally because it does not use words with the
natural ends of speech in view.
251
forms of which it is composed. It is therefore proper to
classify poetry, along with music, the dance and all the arts
whose works depend for their actual existence on the
existence of man himself, among the arts of movement
and of time.
In order to construct relationships in the temporal
sequences of poetry whose structures are perceived as
forms, words must first of all be divided and arranged into
measurable units. Therefore the notion of measure, or
“meter”, is common to poetry and to music, as is seen in
Saint Augustine’s De musica. Hence the invention of verse
which divides discourse into unities of duration of
comparable length. This comparison is possible only
within the same language. In a language obeying the rules
of “quantity”, like Latin, the duration of the verse is
measured by the number of feet it contains; these feet
themselves are made up of short or long syllables, variable
in number and diverse in arrangement, the length of the
verses varying in accordance with the poet’s choice
(hexameter, pentameter, etc.). In French, where the tonic
accent replaces quantity, the number of syllables, or feet,
will play the same role (Alexandrine, verse of eleven, ten
feet, etc.). In any case, a unit of measure is required if only
to permit the licenses that a poet will be able to take with
it. The poetry of every language contains its own metric
system as can be seen simply by leafing through a book,
regardless of its contents. If it claims to be poetry, it is
written in measured phrases of comparable length, in
short, in “verse”.
Rhythm, which consists in defining groups of sounds

252
within the measure whose different durations and speeds
of succession constitute unities apprehended as such,
comes into play, based on the meter.4 Rhythm does not
exist in the signs of language. Belonging only to actual

4 The specificity of the two modes of expression explains


why they combine so badly. From ancient times masters of prose
have advised against the surreptitious introduction of formed
verses into ordinary prose. While reading the Dialogue de l’arbre by
Paul Valéry, there came a moment when I felt a dull malaise
come over me, the cause of which escaped me, when suddenly
two rhymes burst forth:
Tandis qu’à tes chansons mon oreille se fie
Je crains d’être sans gout pour ta philosophie
(While my ear trusts your songs, I fear I have no taste for
your philosophy).
The charm was broken; I thought I heard Bélise, one of
Molière’s learned ladies:
Et les moindres défauts de ce grossier génie
Sont ou le pléonasme ou la cacophonie.
(And the least faults of this gross genius, are either
pleonasms or cacophony).
Thereupon, when I resumed my reading, I noticed that blank
verse had been introduced already for some time in this dialogue
between Lucrèce and Tityre (the philosopher and the poet). It is
troublesome, and Valéry knew it because it is precisely this that
he has Tityre say: “I like your verses indeed, but not your
philosophy: My voice pursues only a shadow of thought. But for
you, great Lucretius, and your secret thirst, what is the word once
it sings? It loses therein its power to pursue the true ...” Nothing
could be more correct. One day I asked him why he had shifted
from prose to verse without warning. Valéry replied simply: “It’s
much easier than prose!” I felt I had been graciously dismissed.
253
verse, that is to say verse that is uttered and sonorous, it
rests upon a duration which can be variable for the same
number of syllables and differently measured through the
relationships of its parts. The variety of poetic rhythm
matches that of musical rhythm, and since it depends
upon the person reading the verse aloud it escapes the
poet to a certain degree in order to bend itself to the will
of the narrator. Like the executant of a musical
composition, the narrator of a poem can regulate at will
the speed of delivery, by slowing down some verses and
groups of verses or, conversely, by reciting at a rapid
tempo without emphasizing the unimportant parts. Sarah
Bernhardt was famous for swiftly dispatching a block of
verses, delimited at her convenience but which she could
endow with a sonorous structure ensuring its unity. She
was also sovereign in the art of arranging silences at will
which would not only affect the total duration of a line of
verse but modify its structure and at times affect its
meaning. How did Racine hear his own line of verse? “Me
voici donc tremblante et seule devant toi?”5 Probably as
do all his readers, with a light caesura in the hemistich.
How did Mme. de Caylus recite it? No doubt in the same
way. But Sarah Bernhardt imagined a different pause, the
effect of which was extraordinary: “Me voici donc/
tremblante et seule/ devant toi.” In this case, the silence
which the mute sound of “seule” imposes dominates the
whole verse, provided that we hear it rather than just see
it. All of us can easily bring to mind many examples of this

5 “Here I am, trembling and alone before you.”


254
power of rhythm, the sovereign creator of sonorous verbal
forms. In a language like French, where the least shift of
the accent of intensity is enough to transform the
constitution of verbal groups and to modify the ensemble
of their equilibrium, there is no limit to the possibilities of
the invention of forms and rhythm. This can be seen in La
Fontaine and Hugo.
Poetry is not the opposite of prose. As we all know
since M. Jourdain, its opposite is verse. Poetry can creep
in everywhere in the form of fleeting intuitions and as
isolated flashes. There is even a poetic prose. The latter
consists in using prose for the ends of poetry, that is to
say to write a prose whose exclusive or principal end is
beauty. Fénelon, Maurice de Guérin, Rimbaud and others
have given remarkable examples of this. They are,
however, relatively rare, the most frequent case being that
of the prose writer whose mind is traversed by poetic
images and who yields to the pleasure of expressing them.
Poetry, in that case, fulfills an ancillary function in the
service of prose and its ends. There is more poetry in the
first chapter of Chateaubriand’s Mémoires d’outre-tombe,
written in prose, than in all of Voltaire’s La Pucelle and La
Henriade, which are in verse. More modestly, but often
with a wholly charming effect, Sainte-Beuve embellished
his literary analyses with images, thereby giving French
romanticism entry into criticism. There is poetry every
time the prose writer, having said what he wanted to say,
gratuitously adds words which are there not to make us
better understand what he is saying, or even to express it
better, but for the sake of their beauty alone. It is

255
noteworthy, moreover, that whereas so many great poets
are also excellent prose writers, the practitioners of poetic
prose run aground when they try their hand at verse.
Chateau briand, an incomparable master of French prose,
was no great shakes as a poet; as for Sainte-Beuve’s
pedestrian muse, careful as he was to limit her flights to
modest altitudes, she rarely succeeded in getting off the
ground. Actually, the very nature of the instrument
compromises the chances of success. To want to write
poetry in prose is a sure way of courting disaster.
It would be wrong therefore to claim that there is no
necessary relation between verse and poetry. The
restrictions of verse, the established rules which the poet
himself often contrives to make even more rigorous than
those which have been handed down by his predecessors,
aim at the creation of a mode of expression which is not
that Of the ordinary word whose end is expression,
information and the communication of ideas or feelings.
Verse reminds the poet of his real function. “Verse,” says
Littré, “is the arrangement of words measured and
cadenced in accordance with certain fixed and determined
rules.” Why these rules and this verbal arithmetic? Are
they not impediments to discourse? Indeed, but this is
versification’s very reason for being. Verse is there to
prevent the poet from speaking. Some persons are
afflicted with a natural gift for versification. To a degree
this was the case with Ovid: quidquid tentaban dicere, versus
erat.6 Others, Voltaire for example, go to infinite pains to

6 “Whatever I tried to say, ended up in verse.”


256
acquire this gift or to bring it to its peak of perfection.
Since their ideal, at bottom, remains that of prose, the
great versifiers imagine they have arrived at poetry when
they succeed in expressing themselves in verse as well as
they would express themselves in prose. In that case they
judge the writings of others in accordance with this
certitude. It’s hard to believe that Voltaire should have
preferred Saint-Lambert’s Saisons to James Thomson’s
treatment of the same theme. He was sure of his judgment
and we cannot imagine how he could have been disabused
of it. Prose has its characteristic beauty; it can even have
incomparable varieties of beauty, but all of them are
directly or indirectly related to the art of expressing
thought, which is an art of the true, not of the beautiful.
Verse and its rules, all the literary forms of which it is the
substance, are the sole language invented by poetry having
its proper end in view. Verse itself is not poetry, but it is
the verbal material created by man with an eye to poetic
form and fashioned to receive it. It was proper to have an
artificial language in order to offer a material suitable to
the forms of the art.
Poets themselves are not in agreement on the
importance that ought to be accorded to the rules of
versification. The fact is they do not all have the same
gifts. The formal restrictions which aid some, hamper
others. Lamartine, Musset, Claudel on the one hand,
Gautier, Baudelaire and Mallarmé on the other represent
two groups, the first of which, above all, includes orators
hoping for opportunities to create poetry out of an ornate
eloquence. Words come easily to them, even in verse; they

257
gladly talk about themselves, the restrictions of verse
throttle their creative drive and at times they express their
impatience with it. The price paid for this freedom is the
lack of solid workmanship which explains the caducity of
the building material and the diminution of their work.
The other group is made up of technicians. They embrace
the restrictions rather than submit to them, being wholly
convinced of their beneficent character, and they look
upon the most arbitrary of formal requirements as useful
challenges.7
Since art in essence remains the same under all the
forms answering to the different materials which it uses, it
was inevitable that poetry, like painting and music, should
waver between its potential two-fold vocation of being
either a plastic art or an art of expression. But poetry finds
itself in a particular situation, owing to the fact that its
material is language. When we ask whether it is possible to
have an art of painting which neither imitates, represents
nor “signifies” something, or anything at all, an affirmative
answer is perforce in order. No doubt, many would

7The author of Emaux et Camées advised the use of hard


matter in all the arts of the beautiful, even poetry:
Oui, l’oeuvre sort plus belle
D’une forme au travail
Rebelle,
Vers, marbre, onyx, émail.
(Yes, the work emerges more beautifully from a form,
rebel to work, verse, marble, onyx, enamel).
He was joining example to the precept.

258
protest that painting of this kind does not interest them at
all; all that can be said in reply is that what they like in
pictures is perhaps not painting. Likewise in music. Those
who would like a musical composition to suggest precise
images to them and, if possible, to recount an intelligible
story, are entirely within their rights and no objections can
be raised. The symphonic poem and all kinds of “program
music” are there to grant them satisfaction. Yet, if they
can say that program music does not interest them, these
same listeners cannot claim that a musical composition
that would not mean anything is outside the realm of
possibility. Innumerable sonatas, quartets, symphonies and
musical pieces of all kinds abundantly attest to the fact
that there is music which tells no story whatsoever and
speaks not. Sounds, colors, and forms have no definite
meaning in themselves. Inasmuch as it is not in their
nature to signify, they can be combined with ends in view
other than signification, to the point where they will
actually have no meaning at all without the result ceasing
to be a work of art.
Does the same hold true for poetry? At bottom this
was the issue at stake in the dispute over pure poetry.
Fought over a formula, the dispute was bound to be
endless and come to no conclusive results, yet it bore the
mark of its time. Pure painting, pure music, pure poetry
are typical phenomena of epochs in which, as a rule,
decadence is tormented by a strange thirst for purity.
The three cases, however, are not entirely comparable,
and it can be easily seen why if we refer to the
considerations on poetry which served as our point of

259
departure. Lines, colors, forms and sounds can signify, but
their signification is not bound up with their nature: it is
not born of necessity. The professor of cosmography
draws two circles on the blackboard: one can represent or
signify the earth, the other the moon. If they are drawn by
the professor of geometry, they signify “circle”, the ideal
object of its definition. Giotto passes by and draws a
circle, his famous O, and it signifies Giotto me fecit. Anyone
can amuse himself by drawing nearly perfect circles on a
sheet of paper. They are circles, they signify nothing.
Likewise with sounds. The blast of a whistle can signify:
Come here! or Stop!, but it can also signify nothing and be
nothing else but the fact of a child amusing himself by
making noise. On the other hand we said that a word
signifying nothing would not be a word; the very notion of
it is contradictory and impossible. If it is the essence of
poetry to be fashioned out of words as its proper material,
an element of signification necessarily enters into the
composition of any poetry.
It does not follow that poetry’s object is to signify
anything whatever: concepts, images or feelings. Poetry
always does this, more or less, but this is not its proper
end; nor is poetry authorized to do so except to the degree
that it can do this without making it impossible for it to
achieve its proper end which is to create beauty with
words, including their meaning, but without linking them
together with their intelligible meaning in view which is
their truth, granted admittance here with a view to beauty.
Truth is the handmaiden of beauty in poetry and nowhere
else. For the love of truth, we ask the friends of truth for

260
permission to assert a truth. If at first sight it troubles
them, a little attention will suffice to familiarize themselves
with it. Beauty is not superior to truth; the very opposite is
true, for truth is being itself present in cognition. The true
always partakes of the intelligible, but artistic beauty
partakes of the intelligible perceived in sensible
experience. In it beauty is linked to the material in the
object and to the body in the percipient. Rather than
deploring this, it should be a matter of rejoicing that man,
made of body and soul, can come into contact even with
sensible beauty, particularly in the objects which he
produces expressly for beauty’s sake. It might be objected
perhaps that if this is the whole story, the beautiful and
the art which produces it are without importance. There
have always been philosophers to assert this proposition
and many more still who think it. This is their prerogative,
provided they are not scandalized by the assertion that art
taken in itself and in the pursuit of its proper end is free to
make use of everything in order to attain it—even of truth
itself if necessary. Poetry makes abundant use of error, for
which it should not be condemned.
We shall halt on the threshold of arguments which
obviously might be interminable. The cause for such
argumentation is inherent in the nature of poetry, for its
material is language which is by far the most spiritualized
of all the materials used by the major arts. A language is at
once a spiritual and corporeal reality in which the word is
a sound informed by a meaning. We do not think without
images, but neither do we imagine without thinking. The
psychosomatic complex which is the signifying word,

261
understood and felt in affective harmonics along with the
accompanying remembrances, is so totally imbued with
spirituality that it offers poetry a material whose formal
vocation would seem to be the true rather than the
beautiful. But we are not asking philosophers to sacrifice
truth to beauty; nor do we forbid them to press beauty
into the service of truth; rather, we would praise them for
doing so, provided only that in the process they do not kill
the beauty whose services they require. In order at the
same time not to wound truth, it is no doubt fitting to
define each transcendental, not in its relation to others but
as it is by itself.
Two sorts of reflections may help us to familiarize
ourselves with this truth which many find paradoxical, and
some almost sacrilegious. First of all, let us mentally pass
in review the ensemble of profound thoughts, or even rare
feelings, that we can find in poets of the first rank. Lyric
poetry contents itself with artful variations on the classic
platitudes about life and death, heaven and earth, the
mutability of seasons and of the human heart. The more
ambitious poets have recourse to ideas, using them solely
as pretexts for literary developments whose banality would
be difficult to deny if they had to be judged by themselves.
If we put back again in the ensemble of the poem the
loftiest thoughts of poets, instead of extracting them from
it in order to provide material for lectures on the
philosophy of Vigny or Hugo, for example, it will become
obvious that these are not thoughts in the speculative and
cognitive sense of the word, but ideological elements
chosen and retained by the writer because they

262
appropriately lend themselves to integration with his work
and to the nourishment or the substance of the poem.
No one has expressed this more aptly than John
Middleton Murry: “We speak, for instance, of thought in
poetry; but if poetry is pure and uncontaminated the
thought it contains is of a different kind from what is
ordinarily called thought: it is perception, not a cogitation,
and in the finest kind of poetry it is a perception of the
general in the particular. But there again, and quite
inevitably, by dragging in these words ‘general’ and
‘particular’, as we are forced to do, we are doing violence
to the unique thing. We are, in spite of ourselves,
assimilating poetic thought to ordinary thought. We
cannot do otherwise: exposition in such a case is
necessarily transposition from one order of reality into
another. How then can one convey the truth that poetic
apprehension and comprehension are of a totally different
kind from the processes we ordinarily understand by those
names? Yet this is a vital point, and unless we have some
grasp of it, a real penetration of poetry is impossible; and
we shall fall into the error of imagining that poetry which
contains the greatest amount of explicit and recognizable
thought is the profoundest poetry.”8
The distinguished English critic’s difficulty is
understandable. It is that of any writer who undertakes to
talk about beauty in anyone of its forms, for we cannot
talk about beauty except to say the truth in regard to it

8J. M. Murry, Keats and Shakespeare (New York: Oxford


University Press, 1925), p. 22.
263
whereas its reality is not of the order of truth. The
philosophers, of whose company I am, who place being
itself at the summit of all, followed by the truth of being
and the goodness of being, fall easy prey to the illusion
that by refusing to identify beauty with truth, or to
subordinate beauty to truth, one sets them over against
each other. This is not necessarily so, for the only thing at
stake is to distinguish them; at the level of abstractions
where transcendentals are in question, we can do no more
than achieve the object completely or miss it completely.
Truth being the object of knowledge, beauty is barely
perceptible except in small dosages and mixed with a
strong proportion of truth, hence of cognition and
intelligibility. This is the very reason why classic French
poetry is the favorite haunt of the platitude. The more
platitudinous it is, the more it feels at home. Désiré Nisard
exhibited no hesitancy on this point. He even extended
this notion to art in general: “What, then, is art in the most
simple acceptation of the word,” he asked, “if it is not the
expression of general truths in a perfect language, that is
to say in perfect conformity with the genius of the country
which speaks it and with the human mind?”9 France has
her art when “she expresses in her turn general truths in a
definitive language.” 10 Cut to measure for Boileau, the
poet destined to formulate the following notion of poetic
beauty:

9 Désiré Nisard, Histoire de la littérature française, vol. I (Paris:


Firmin-Didot, 16th ed., 1889), p. 4.
10 Op. cit., p. 6.

264
“Rien n’est beau que le vrai, le vrai seul est aimable.”11
After that, it will come as no surprise that many minds
find it difficult to accept the notion of beauty desired for
its own sake, and not as a vehicle of truth. It is not that
they are insensitive to works of beauty, but that their
beauty seduces them only in the species of truth that it
serves. Theirs is a desperate plight; they will never love
beauty, for they believe they already love it.
A. E. Housman, who had a deep insight into the
essence of poetry, expressed himself with perfect lucidity
on this point: “If a man is insensible to poetry, it does not
follow that he gets no pleasure from poems. Poems very
seldom consist of poetry and nothing else; and pleasure
can be derived also from their other ingredients. I am
convinced that most readers, when they think that they are
admiring poetry, are deceived by their inability to analyze
their sensations, and that they are admiring not the poetry
of the passage before them but something else in it, which
they like better than poetry.”12 This observation is of an
absolute general character, true of poetry but also of all
other arts without exception. Most people who think they
admire sculpture, painting or music actually admire in
these arts something altogether different which is indeed
found in them and which they prefer to painting, poetry
or music. To determine whether this is a good thing is an

11 “Naught save the true is beautiful, the truth alone is


lovable.”
12 A. E. Housman, “The Name and Nature of Poetry”, in

Selected Prose, Cambridge University Press, p. 185.


265
altogether different problem. The great tradition of
philosophers and moralists wholly approves this attitude
which relegates the arts of the beautiful to their true place,
namely that of amusement and games. Saint Thomas saw
the hallmark of poetry in its “lack of truth” (defectum
veritatis), and we know what Pascal thought about painting
and Kant about music. This is not here in question. Our
concern is merely to ascertain whether such is actually
the case, and of this there can be no doubt.
In a sense nothing is more simple to assert. Perhaps
the good Abbé du Bos who thought that the origin of the
fine arts is traceable to the need to escape from
boredom—and there is much truth in this—said what is
essential on this matter in the most simple terms: “We do
not read a poem for self-instruction, but for the pleasure
of it; and we stop when it no longer has a charm capable
of holding us.” But the professors scarcely admit that we
read a poem for the pleasure that we may find in it. From
ancient times to our day poems have been delivered up as
victims to philology, history, philosophy, and even science.
Ethics is no longer in fashion, but it has heen replaced by
psychoanalysis. In short everything about a poem is of
interest, save the poetry. True enough one cannot venture
a recall to order without incurring the question: “What is
poetry?” And if the answer is that poetry is experienced
but cannot be defined let us acknowledge that there are
good excuses for not talking about it.
If we simply grant first of all that the failure of any
attempt of this kind is inscribed in the nature of things, we
will no doubt recognize one of the most courageous, lucid

266
and penetrating attempts to wrestle successfully with a
problem in the pages of a poet who most assuredly has the
right to speak on this subject, Stéphane Mallarmé. For him
what was undoubtedly at stake was to say what poetry is, if
he could.
“That’s the gist of it. I make music and I call this not
that which can be drawn from the euphonic proximity of
words, this first condition is self-evident, but what lies
beyond this and is magically produced by certain
arrangements of the words in which the latter remain only
in the state of material communication with the reader like
the keys of a piano. Truly this transpires in absolute purity,
between the lines and beyond the glance, without the
intervention of strings and horns as with the orchestra
which is already mechanical; but it is the same thing as the
orchestra, except in a literary relation or silently. Poets of
all times have never done otherwise, and today it is
amusing to be aware of it, that’s all. Use music in the
Greek sense, at bottom signifying idea or rhythm among
relationships; there it is more divine than in public or
symphonic expression.”13
“Very poorly put,” concluded the poet. The opposite
is true. He put it marvelously by defining poetry as
something produced by “certain arrangements of the
words” when the latter act upon the reader as though
materially, in the manner of the keys of a piano, for this is
precisely how poetry, even the most classic, acts upon us.
13Letter to Edmund Gosse, January 10, 1893, published by
Alain Lhombréaud and quoted in Henri Mondor, Autres précisions
sur Mallarmé, p. 115.
267
Every word acts upon the reader without requiring him to
contribute anything of his own save his openness to it.
This is the place to recall that the word is not a mere
sound and that the music of words is a music of signs
taken with the various harmonics they awaken in us,
including their meaning.14 The poet arranges these poetic
unities into poetic sentences whose unity is not necessarily
that of meaning, or it goes beyond it and includes it. As
much intelligence is required to create poetry as to create
music, but in poetry intelligence is employed for a reason

14 I find the same idea, loaded with so much gold and


precious stone by the flood of Claudel’s prose: “Words have
more than the strictly limited meaning assigned to them by the
dictionary. In addition to their power, which is, let us say, useful
to the profit of our personal expression, they wield a charm of
evocation around us, they yield an attraction, they call beyond
logic to the vast resources of our sensibility and our memory.
The word FLOWER ‘this absentee from every bouquet’, as
Mallarmé calls it, in reality rises from countless necessities, and
not only from an actual garden, but from a prodigious flower-bed
of analogies, and, far from pausing at the frontiers of
horticulture, there and then it touches on the most diverse
resemblances and contrasts.” Paul Claudel, L’oeil écoute (Paris:
Gallimard, 6th ed., 1946), pp. 191-192. We must look for the
observation in an essay of 1943 entitled “Les psaumes et la
photographie”. It is interesting to observe that Claudel could not
express this idea without recalling Mallarmé. For it is between
these harmonics of words that the specific poetic meaning is knit,
and this is what Mallarmé never ceased to repeat: poetry is
between the lines, in the white of the pages and in the space
between the lines.
268
other than to understand or to make others understand. It
is employed, literally, to charm.
To achieve this effect poetry must be in the words
before being in the sentences, and the words must be
poetic in themselves, so that to say poetry is made with
words amounts to saying that it is made with poetry. At
the same time it follows therefrom that poetry can be
made only with words that are already poetic. The poet
creates the poem with the poetry latent in the language,
which he finds and does not create. The awareness of this
truth has led many poets to make use of a special
vocabulary, as though poetic language could not be the
same as that of prose. We rightfully poke fun at this
language whose least fault is that it quickly wears out. The
French classics made abundant use of it and this is why
their poetic language has often aged. Yet it must be
understood that this artifice betrays a kind of necessity, or
expresses a wish, to avoid a-poetical or anti-poetical words
as much as possible because it is always difficult to make
poetry out of them and sometimes altogether impossible.
The poet’s first gift seems to be a particularly broad and
keen sensitiveness to the poetic potential with which some
words of the common language are charged. They think of
words which we would never think of summoning into
being so as to create the charm which puts the reader in a
state of poetic receptivity. They know that words are like
the keys of a piano which if properly struck will produce
the sound waves of which music is made. Poetic genius
certainly is attributable to this innate gift, a kind of co-
naturality between a sensibility and the forms of a certain

269
language which enables the writer to demonstrate the
incantatory power of words by choosing them and by
arranging them in such a way that their action is brought
to bear in all its force and which no sin against their
musicality prevents from coming into being, or destroys.
Those who are totally bereft of this gift cannot even have
a feeling for poetry; if they write verse it is but prose, or
else we see something that frequently happens with many
great poets: the most soaring flights of the imagination
collapsing into the flattest kind of prose of which they
themselves seem to be unaware.
The philosophy of art arrives here at the threshold of a
domain that goes beyond it. Mallarmé clearly perceived
the essential nature of poetic being and of the central
place which the word occupies in it as a living complex
whose reverberation in the consciousness creates
innumerable and unforeseeable relations between notions
and images that no logic would ever connect. Gaston
Bachelard’s impressive works, especially perhaps his
Poétique de l’espace, suggest the manner in which this world
of poetical relationships could be subjected to an objective
analysis. The poetic world is not answerable to the
methods of scientific explication: it does not lend itself to
demonstration but it certainly can be explored. This
exploration can even be fruitful in that it will help poets to
acquire a better knowledge of the substance worked by
their art, to avoid some possible errors on the object of
poetry, and to dare to run intelligently calculated risks.
We can already see the limits that such an inquiry
may expect to encounter. First of all, it must always agree

270
to come after poetry. It presupposes the latter for it is the
poet who invents, the philosopher being able to do no
more than to observe. It will agree, moreover, not to limit
the poetic substance of the word to the single images that
it evokes in the consciousness, even by charging them
with all the affective resonances that one would like. A
unique, organic, vital, intimate entological relationship
exists between the word and man that will always defy
analysis. Except in the case of singing, which is language,
music itself utilizes a material that is less humanized than
poetry which is fashioned out of human ingredients. It is
in this sense that the poet is the most creative of artists in
the cases, very rare to be sure, in which what he creates is
truly poetry. He creates, in that he extracts the substance
of his work only from himself and in that he does so
without for an instant ceasing to remain free toward it as
toward himself. This is the realm in which Bergsonian
freedom is truly at home: namely that of a freedom
anterior to causality.
Thus linked to the word, poetry is not completely
perceptible except to those whom a vital relationship
unites to the language it uses and who not only understand
the meaning of words and sentences but hear their sound
when they read it. There is something awesome in the
thought of the immense contingency that prevails in the
world of poetic reality. If the beauty of the poems of
Theocritus and Virgil is closely related to the particular
musicality of their respective languages, what would we
understand of it today inasmuch as we do not know how
to speak it as they spoke it, nor hear it as they heard it?

271
The pronunciation, elocution and diction within every
language change with time. Do we today hear Corneille
and Racine as they heard themselves? Speaking more
generally, if we may push this problem to its extreme,
what is the meaning of this agreed upon admiration for
the world’s classical literature whose language we have
never heard and which we pronounce, as is said, in the
modern way? The problem would be different if it
concerned prose whose proper function is information
and the transmission of knowledge. But when it is a
question of poetry, whose formal beauty is inseparable
from the music of language, what remains of it where this
language is missing?
Merely to glimpse a response to this question makes
us dizzy, for Virgil would be able to recognize nothing in
the poetry of the Georgics, deprived of its hard “c”, of its
diphthongs, of its tonal accents and of its syllabic quantity
as we, however, loved it in our distant student days. Hence
the teaching of the classical poets, as well as that of
modern poets using foreign languages which those who
teach them at times speak in a comic way, is in reality a
misunderstanding and bears on something other than
poetry. The poets in that case become mere pretexts to
push further the study of their language, a function which
their abnormal grammatical constructions predestine them
to fulfill. As for works in translation that are assigned for
study, obviously nothing of their poetic content remains.
What is The Tempest translated into French, if not The
Tempest translated into prose? What is most remarkable is
that the translators scarcely perceive this and that the

272
spectators feel no discomfort. The French acting
companies who pushed innocence so far as to perform a
translation of Hamlet in England really believed they were
playing Hamlet, and the French who see this translation
played in France really believe they are hearing Hamlet.
Indeed, they do hear all of it, except the poetry. It is an
impressive sign of the richness of his dramatic art that
even when it is stripped of its poetry, what remains of
Shakespeare can pass for it.
There is a general contingency which comes before
these particular ones which affects poetry in all languages,
in its very substance. Up to now for the convenience of
exposition we have talked equally about poetry read aloud
and actually heard or about poetry simply read in the
silence of a mind that speaks to itself. Is the same thing at
stake both times? Is the substance of the poetry the same
in both cases?
This problem is born of the conditions of existence
proper to the poem. Since everybody knows how to speak
some language, everybody early in life possesses the
natural building material of poetry. The technique of
versification—which Abbé du Bos called the “mechanics”
of poetry—is a relatively easy apprenticeship in most
civilized languages. In French it is ridiculously easy. All
that is required is the ability to count syllables up to twelve
and to amuse oneself by looking in a rhyming dictionary
for words that end in similar sounds. Thus the number of
rhymers is considerable. True enough, the rules,
assonances, alliterations, interior rhymes and all the
subtleties of the ear or of the meaning of words and of

273
their nuances can be refined to infinity, but in that case we
are embarking on the dangerous path of pure and simple
fabrication in which this or that modern poet has all too
often lost his way, and the danger of imitating Jean
Baptiste Rousseau is all the more serious because it is not
necessary to step out of the common usage of language to
expose oneself to it. At most one adds to it the skills of
the grammarian, which smell of midnight oil.
In this respect the poet resembles the musician who
would be able to execute all his own works for the reason
that from early youth he had a good voice, and knew the
art of singing and of playing an instrument. In fact the
musician can imagine more or less perfectly the effect that
his music will produce; he can hum some fragments of it
with the “voice of a composer” but he does not by nature
have the means to impart to his music the actual existence
that only a good execution can do. On the other hand the
poet can be his own executant. He himself can talk his
poetry and, as is said, “recite his verses”, but the passage
from thought verse to verse recited in a loud voice, or
even in a low voice, profoundly modifies its nature.
Spoken verse is a physical reality; it is composed of
sounds, hence first of all of sonorous vibrations which can
be measured with the aid of specially built instruments and
whose relationships can be calculated. Phoneticians have
shown a great interest in verse as vocal emissions. Verse
read silently is also answerable to the word, but to what is
called “the interior word”, whose substance is not made
up of sounds but of images of sounds; this material
distinction affects the respective modes of existence of

274
these two kinds of poetry. Psychology and psycho-
psychology alone are competent exactly to define these
two modes of existence, all the philosopher need know is
that they are different. The image of a sound is not a
sound; if he wants to change the sonorous image into a
real sound, the poet himself will have to choose between
several possibilities each one of which excludes the others.
If the poet is replaced by a narrator, he is at the mercy of
interpreters as much as are composers. The same verses
will be recited by different interpreters; they can even be
recited in many different ways by the same interpreter “by
varying the tone”, without it being possible to ensure that
one of them is good to the point of excluding the others.15

15 The ancient custom of public recitations, not to go as far


back as the sung and recited poetry of the bards of the high
Middle Ages and their successors, produced a poetry which,
having been made through the word, naturally returns to the
word. But it would be quite interesting to hear a record of several
pages of the Aeneid read by Virgil himself. In our day,
overlooking the individual differences in pronunciation and of
voice (Claudel with his Tardenois accent reads his own poems
admirably), the problem of passing from the poem to the interior
word to that of the external word is still with us. Many excellent
actors read poetry badly, they believe they must act it, which is
quite natural since acting is their trade. Among those who read
(Jacques Copeau did not act his poets, not even Péguy) there is
no one, so to speak, who does not feel the necessity of adopting
for this purpose a particular tone of voice and delivery,
somewhere between speech and song. They are right, but they
themselves know what a monotony ensues if the reading is
prolonged. The result of this situation is that the purer the
275
Everything alters in the physical substance of the line of
verse in keeping with each of these alterations; the pitch of
the sound and the timbre, the speed of the delivery which
is the very movement of poetry, the arabesque of the
verses which varies in accordance with the different
pauses imposed on the same verses by those reciting
them. And more still. When we hear the verses of the
same poet read by two different interpreters, especially if
they are professionals, we note that each one of them has
his personal conception of the art of reciting verse, being
either cadenced, musical and almost sung or, in contrast,
broken, closer to prose, and full of surprises and turnings.
We would be led to believe in that case that the same poet
wrote two kinds of poetry, that both bear his name and
nothing about either of them, moreover, guarantees that
the poet himself would recognize them as his own.
But when we think a line of verse, what is it? Actually,
most of the time we don’t know. The interior word is
quicker than the exterior word; we never read as slowly
silently as when we read aloud. Compared to thought,
speech is slower and longer. Interior sounds lack the
vigorous articulations of the actual word, but on the other
hand they have a more flexible, more subtle, more delicate
musicality which permits the mental combinations of
sonorous images difficult to materialize in the form of real
and actually perceived sounds. By virtue of examples,
poetry, the more difficult it is to read it aloud. The reality of the
problem is confirmed by a curious passage in Montaigne, Essais,
book II, ch. XII, ed. A. Thibaudet, Pléiade, p. 577: “And Zeno
was right to say that the voice was the flower of beauty ... ”, etc.
276
leaving each one free to find his own, we can ask whether
there may not exist at least two types of poets, one whose
poetry is made to be heard like that of Malherbe or of
Hugo, and others whose poetry often seems to lose
something when recited, like that of Racan in his best
moments and, almost always, La Fontaine or Racine. We
are so accustomed to hearing it so wonderfully in
ourselves that it becomes practically impossible to find a
voice that would impart an actual existence to it without
robbing it of some element of its perfection. Such
statements infuriate some of the admirers of these poets.
Immediately they quote: “Le jour n’est pas plus pur que
le fond de mon coeur”,16 which according to Valéry is
“the most beautiful line of verse”. But it is precisely this
line of verse, so delightful as a thought, that is so difficult
to recite. The actor instinctively lowers his voice in order
to attenuate the triple shock that the hammering of the
three successive p’s inflict upon the ear. These accidents
are rare, but it is when he is perfect that Racine floats in
the memory above any possible diction. The material
music of the voice puts to flight the imaginary music of
the simple verbal images, ever more etherealized thanks to
their very unreality. In that case the same verses are no
longer in question. No actress, not even Julia Bartet, has
ever been able to recite “Que le jour recommence et que
le jour finisse ...”17 as well as we recite it to ourselves,
simply because we do not say it at all.18 All we have to do
16 “The day is not more pure than the bottom of my heart.”
17 “May the day start again, and may the day end.”
18 How often have we not had public readings of the fables

277
is to try it in order to be convinced that we ourselves do
not know how we would like to hear this or that line of
verse or this or that sentence from Chateaubriand or
Senancour because the sounds that we expect have no
possible existence in reality. All poetry is not of this
nature. On the contrary, Shakespeare never loses when his
lines are spoken and Corneille’s verse always gains when it
is recited.
Philosophical reflection must limit itself to a definition
of La Fontaine? They are perfectly rendered insofar as they can
be acted: as regards the specific poetical element (Les alouettes
font leur nid ... ) the more it dominates, the less is the success
complete. Each one of us can try the following on ourselves:
Volupté, Volupté, qui fus jadis maîtresse
Du plus bel esprit de la Grèce,
Ne me dédaigne pas; viens-t’en loger chez moi;
Tu n’y sera pas sans emploi.
J’aime le jeu, l’amour, les livres, la musique,
La ville et la campagne, enfin tout: il n’est rien
Qui ne me soit souverain bien,
Jusqu’au sombre plaisir d’un coeur mélancolique.
(Pleasure, Pleasure, in olden times the mistress of the finest
mind of Greece, Disdain me not; come live with me; You will
not be idle. I love games, love, books, music, the city and the
country, in short, everything; there is naught that would not be a
sovereign good to me, including the sombre delight of a
melancholy heart).
These verses are found in The Loves of Psyche and Cupid. Not a
trace of hermeticism. It is not even necessary to name “this finest
mind of Greece”. Everything is simple; we would think it is
everybody’s language, but the voice puts to flight this victory
w’nged with leaden sandals.
278
of the general postulates of the problem with respect to so
contingent a matter in which judgment ultimately depends
upon the personal and ever mutable dispositions of the
judge. Let us once more recall, since this opportunity is
afforded us by a subject which unleashed the interminable
controversies over “pure poetry”, that poietics does not
pronounce any esthetic judgment upon any kind of poetry
or poetic work. Rather it would invite us to the reflection
that no monopoly is justified in this regard. If there is one
point on which the most resolute defenders have agreed
with their opponents, it is that which holds that “pure poetry
is an abstraction”. As A. C. Bradley says in his Oxford
Lectures on Poetry, which Henri Bremond quotes in
this connection, “something which would be nothing else
but poetry” does not exist in nature.19 In contrast to what

19 After finishing the revision of this chapter, I wanted to re-


read Henri Bremond, Prière et poésie. The experience was
discouraging, because he has said everything, and the spirit of
gladness that animates the book makes one doubt that a
philosopher would be wise to touch upon the subject. But
perhaps a little philosophy may be necessary in order to prevent
poetry from evaporating once more, even if this time it would be
at the side of prayer. Poetry is not prayer either in actuality or by
analogy. In order to convince ourselves it suffices to re-read in
the last page of the book (p. 221) what a spiritual author, M.
Hamar, says about prayer: “The concern to find words greatly
harms the movement of the heart.” But this concern is the
greatest one the poet has. His poietic activity is totally different
from the mystic passivity of the saint: pati divina. This said, La
poésie pure, a lecture delivered to a public meeting of five
279
the heralds of pure poetry since Poe think, it is not
didacticism which puts it to flight. There is no didacticism,
no matter how abstract, from which a poet cannot make
the purest poetry gush forth: De rerum natura, Georgicon liber,
la Divina Commedia. Didacticism can become poetry,
nonsense can become poetry:
“L’air est plein d’une haleine de roses,
Tous les vents tiennent leurs bouches closes,
Et Ie soleil semble sortir de l’onde
Pour quelque amour plus que pour luire au monde.”20
All we have to do is to surrender to the charm, without
thinking about it.
It is with difficulty that we resign ourselves to
admitting a failure to distinguish the poetry from the
poem, as A. E. Housman so pertinently recommends. For
it is quite true that many love everything about a poem
except its poetry, but the fact is that the rest can merit
being loved. How manifold the beauties in The Divine
Comedy! The grandeur of the subject, the loftiness of the
feelings, the moral nobility of the passion for justice which
animates the whole work, the creative power that
resuscitates so many personages, illustrious or not, but all
restored to life by the poet’s imagination; let us not forget

Academies, on October 24, 1925, will mark a date in the history


of French letters. Or at least we would like to hope so.
20 “ The air is full of the fragrance of roses,

All the winds keep their mouths closed,


And the sun seems to rise from the wave
More for some love than to shine on the world. ”
280
the universal history seen in the history of Rome, nor the
philosophy, nor the theology expounded in the work, each
of which has its characteristic beauty. Never was the rule
of the cumulative act of different kinds of beauty
confirmed more strikingly than in the sacro poema. But its
poetic beauty is attributable to another thing, to that
element of pure poetry which flows and circulates
throughout this grandiose epic, now offering itself openly
as a lyrical outburst, now informing privately so many
erudite expositions—we know not how many—over
which it throws a poetic mantle. Dante’s poem is
doubtlessly a greater work than Petrarch’s collection of
sonnets, but to ascertain whether there is more poetry in
the one or the other work is a meaningless undertaking.
More particular kinds of beauty, yes, but more poetic
beauty? Boileau himself had doubts on this score: “A
flawless sonnet ...” The fact is that the notion of more, or
of greater, is not really applicable to the quality that is
poetry. Poetry is, or is not. It is an absolute: Rien, cette
écume, vierge vers à ne désigner que la coupe ... Once we
begin to make comparisons, the poem has already taken
flight.

281
EIGHT
The Theatre

POETRY CAN HARDLY BE discussed without bringing up


the subject of the theatre, for which many poets, including
the greatest, have labored, but it is possible to discuss the
theatre without including poetry in a descriptive analysis.
There is poetic drama, just as there is musical drama, and
dance theatre. Like architecture, the theatre is receptive to
all the other arts, indeed it could hardly exist without
recourse to several among them, but it does not consist of
any of them in particular. Richard Wagner was a dramatist
of the first rank, a fact confirmed by the precise directions
regarding decor and changes of scenery contained in his
librettos. Here music dominates everything, but it is so far
from being pure music that, as music, it suffers an obvious
loss when it is stripped of dramatic action and of the
elaborate staging that accompanies it in the theatre.
Wagner was a man of the theatre to his fingertips, and
pure music is not to be found with him. Neither do we
come upon pure poetry in the theatre. Keats or Shelley,
rather than Shakespeare, represent poetry desired for its
own sake, with no other end in view. As the poet A. E.
Housman tried to put it: “I call William Blake more poetic

282
than Shakespeare, although Shakespeare contains so much
more poetry … !”1 The names of famous dramatists are
the first to come to mind, precisely because they are less
purely poets than the writers of lyric poetry and because
poetry has only relatively few faithful followers. Poetry
compromises itself with the theatre, as do music and
dance with the ballet, at times out of a liking for the
theatre, often simply to earn a living for its practitioners.2

1 A. E. Housman, op. cit., p. 57.


2 Camille Saint-Saëns was not afraid to recognize that the

reason why he wrote so many operas was that music for the
theatre was the only kind which at times enabled a composer to
earn enough money to live on. Nothing could be more legitimate,
but he was jealous of Wagner’s success and stubbornly
contended that his music was as good as that of the German
composer. Perhaps it is, but this is not the question. Wagner’s
music was essentially theatrical; this is precisely why Saint-Saëns’
music is closer to pure music, that is to say, it never succeeded in
animating his operas. Too many musicians have paid dearly for
disdaining this distinction. A good libretto is essential for an
opera to be a theatrical work. The Marriage of Figaro, The Barber of
Seville, Faust, Carmen, Pelléas and Mélisande have good librettos, and
they are played; Fidelio has a bad libretto, and it is played rarely,
and only out of deference to Beethoven; Ariadne and Bluebeard by
Paul Dukas has an execrable libretto and despite its admirable
music, the work has been a fiasco every time that a theatre has
been found to revive it. On one occasion, someone in my
presence was criticising a French novelist, commenting on the
dryness of his character. I defended him by pointing to his love
of music, especially Mozart. “No,” replied the speaker, “he does
not love Mozart, he loves Don Juan.” Let us acknowledge, at least,
283
In Chapter IV of his Poetics, Aristotle asserts that
tragedy and comedy emerged from the epic through a
spontaneous evolution. This provides food for thought. In
the beginning was Homer and others who like Homer
were animated by a powerful imitative instinct. Those with
noble-minded souls imitated noble actions by portraying
them in their poems; those with souls made of more
common stuff imitated common actions and held them up
to censure in their satires. Thus the distinction between
tragedy and comedy made itself manifest from the start. In
this historical perspective, Homer’s noble works (the Iliad
and the Odyssey) and his common works (the Margites and
other similar creations) were already tragedies and
comedies because they were dramatic accounts imitating
human events. They were plays with one or more
characters impersonated by the author alone.
It is not certain that Aristotle has an altogether clear
view of this problem.3 The transition from epic to tragedy
that Molière’s Don Juan is a good libretto, but its failure proves
that the subject is not everything, even in the theatre.
3 I would not dare to affirm it outright, not because it was

Aristotle, but because he was very intelligent. Naturally, he noted


that “tragedy … is an imitation of action that is serious and also,
having magnitude complete in itself, in language with pleasurable
accessories, each kind brought in separately in the parts of the
work, in a dramatic, not in a narrative form …” in the Poetics, VI,
1449b 25-26, Introduction to Aristotle, ed. by Richard McKeon
(New York: Random House, The Modern Library, 1941), p. 631.
This is precise to the point of perfection; it is merely a question
of determining whether tragedy is still poetry. Racine believed it
was: Principles de la tragédie, the text of Racine’s notes on the
284
implies a change of genre; they differ, as we said formerly,
toto genere, because it is the genre of poetry carried over to
the theatre, hence from one major art to another. This

margin of Aristotle’s Poetics, established by Eugène Vinaver


(Paris: Librairie Nizet, 1951). See the author’s cogent
observations on p. 45. “That Racine interpreted his task as poet
in this way is attested to by his theatre, which lends itself so little
to definition and which escapes any attempt at reduction to the
tragic type” (p. 45). For Racine, in fact, tragedy is an epic in
dialogue form, something generically different from a play.
Seemingly Sainte-Beuve—hardly a naive person!—did not
perceive this when he criticised Racine for not placing the most
tragic events on the stage, as Shakespeare does. With Racine the
“narrative” always dispenses with the representation. Sainte-
Beuve does not distinguish between the “poets” of the theatre
and the others (Homer, Pindar, Aeschylus, Dante and
Shakespeare are for him in the same class, Horace, Virgil,
Corneille, Moliere, Boileau and Racine being in the second rank);
he distinguishes them, but as poets of genius “independently of
the genres,” “XVII siècle,” Les poètes dramatiques, ed. M. Allem, p.
193. See his criticism of Racine (“We can rightfully criticise
Racine, above all, for having described rather than staged the
banquet scene …,” pp. 210-211). Assuredly, but any stage
manager can mount a banquet scene. It is not poetry. Sainte-
Beuve criticizes Racine for not being Shakespeare, and he
certainly is not, but the reason why he steers clear of spectacle is
that he remains faithful to the epic. When, today, a director
desires to add the dimension of spectacle to Bérénice, he has a
perfect right to do so because the theatre exists for our
amusement, but it is a mistake from the point of view of the
Racinian ideal itself. To add the dimension of spectacle to Bérénice
is like removing it from Wagner’s Die Meistersinger.
285
event occurred when “Aeschylus first introduced a second
actor,” as Aristotle himself says. In fact, Aristotle is
describing here an impossible operation, for if only one
character is involved, he is not yet an actor. Theatre begins
with dialogue which, by definition, requires two persons.
Reading is the normal form for the presentation of the
epic. Whether it is a public or a private reading makes no
difference as regards the genre of the work. Public reading
was the usual way for spreading poetry before the
invention of the printing press. It is still practiced in our
day. The reader may be a professional actor and in most
cases he frequently is. In his public reading of a play he
can even imitate several different actors by varying the
tone and timbres of his voice and make us believe that we
are listening to a man or a woman, a young man, an old
man or a child speaking. The Japanese have developed the
art of public reading to the peak of perfection, inasmuch
as they have developed specialists who themselves speak
all the parts of the same play, while all the actors do is
mime them. Yet the public reader, as such, is not an actor.
As we know, he is alone and instead of seeing several
characters we see a man by himself who vainly tries to talk
as if he were several men at once. 4 The first one to
4 This is what distinguishes the theatre, as a major art, from
all its derivatives, such as the marionette show, or the cinema; the
images that are projected on a screen exist, but the persons they
represent do not. They have existed, but their images survive
them; no real actor continues to act after his death. We can
consider cinema as the image of a theatre that has ceased to exist,
but the film has never existed as theatre. There is never a
286
introduce a second actor, again according to Aristotle,
created the actor and the character at the same time, for
the public reader is himself and not an actor since he
speaks for others without claiming to impersonate them.
The difference was manifest to anyone who entered
the tiny auditorium of the Vieux Colombier where Jacques
Copeau used to give his public readings. The only décor
was a table behind which a man sat reading. Obviously his
self-assigned function was not to give a performance in
the formal sense; he himself made no effort to make the
audience believe, even temporarily, that he was any
personage other than the one who was holding the public
reading; if he was reading Péguy, Péguy’s work alone
occupied the whole stage, it alone had the floor and
Copeau acted neither Joan of Are, nor Madame Gervaise,
nor God. He did not even impersonate Péguy. In fact he
did not act at all, and his auditors sensed the tact with
which he guarded himself against acting. For him to have

“general rehearsal” of the film as there always is with a play; it is


only after the montage and on the screen that a film attains its
unity, that of an image whose reality already is no longer there. It
seems, therefore, that cinema has an interest in seeking its paths
outside those of the theatre, even of a faked theatre. Perhaps it is
one more case of a new material in search of its form. On this
score Henri Gouhier, “Théâtre et cinema”, in L’essence du théâtre
(Paris: Plon, 1943), pp. 8-14, makes profitable reading. We quote
a sentence relating to the core of the question, italics ours:
“These five acts are actions in search of actors who actualize them”
(p. 4). And a few lines further: “Hence it is the actor who is the
dramatic fact.”
287
done so would have been a transgression against art, for
his function at that time was not to simulate the presence
of any character but to ensure the presence of poetry. The
moment there are two readers, they become actors. The
actor is born the moment when, instead of speaking for
the author by presenting his work, he speaks for anyone of
the characters imagined by the author as though he
himself were this character, temporarily endowed with a
borrowed reality and life which we agree fictitiously to
consider as real by virtue of a convention tacitly accepted
in advance. Indeed this is the spectator’s personal
contribution to dramatic art: to help to defray expenses by
paying for his seat and to become himself an actor by
accepting the role of the spectator who plays at believing
in the reality of what he sees. He does not go to the
theatre to see Corneille, not even to see Talma, but to see
the actor Talma playing the part of Augustus as conceived
by Corneille. The theatre truly begins when, the narrator
having withdrawn into the background, the parts of the
story are acted by actors whose very name clearly states what
they do.
What is true of the actor is also true of the play in all
its constitutive parts. Just as the narrator makes way for
the actor, the descriptions in the play become décors, its
lines are actually pronounced, its portraits are replaced by
rouged and made-up faces as well as by bodies dressed in
disguises that are as easy to see as it would be difficult to
imagine them. The transition from reading to theatre is
effected every year in Christian churches each time that at
the hour of the Passion, while the celebrant is reading the

288
Gospel for himself at the altar, several celebrants chant it
publicly and transform into real characters what before
were only the parts of a story. One becomes the Witness,
who is the evangelist Matthew or John, another becomes
Jesus, a third plays the role of episodic characters; the only
necessary convention as far as the latter is concerned is
that he represent only one person at a time. The choir
naturally is the multitude but alternately it also represents
the Christian people in prayer. The celebrant who plays
Christ no longer reads the Gospel, but impersonates
Christ in the grave voice and the lofty and slow diction
that is chosen as apparently befitting the Man-God. It
would be easy to note what distinguishes this liturgy from
a play proper, but here we can observe the spontaneous
transition from narration to dramatic action, from reading
to representation. A theatre is not a church; everything in
it is fiction and willed as such, but the fiction is embodied
there in a very real matter. When theatre people are told
that their art is illusion, the authors, actors, stage
designers, costumers, accessorists, stage directors and
financial backers know all too well what a heavy,
burdensome, and costly mass this illusion requires for its
embodiment. The physical substance of this embodiment
is the material of the theatre; the proper function of the
author is to inform it with the ends of beauty.
The actor stands in the foreground of this material and
altogether apart from the rest, for if the theatre is
representation of human events and, as is said, of life, in
this regard it surpasses all the other arts in that this
representation of life is made with living persons and that

289
of human events with human beings. Everything in the
theatre is a portion of the real charged with a fictitious
signification, but those who signify fictitious persons are
themselves real persons. When an actor is assigned to
impersonate a certain character it is said that the actor has
a “part” or a “role”. According to Littré a part, or role, is
“that which an actor must recite in a play”. Thus called
because it is written on a role, on a sheet of paper. When
Molière in L’Impromptu de Versailles tells his troupe: “But
pray, let us set about our rehearsals,” Mlle. Béjart replies:
“How do you expect us to do this if we do not know our
parts?”
Assuredly that is what a part is, but it is more than
that. When an actor looks for the first time at the lines
that he is to recite, he grasps them as a unity. They are the
words of one and the same character whose utterances
follow one upon each other and, moreover, they meet up
with the utterances made by different characters; they are
like the substance of the fictitious being whom the actor
will be charged to impersonate in his countenance, his
attitudes, his bearing, his gestures, his tone of voice, his
inflections, in short in his whole body. A part, good or
bad, is more than a sequence of lines written on paper; it
is a virtual theatrical being whose actualization is at stake.
Furthermore, this is the distinguishing trait between acting
and reading. If I read Le Cid in public, I am simply a
professor or a lecturer who is reading the play, but if I take
it upon myself to play the part of Rodrigue, the words that
I utter in his name become a part forming a continuity
beyond the interruptions imposed by the dialogue; they

290
assume a unity and become reality by borrowing the reality
of the actor who pronounces them. His person becomes
that of the fictitious character who speaks the words; the
real action of the actor is like the embodiment of the
action he is charged to portray.
The actor, in some way, is the executant of the theatre
without whom the dramatic work would. remain in the
planning state, or at best in a state of potentiality, waiting
to be brought to fruition. The only musical executant
whose situation is comparable to his is the singer.
Actually, a singer is an actor who sings rather than speaks
his role; this is why music in that case becomes theatre
because the musician really draws from himself the music
that he is performing. Ordinarily, the musician’s role is
limited to playing a musical instrument well, whereas the
actor’s role, whether he is speaking or singing, consists in
playing himself well, as it were. His instrument is the man
he is, his very person, body, mind, his natural gifts and
acquired talents, in short his total self. There is no theatre
without this real presence of actors engaged in their roles.
Alceste in the theatre is the role of Alceste literally
“personified”.
Therefore, the actor’s specific contribution to the
dramatic work is to commit his very person to the service
of its realization on stage. This extraordinary vocation
exists. It is not even rare, but all those who are called do
not have the means to respond successfully to the call.
This is first of all decided by the physique: build, carriage,
voice, which pre-determine the career of the future actor
by fixing the uses to which his artistry will be put. Molière,

291
an excellent comic actor, was never exactly brilliant in
tragic roles. The actor does not play the role he wants, but
the role he can. It requires an arduous apprenticeship and
long hard work to cultivate these gifts. Finally, assuming
full mastery of his trade, the actor must make a special
effort every time he approaches a new part. He must
reform himself so as to become the character whom he is
to personify. It is essential that he enter into the meaning
of his lines, but his object is not to grasp their meaning as
such but to imagine himself already on stage and under
the skin, as the saying goes, of the character he is to play
unless, conversely, the character has gotten under his. 5
This is not all. A role stands in relation to other roles.
Therefore the actor must think of himself as one of the
beings making up the microcosm imagined by the
dramatist. Thus the actor will conceive his manner of
acting, his place and his role in terms of the ensemble and
of the “cast”. In this sense, he is not a negligible factor.
Even if it is only a supporting role, a role can be acted well

5 It happens that a role is played by an actor who does not


have the physique for it. Since beautiful voices are rare and
powerful voices require a rather large chest, the disparity between
the actor’s physique and the role is almost the rule in opera, at
least as far as concerns a certain genre of roles. But we have seen.
many comedians tormented by the desire to play high tragedy,
and many tragedians work at parts that simply were not for them.
If he has the wisdom to resist such temptations, the great actor
commissions one of his pupils to play the role for him. “I am
working on Silvain’s Harpagon,” a young actor told me one day,
“he’s the one who wants it.”
292
or badly. There are, moreover, major or minor supporting
roles, and often the weight of a play rests on the actor or
actress with the supporting role. An excellent actor of the
Comédie Française once told me that besides the role of the
star in whom the public is primarily interested and who
walks off with the laurels, there is often a role less dazzling
but of a kind which will cause the play to “flop” if it is not
perfectly carried off. Orgon alongside Tartuffe, Bartholo
next to Figaro. Lengthy collective efforts, nowadays often
regulated by a stage director, finally culminate in the play
acted on the boards. But the play is not truly acted except
on the night of the “premiere”, that is to say with the
indispensable collaboration of the public. When at the
curtain call the artists come on stage as a group to receive
the applause, they can rightly feel that they have deserved
it, for even if the play has failed and dragged them along
with its failure, the actors at least “defended” it well. Why
should not a theatrical company, why should not an actor
or an actress be proud of the part they have just taken in
the extraordinary event which is the production of a work
of art willed only for the sake of its beauty?
Here a problem arises, however, which the speculative
philosopher would prefer to avoid because it relates to
morality. But its roots dig so deeply into the ontology of
dramatic art that he can hardly avoid it.
The actor is the only creative artist who fashions the
building material of the beauty that he creates out of his
own person. This is true, of course, only insofar as he is
actor. Speaking absolutely, the actor remains wholly
himself while he is on stage. He is like other mortals, with

293
his own character, thoughts and feelings. If he does not
become God while playing the part of Jesus Christ, neither
does he become a devil playing Mephistopheles. The
problem is of a more hidden character; it requires some
effort to meet it on its own ground.
First of all there is a moral problem, real and
supremely important in its order, which is not that of pure
speculative philosophy treating of the essence of the arts
of the beautiful. This must at least be recognized, because
it is one of the constants of the problem, and it merits this
recognition if it serves merely to situate our own problem
exactly.
There must have been a meaning behind the Church’s
repeated condemnations of minstrels, mountebanks and
actors of all kinds. One specific point ordinarily held the
attention of theologians. There were no actresses in
ancient comedy or in ancient tragedy, and this custom
lasted for a long time in some modern countries, for
example England. But in Bossuet’s time women already
tread the boards, posing a serious problem in the minds of
theologians for whom decorum, modesty and decency
were the distinctive attributes of the Christian woman.
How could a woman exhibit herself in public and in full
view of everybody, and mimic the language, gestures, and
attitudes of the most violent or tender emotions without
spreading a feeling of disquiet in the hearts of the
spectators? How could she do this without exposing
herself to these same feelings? This is the question which
Bossuet posed in terms that clearly reflect his ideas on the

294
subject.6 On this point all we have to do is to refer to what
he said about it.
The problem in all its aspects goes beyond the
personal situation of the actor or the actress. Even
assuming that an actress is completely insensible to the
emotions which she inspires, which is not only possible
but in a sense useful to her artistry, she is not without
responsibility for the emotions she arouses in others. In
this other sense, she is a being professionally dedicated to
the function of kindling these emotions, feelings and
passions in the hearts of others. To expose a woman on
the stage in this way, offered to the desires of men, a
woman whose talent consists in exciting them by making
believe that she feels them herself, in Bossuet’s words “is
to sacrifice them to public incontinence in a more
6 “What mother, I do not say one who is Christian but who
has a modicum of respectability, would not rather see her
daughter in the grave than on the stage? Did she raise her so
tenderly and with so much wariness for this shame? Did she keep
her night and day, so to speak under her wings, with so much
care, in order to deliver her to the public and to make of her a
peril to youth? Who does not regard these unhappy Christians, if
they are still in a profession so contrary to the vows of their
baptism, who, I say, does not regard them as slaves on display, in
whom modesty is extinguished, except for the kind of glances
they attract, they whom their sex had consecrated to modesty,
and whose natural frailty demanded the sure refuge of a well-
regulated household? And here they are spreading themselves out
right in the middle of the stage …”, etc., ch. VIII, Bossuet,
Maximés et réflexions sur la comédie, ed. A. Gazier (Paris: Belin,
1881), pp. 39-40.
295
dangerous manner than would be the case in places that
we dare not call by name.” A perusal of Chapter VIII of
Maximés et réflexions sur la comédie would show how deeply
Bossuet pursued the examination of this problem. He
knew all the answers of those who defended plays. “When
plays are criticised as dangerous, the fashionable folk …
repeat daily that they do not perceive this danger at all.
Press them further and they will tell you the same about
nudity, and not only about nudity in painting, but that
even of persons. …”7 Bossuet, moreover, does not speak
only in the name of religion. The aforementioned chapter
of the Maximés expressly cites the authority of Plato and it
is on this occasion that he pronounces the word suggested
by the developments that we have just seen. Despite the
licentiousness of their theatre, the pagans never showed
women on the stage. They believed that a sex dedicated to
modesty “should not be exposed to the public in this way,
and that it was a kind of prostitution.”8
7 Op. cit. … p. 43, and the further development of the
argument which is Bossuet at his best. It is very strange that such
a subject of literary history has not yet found the historian it
deserves, especially in a time when whole theses are dedicated to
the life and work of some “stage managers” whose importance,
real as it may be, nevertheless interests only one of the least
literary “parts of the theatre.”
8 Bossuet, op. cit., p. 56. Bossuet does not quote Plato merely

as a decorative authority. Plato does not countenance the theatre,


as he does music and poetry, except in the service of morality.
The actor follows the fate of the theatre. Plato cannot allow that
a future political leader imitate a woman, a slave, a beggar or
coward, a debauchee, etc. Why? For fear that by imitating their
296
This is not the core of the problem, if not for the
moralist at least for the speculative philosopher. Even if
we do not attach any moral connotation to the word, the
fact remains that the actor is a professional “simulator”.
To imitate feelings that one does not feel, to say things
that one does not think and to do it as perfectly as
possible to the point where the spectator, though
unbelieving, is gripped by the performance, is truly to
simulate. No intention to deceive is involved in this game;
the public knows that the actor is imitating and it lends
itself to the game to increase the pleasure which it derives
from the spectacle. But this is not the question. What is
solely at stake here is that the actor, whatever his
intention, assumes the appearance of an imaginary
personality and creates the illusion of a nonexisting reality.
In Aristotle the art of the actor was called è hypokritik.9
Later, the appellation actor hypokritès, was to designate a
“knave”, a “hypocrite”. The meaning which links these
two different usages of the word is that of “the simulation
of an imaginary person by a real person”. While he is
playing a role the actor assumes a “borrowed personality”.
What is his own in that case? This is the core of the
question.
No doubt we shall be tempted to dismiss Bossuet’s
testimony. After all, it will be said, his attitude was
baseness and vices, he may contract them in reality: Republic, III,
8, 395 c-d. In citing this passage in Chapter XIV of his Maximes,
Bossuet rightly asserts “it is a sapping of the foundations of the
theatre, removing from it even its actors. …”
9 Aristotle, Poetics, ch. 20, 1456b. 10 (op. cit.).

297
predictable because he was merely plying his trade. But
there is also the testimony offered by Diderot, the
permissive moralist of the Supplément au Vovage de
Bougainville, ou Diaogue entre A. et B. sur l’inconvénient d’attacher
des idées Morales à certaines actions physiques que ne’en comportent
pas. 10 On the other hand, it seems that their imitation
involves very precise moral ideas when we read the
famous Paradox sur le comedien. Here Diderot discusses the
“degradation of actors”, of those people who “are debased
to the condition of the lowest mountebanks,” and if his
testimony differs from Bossuet’s the reason for his
contempt of the actor’s calling is expressed no less
forcibly by Diderot: “Where is the poet who would dare
suggest to wellborn gentlemen to repeat in public talk of a
vapid or gross character, or to women, more or less sage
as our own, to recite brazenly before a large audience
words that they would blush to hear in the privacy of their
homes?” In fact Diderot points out that actors are
excommunicated by the Church and rejected by public
opinion. “This public, which cannot be without them,
despises them. They are slaves ever under the whip of
another slave. Do you believe that the marks of a constant

10 Supplément au voyage de Bougainville, in Oeuvres (Paris: La


Pléiade), definition of modesty: “Man does not wish to be
disturbed or distracted in his pleasures. Those of love are
followed by a weakness which would surrender him to the mercy
of his enemy. This is all that there can be of a natural element in
modesty: the rest is institutionalization” p. 1025, and the
subsequent passages in which the almoner learns many things
obviously new to him.
298
degradation can remain without effect, and that under the
burden of this ignominy a soul is strong enough to be a
match for Corneille?” Save for the difference in language,
the views are identical.
Diderot introduces a new point of view here. All we
have to do is to follow it to its end to arrive at conclusions
of great importance. Pushing beyond Bossuet, his merit is
that he posed the question of what might be called the
soul of the actor, and perhaps, above all, he sensed that by
proceeding along these lines one might find the answer to
the problem of the social condition of the actors of his
time, as well as of the times anterior to his own.
Distinguishing between two temperaments of different
dramatic artists, Diderot formed a first group of those
who, acting by some kind of instinct, are dominated by
their sensibility. Such actors are wholly in the grip of their
roles and become as one with the character being
portrayed. If they have this gift, they experience sublime
moments followed by painful letdowns. The others have
no sensibility whatsoever. By calculating in advance the
manner in which they are to act down to its least detail
until they achieve perfection, they succeed admirably in
imitating all the gestures and all the expressions of a
person like the one whose role they are to play. They will
make the most regular and the most perfect actors,
provided only that they never are carried away by the
stirrings of their sensibility. Herein lies the “paradox of
acting”: the less the actor himself is stirred, the more he
stirs his audience. Now in both cases he is never himself,
that is to say whether he renounces his real being to

299
become the personage of his part or whether, having no
definite self-identity, he deliberately fashions the soul of
his character. It is when he has nothing of his own
selfhood to sacrifice that he identifies himself most
perfectly with his character; therefore this is also when the
actor is at his greatest.
It is not necessary to share Diderot’s contempt for the
actor but we must be aware of it because it is an essential
factor of the celebrated paradox. To make clear that the
sensibility of actors is not the root of their art, Diderot
vigorously asserts that true actors have no sensibility to
sacrifice, nor much of anything else for that matter. “What
leads to their infatuation with the stage? The lack of
education, poverty and libertinage. The theatre is an
expedient, never a choice.” In short, “one never becomes
an actor for the love of virtue.” If this is so, whence do
actors get these admirable feelings which they express so
forcefully? In point of fact they do not have such feelings
at all, they mimic them and their imitation of these
feelings is all the more perfect the more they themselves
are completely devoid of them.
The core of the problem posed by the actor’s art
appears here in all its fullness. Is it possible for the actor
to practice this art without sacrificing his own personality,
provided he has one, or must he be without one at all so
that he can always be ready to assume what Diderot so
aptly called “a borrowed soul”? Here is his awesome
judgment: “It has been said that actors have no character
whatsoever, because by acting all of them they lose the
one which nature gave them, that they become false just as

300
the doctor, the surgeon and the butcher become callous. I
believe that one has taken the cause for the effect and they
are fitted to play all the characters because they have
none.”11
The interpretation of these testimonies is no easy task
because they are compounded of disparate elements.
Some are religious, others are moral, others social and
related to living conditions that are no longer the same
today or that have ceased to exist. Nowadays actors and
actresses are in no sense recruited as they seem to have
been in Diderot’s time, if we are to believe his testimony.
Moreover, there were always exceptions at all times, even
in the hostile judgments pronounced upon the theatrical
profession: Roscius, Garrick and other famous names can
be cited in protest against summary condemnations which
are contradicted by some cases of a striking character.
Finally, it must not be forgotten that plays have been
performed by other than professional actors. The desire to
appear on stage is extraordinarily widespread. All, or
nearly all, children love to do so. Religious schools,
especially those of the Society of Jesus, include theatrical
performances in their educational programs. The
fashionable theatre flourished in the seventeenth and
eighteenth centuries. Plays were staged at Cirey, Ferney,
and Coppet, and not only Molière and Voltaire but also
Louis XIV and Frederick II walked the boards.
Consequently, it seems impossible that the judgment upon

11Diderot, Paradox sur le comédien (Paris: Pléiade), pp. 1065-


1067, 1068, 1070, 1071-1072.
301
the art of the actor, and above all of the actress, could
have been as summary as we have just seen.
Upon closer examination it will be noticed that these
testimonies converge toward a kind of focus located
beyond religion, social convention and even morality. The
scandals described by Bossuet, assuming they were real,
were also found outside the world of the theatre. The
court and the Church itself had their share of them, and
the “good society” of the eighteenth century was not
exempt from those described by Diderot. But we see a
wholly different idea gradually emerge by way of censures
of this kind, that of the alienation from his personality to
which the actor must acquiesce, at least in part, if he
makes the theatre his calling. Diderot had in mind the
professional actor who cannot choose his parts when he
described him as a marvelous puppet whose strings are
pulled by the poet.12 If we disregard what is exasperating
and, moreover, inexact about the comparison because an
actor is not a marionette, the fact remains that the actor
views himself as one on whom different forms of being
are imposed from without and which he must successively
assume. Let us ponder Goethe’s reply to Eckermann when
the latter asked him how to choose a new member of the
company for the theatre at Weimar. If he’s a young
beginner, Goethe observed, he should be chosen if he has,
among other things, enough self-control to appear in the
most favorable light, that is to say, to act in a play for his
personal benefit. Thereupon he added, “The profession

12 Op. cit., p. 1065.


302
requires continual self-denial and a continued existence in
a foreign mask.” 13 Is the mark of the genuine actor,
therefore, the fact that he never stops play-acting? Surely
not, but what Goethe meant to say is that he is
unceasingly called upon to insert a fictional self of his own
creation between himself and his spectator. Perhaps
Baudelaire got closer to the truth by pointing out that the
actor’s art can be compared to the world’s oldest
13 Goethe’s Conversations with Eckermann, tr. by John
Oxenford (New York: E. P. Dutton & Company, Everyman’s
Library, New York, 1930), p. 100. An observation made in the
conversation of April 14, 1825. Charles Dullin forcefully
declared: “The Playwright is the master of the theatre. All the actor can
do is to bring his inventions to life, the stage manager cannot
animate any other ensemble save the one foreseen by the author.
Let us repeat, all the substance is given by the playwright.”
Charles Dullin’s remarks in H. Gouhier, L’essence du théâtre, pp.
IV-V. This temporary and willed abdication of his personality for
the sake of a simulacrum is the enduring substance of the
problem.
All roles are not equally heavy to bear; there are even some
light ones, but some are such that the actors or actresses who tax
themselves to embody them nightly for months, sometimes for
years, end up by feeling the need of liberating themselves of it
like an obsession. On the psychological problem, see the remarks
commented on by H. Gouhier, L’oeuvre théâtrale (Paris:
Flammarion, 1958), p. 23, footnote 14. This note refers in
addition to André Villiers, La psychologie du comédien (Paris: O.
Lieutier, 1946). The moral conclusion is obvious: can one,
without danger, accept feigning to be (sometimes, or often, for a
long time) a being whom he is not and whose substance is made
of the person that one really is?
303
profession only with reservations, for it does not involve
either the same act or the same end.14
The feature common to all these observations is that
they were made by writers who adopted the public’s point
of view and who were even on the side of that public for
whom the theatre is primarily an erotic spectacle. Such a
view forgets that the art of the actress, about which
nothing is said, could not be wholly different from that of
the actor, and above all that the actor by definition sees
things from the “other side of the footlights”, so different
in all respects from that of the orchestra pit. For the actor,
acting is work. Furthermore, it is arduous, long and
painstaking work during which a show must be staged.
The show, if the efforts of the cast are crowned with
success, is accomplished only after numerous, wearisome
14 “The considerations relative to the courtesan, up to a
certain point, can be applied to the actress. For she too is a
creature of display, an object of public pleasure. But here the
conquest, the prey, is of a more noble, more spiritual nature. It is
a question of obtaining general approval not only through pure
physical beauty, but also through the talents of the rarest order. If
on the one hand the actress is akin to the courtesan, on the other
she borders upon the poet. Let us not forget that apart from
natural and even artificial beauty, there is in all beings an idiom of
the trade, a characteristic that can be translated physically into
ugliness, but also into a kind of professional beauty.” Charles
Baudelaire, “Le peintre de la vie moderne,” in Curiosités esthétiques,
Oeuvres (Paris: Pléiade), p. 916. Here we deliberately avoid
engaging in an exegesis of the famous texts of Fusées (op. cit., p.
1189): “What is art? Prostitution.” Is there a single trade which
the writer does not think he can practice, by writing it?
304
rehearsals. Failure is discouraging, but success means that
the actor must rehearse the same part every day, when not
twice on the same day, for weeks, for months, sometimes
for years. Certainly the objections raised against the actor’s
art are not without foundation, but they are one-sided.
They overlook the actor’s curious vocation—of which
very few of the audience have any personal experience—
which is born from an innate desire to create out of his
substance another human being, imaginary no doubt but
offering all the appearance of a real human being. They
overlook the correlative desire to contribute one’s share to
the production of the collective reality which is the play,
composed of men and women who consecrate part of
their lives to the effort required to produce it. The
moralist does not know what it is to feel the elements of
the play falling neatly into place, the parts finding their
right tone and gradually harmonizing with each other until
the day when, although the outcome is almost totally
uncertain, the director feels in his bones that the play is
ready for public performance. The ultimate meaning of
the vocation of actor and actress is this final moment at
the end of the performance when the whole “cast” comes
on the stage to receive the hoped-for applause from the
public. And why should the public applaud if not because
it feels that all this effort has been extended for its benefit
and that now it behooves the audience to thank the actors
for the pleasure they have just given.
Please the public. Corneille, Moliere, Racine vied with
each other in quoting this Golden Rule which so many
others put into practice after them. Please the public,

305
indeed, but by giving it what sort of pleasure? If it is a
question of eroticism, the lowest forms of the music hall
(which is much better than this suggests, if it wants to be)
and the indescribable commerce of sexual excitation, to
which a notable part of films are dedicated nowadays, are
able to purvey cheaply to millions of spectators all the
merchandise of this kind that they can desire. It is art for
voyeurs. But the theatre as art is something quite different.
Its object is to present to the public serious drama or
comedies, operas or ballets which offer the eye, ear and
mind the spectacle of works conceived and executed with
beauty alone as the end in view. The public is quite aware
of this. If upon leaving the theatre the spectator must
make an effort to re-enter the real world from which the
play, comedy or opera have temporarily liberated him, it is
proof that for a few hours art has succeeded in imparting
the illusion of an imaginary life. This temporary removal
from his selfhood and his environment has pleased the
spectator, and by applauding he is expressing to the cast
his appreciation for this pleasure. Thus we have shifted
the problem but, even if the reasons for doing so were
serious, we have not in the least changed its nature
thereby. The profession of the actor depends upon the
manner in which he can and wishes to exercise it.15 It is
15 In his engaging preface to Tartuffe, Molière quite
appropriately recalls the religious origins of drama from the
Ancients up to the “holy plays of Monsieur de Corneille, which
have been the admiration of all France” The need to defend
himself leads him to consider “the Comedy in itself, to see if it is
condemnable.” He defines it as “an ingenious poem which,
306
not surprising that its exercise poses problems; they arise
every time that the human being is in question. We can
recall in this connection that the human being ought to be
treated as an end, never as a means, but how many times
does he not voluntarily sacrifice himself to ends that
transcend him? The public’s applause expresses the
grateful admiration it feels for those who have let it share
in the creative joys of art.
The play is a “well-contrived poem” said Molière; and
Pierre Corneille wrote a Discours sur le poème dramatique.
Indeed a play is a poiema, something that is made, the result
of a poiesis, or fabrication, which is the work of an artisan,
the poietes. In short, a play is the product of a poietic
activity. Yet it is not a poem, for a poem is made with
words, whereas a play is made with actors who are human
beings impersonating characters. The characters
themselves speak and act, but they say only what the
author makes them say and do only what he prescribes
they are to do. Hence the author is here the first cause of

through pleasurable lessons, reproves the faults of men.”


Everything which follows which begins with: “I confess that
there have been times when Comedy has been corrupt. And what
is there in this world that one does not corrupt every day?” is at
once very forcefully and cogently expressed and, if we pay
attention to it, with an extreme wariness. For in the end when he
says “even the holiest things are not sheltered from the
corruption of men,” Cardinal de Retz, the archbishop of Paris,
would have shown bad grace to deny it. And as regards the
private life of the Very Christian King, Bossuet himself assuredly
was informed.
307
the dramatic work. Is it possible to define this work in
terms of its essence?16
The words of ordinary language are not intended to
express philosophical notions, even when the object of
these notions is the work of art. Since we must make a
detour here, let us start out from a distinction for which
our language has no words either but which are happily
found in German: Geschichte, history as event, that happens
(geschiet), and Historie, history as narration, that is told. If
we had a recording apparatus that could note all events as
they were taking place, the result of this notation would be
chaotic. To render it intelligible it would have to be cut up
into a number of fragments, as in narrative history.
Hegel’s Philosophy of History is an excellent example of this
reconstruction of events that have occurred since the
beginning of the world, as they have affected man and to
the extent in which some documents have preserved a
memory of them. In Hegel’s works events are arranged in
groups roughly corresponding to the major peoples
known to us and intelligibly linked to one another within
these groupings in terms of a principle of causality. We see
peoples form, grow and perish, and within these peoples

16 The problem is approached from all sides in the excellent


work by Henri Gouhier, L’essence du théâtre (op. cit.) to which we
also add his L’oeuvre théâtrale (op. cit.). Both books, written by a
philosopher who is well informed about the theatrical production
of his time and familiar with the world of the theatre, in every
respect go beyond the restricted frame of my own reflections. I
cannot restrain my envy for the richness of their insights, but it is
a satisfaction to think that they are the work of a friend.
308
the social classes, the leaders of men in all orders,
sometimes even vast unities created by the Spirit expressly
for the purpose of assembling the greatest number of
particular events possible under a single category. History
in that case fashions its myths, such as the Middle Ages,
the Renaissance, the century of Louis XIV and other
fictions of the same kind which are universally accepted
because of their convenience. The feature common to all
these groups is that they obey a scheme: they have a
beginning, a middle and an end. Beginnings or birth,
maturity or perfection, decadence and death, thus does
narrative history view the intelligible elements that it cuts
up as events in the continuity of history in order to find a
meaning in it or to confer a meaning upon it, if it has
none.
The event is the intelligible unit of real history.
Generally speaking, an event is anything that happens, but
history retains only a minuscule part of what does happen;
what it retains of it, that is to say the historical event, is a
privileged event. For a great variety of reasons, such as its
greatness, nobility, beauty, but most often because the
event in itself summarizes the meaning of a determined
historical situation, the historian sets it aside from the
others for closer scrutiny. Whatever it may be, the
historical event is never a brute fact; history takes
possession of it so that it may not remain in the raw state,
and what it does with it is already a history, with a
beginning, a middle and an end.
Invented narratives obey the same law. Anecdotes
which we polish for a long time to achieve a perfection of

309
form, tales, stories, novels in prose or verse, all these
imaginary histories individually form a complete whole; we
know where each one begins, how it develops and also
how it ends. The story-teller assumes the responsibility for
arousing our curiosity, and he must satisfy it. The
dramatist also invents a human event similar to those that
history relates, but instead of telling the story like the
novelist, he lets it transpire on a stage by having it acted
out by actors before an audience. The author himself
mayor may not playa part in it. Shakespeare and Molière
were both authors and actors, but this is not necessary.
The author as such invents the human event which he
intends to bring on the stage; if he draws his inspiration
from history, he chooses the event and decides what
elements of it to retain, the essential thing always being
that actors will undertake to portray it. If, for example, the
event in question is the assassination of Julius Caesar, the
dramatist will reconstruct the series of events leading to
the crime. The play is an event that happens on stage
according to the dramatist’s decision and the order that he
has freely decided upon in advance.
Like any event, the one which the play portrays has a
beginning, a middle and an end, whose reciprocal
relationships impart being to the play by imparting unity
to it. Since its unity is that of a whole, it can consist only in
the relationship between the parts which allows them to
be conceived as a discrete and distinct grouping. This is
why the author, actors and spectators agree on the need
for an exposition which describes the situation from
which one starts. It is the point of departure for the event.

310
The great dramatic enterprises confirm this concern to the
point where the work itself is preceded by a prologue
which serves to situate, so to speak, the play’s absolute
point of departure: the Prologue in Heaven of the first Faust,
Das Rheingold for Wagner’s Ring Cycle, or that other
prologue in heaven which forms the first scene of
Claudel’s The Satin Slipper, in which the Jesuit Father takes
his leave from the world so that he can entrust his brother
to God. This grand play begins with a death, which is an
absolute, in itself the reason why death ends so many
plays. Comedy often ends with a marriage because it too
marks the end of a life and the absolute beginning of
another. This does not constitute “a slice of life”, as some
have called it, in the first place because life is not cut up
into slices which have only two ends but neither a
beginning or end, and in the second place because the
theatre is not life, but the appearance of life. The living
being, says Aristotle, has its cause in itself, whereas the
product of art has its cause outside itself. This is what
permits the dramatist, who is the cause of his play, to
freely assign it an absolute beginning and end. The actors
and the stagehands interrupt their real lives so as to be at
hand at the moment when the three traditional knocks,
which also have a beginning, a middle and an end, mark
the beginning of the acts which are to simulate life on the
stage. Faust begins in heaven, Don Juan ends in hell; the
whole intermediate period is made up of words and
gestures regulated by the dramatist and which are the very
substance of the work. We will concede all the possible
derogations of these general rules, but the authors do not

311
abuse them, for if the play is to come to life the public’s
curiosity must be satisfied. At bottom this curiosity is only
a requirement of the mind which always wants to grasp an
event through its cause and demands that it be carried out
to its end in order that it may be, and be intelligible. Thus
we are back to the observation made long ago by
Aristotle, and which was taken up again by Corneille: a
play must represent a whole action and that to be whole
means “to have a beginning, a middle, and an end.”17
The proper work of a playwright therefore is the
invention of this action performed on stage before a
public. It is the actual performance of the play that
constitutes its reality. This is the end to which all the rest
is ordered and subordinated: the work of the actors,
staging, decor, costumes, hair-does, make-up, lighting,
music and dance if called for. Whether or not he takes
part in the performance, the author is a kind of creative
demiurge, in the Platonic sense, of a cosmos that owes its
existence to him. He knows it, and doubtlessly this
demiurgic aspiration is hidden in the background of the

17Aristotle, Poetics, ch. 7, 1450b, (op. cit.), p. 634. See also


preceding passages, which are of a definitive character, on the
primacy of action in tragedy, in which the personages do not act
to imitate their character, but in which their character results
from the action, VI, 1450a, 27, p. 631. On tragedy as the
representation of an action, 1450b, 3, p. 633. The unity is not that
of a personage, but of “one action, a complete whole”,
containing only elements that it would be impossible to transpose
or withdraw without affecting the whole: VIII, 1451a, 30-35, p.
635.
312
dramatist’s vocation. If he could, the author would like to
engender the play solely through his will and thought, the
way God created the world. At least, he would like to be
able to be all the characters at once. Molière in the
Impromptu de Versailles has Mlle. Molière say to him: “May I
tell you that you ought to have written a comedy where
you would have played all alone.” All that Moliére can
come up with as a rejoinder is: “Hold your tongue, wife,
you’re an ass!” But since the remark actually originated
with him, Molière knew that it was eminently fitting.
Hence this characteristic that so clearly marks the
dramatist, and which distinguishes him from the
immateriality of the poet whose creation is accomplished
entirely in the mind; namely his love for the orchestra,
above all for the stage and for everything that transpires
on it. He is dedicated to this mundus scaenicus where reigns a
semblance that deceives nobody, with its decors and
painted cardboard cities, its actors and actresses,
fashioners of illusion, its invented action without concern
for the true and all the ingenious fakery which contributes
to create the illusion desired, willed and acquiesced to by
all.18 Only one thing matters to the author for as long as

18 To cite an example among a hundred, Goethe was a man


of the theatre to his fingertips. He knew that a theatre had to
make money in order to exist and said that “Shakespeare and
Molière did not think differently.” Everything interested him
from the recruitment and training of actors and actresses up to
the architecture of the building. Goethe’s Conversations with
Eckermann abound with observations on this subject, notably the
entry of March 22, 1825: “Anyone who is sufficiently young, and
313
he is engaged in writing his play, namely that the world
which the theatre accepts is his own work. The public
demands only that this invented world captivate its
attention and hold its interest so completely that it will
temporarily forget the real life which the spectacle has
suspended. To achieve such an effect this world must
possess a feigned reality sufficient unto itself. The form, of
which all the rest is like matter, consists of this infinitely
subtle, fragile relationship of the parts of the work to the
whole and which mere nothing can destroy.
The necessity for unity explains the classic rule of the
three unities, for as preposterous as it is the rule had a
reason for being and, moreover, nothing prohibits the
dramatist from subjecting himself to it if he pleases.
Actually, only one law seems necessary: the unity of action
without which the play would not exist since the event
that the action represents is the very substance of the
work. It can be the unity of a fable or even of several
fables woven together into one, but the more deeply the

who is not quite spoiled, could not easily find any place that
would suit him so well as a theatre …”, etc. (op. cit., p. 92); his
remembrances of the time he directed the theatre at Weimar (pp.
93-94) (Schiller and their common concern to gain entry into the
best circles for actors and actresses), above all, perhaps, the entry
of January 29, 1926: “I was really interested in the theatre only so
long as I could have a practical influence upon it. It was my
delight to bring the establishment to a high degree of perfection;
and when there was a performance, my interest was not so much
in the pieces as in observing whether the actors played as they
ought …”, etc. (op. cit., p. 127).
314
unity of action is rooted in the characters the more
coherent it is and the more does the play take on
substantiality.
The simplest way of obtaining the maximum unity is
to let it emerge from that of one or two of the main
characters, moved from within by some ordinary passion
or from without by some fatality. This is why so many
tragic or comic plays bear the name of a hero or of a type,
whose role is the title role. Hamlet, The Misanthrope, The
Miser, Faust dominate the plays in which they appear and
which are ordered mainly around them. Therefore, the
invention of the play necessarily implies that of characters
who will accomplish the human acts which make up the
event. The creation of types like Alceste, Harpagon or
others like them is often considered as the triumph of
genius in an author. In any case, it offers a chance for the
success and duration of his work because there will always
be actors who will want to revive such composite roles
which can give greater scope to their talents. But at the
heart of the concern which animates him, the dramatist
finds the desire to obtain to a certainty the maximum
ontological density for his work by ensuring it the
maximum of unity. The actor who “revives” a role of this
kind occupies in relation to him a situation like the
individual-species relationship in Aristotle’s philosophy.
Actors resemble each other as being possible Hamlets,
Phèdres or Tartuffes, but all are different from each other
and this clearly shows that the role has no existence of its
own, it exists only in that it is played.
This strict unity, closely related to that of a character

315
or a situation, is not necessary. The unity of a fable
suffices, for it is enough that the public watching the play
perceives and understands the action as being of one
piece. 19 The unities of time and place are scarcely
important and, in fact, they have never been observed. It
would be really absurd to impose them for the sake of
plausibility, for in the theatre nothing is plausible
beginning with the place itself, the actors and the public.
In what sense is it more plausible to compress into three
hours an action that ought to last twenty-four hours, or
for that matter twenty-four years? The unity of place is
even more arbitrary. Corneille, on whom these restrictions
weighed heavily, noted the price that the observance of
this rule entails.20 Moreover, do we not go to the theatre
to enjoy the improbable and to find in it relief from what
is all too commonplace in reality? Corneille perceived this
too,21 but he lacked the boldness to free himself.
In an absolute sense the creation of the dramatic form
does not require writing, but most often it is through this

19 P. Corneille, Discours sur le poème dramatique, beginning of


the second discourse: “the unity of action in comedy consists in
the unity of plot, or of obstacles to the plans of the principal
actors, and in the tragedy in the unity of danger, whether the hero
succumbs to it or whether he escapes it.”
20 Discours sur le poème dramatique, second discourse: “As

regards the unity of place …,” particularly “The same does not
apply in Rodogune …”
21 Discours sur le poème dramatique, beginning of the first

discourse, where Corneille declares “very wrong” the maxim that


“the subject of a tragedy must be plausible.”
316
form that it is fixed and transmitted. In any case, the fable
itself is the only part of the dramatic work that must
necessarily be invented and executed by the author. In the
dance theatre, or ballet, the action is invented by the
author of the scenario and the choreographer; in the opera
by the author of the libretto and the musician; in comedy
or tragedy, in which the events are the actions of persons
as talking animals, language is the natural means of
expression. This is not absolutely necessary, however,
since action can be mimed. At all events the gestures,
attitudes, and facial movements will play their role, but in
the theatre, as in reality, these accessory means of
expression will be ordered around the principal one,
namely the human voice. Not only will the characters talk
but they will talk much more than real persons do, for the
latter think, reflect and spend much more time in silently
preparing the acts that they intend to carry out. In short,
they are silent for a longer time than a character in a play
being performed in a theatre is allowed to be. The author
views the creation of the character, through whom the
action will take place, essentially as the invention of the
lines that he will have to speak before the audience. He
can indicate some stage business, if he desires, but
essentially Molière’s Don Juan consists only of words
which he puts into his hero’s mouth. Therein lies its whole
substance, and it is up to the actor to do the rest. Hence
the dramatist will inevitably be a writer.22
22Since the work of art has its cause outside itself it is not
answerable, like the works of nature, to the principle of the unity
of substantial form in the structure. On the contrary, it is a
317
To say that a play is a written work before being
spoken is a confirmation of this obvious fact. But from
this it does not follow that a play is at one and the same
time a written work by virtue of its essence and its
destination. It is possible that the performance adds
nothing to the literary beauty of the great dramatic works,
especially if the reader is himself a writer who reads them
as a writer, but a play is first of all written with a view to
being heard and it is not well-written unless the text grips
the imagination of the public when it is spoken on the
stage by actors. This quality distinguishes what is “well-
written” from what is “well-written for the theatre”. A
man of the theatre no doubt can form an opinion merely

remarkable example of the case in which the doctrine of the


plurality of forms is applicable. This is particularly true in the
theatrical work. The author imagines a sequence of possible
events presenting a certain unity of action. In order to impart
existence to it, the writer must have recourse to other persons,
none of whom is the author of the play but each one of whom
practices a particular art, or represents a particular technique, all
of whom, however, contribute to imparting to the theatrical work
the actual existence to which it aspires. Each of them acts as a
subordinate form to the principal form, which arranges them into
an hierarchical order. From the banker and the theatre director,
by way of the stage manager, the actors, including the costume
designer, the hairdresser, the dressmaker, in short all those whose
names must be listed at the beginning of a film or on the
program, each one of whom is commissioned to do well what he
can do and pursues the particular end that the structure of the
play imposes upon him. Here the highest form does not dispense
with the lower forms; without them, indeed, it could do nothing.
318
by reading the play, but the performance is the crucial test.
Racine was an incomparably better writer than Corneille
and Molière, but they were better writers for the stage
than Racine because with them language itself was always
action. Real dramatic dialogue, that which is well-written
for the stage, is that which the writer creates as a language
that is spoken and even acted. One of the major
difficulties which a dramatist must overcome is to refrain
from writing except when under the command of
imaginary voices already “on stage” in his own being in
those parts which real actors some day will play on the
boards. The eighteenth century bequeathed us a quantity
of very well-written plays whose language, however, is
devoid of theatrical virtue. A critic in the nineteenth
century would have occasioned surprise by declaring
Victor Hugo’s language, as theatrical dialogue, to be
inferior to that of Alfred de Musset. If necessary we can
“explain” a play by Racine as we would explain a canto of
the Aeneid, but the authoritative commentary of a great
work that is essentially dramatic is beyond the competence
of a purely literary culture. “Rodriguez, do you have a
heart?” “Allow me to say two words, Count! … Sire, Sire,
justice. Ah! Sire, listen to us!” What have such utterances
to do with the art of “writing well”? Here the beauty of
language in itself is not the aim of the work as it would be
in poetry; what is aimed at here is the beauty of the play
performed on stage to which the beauty of language must
be subordinated in order to serve it. Theatrical styles are
infinitely varied; but all of them as a whole differ from the
other styles which narrate only for the sake of narration

319
and sing only for the sake of singing. The best theatrical
style is that which finds the perfection proper to it by
coinciding with the action. No doubt it would be better to
reverse the proposition and say that action creates style.
This is the deep root of Shakespeare’s supremacy as a
playwright: his poetry is the very substance of theatre. It
would be difficult to go beyond The Tempest in this
direction. If ever there was a “prodigious magician” it was
certainly he who made theatre out of dreams. For
Prospero is a dream, but Shakespeare commissions a real
man to tell us that dreams are the stuff of which man is
made.
Here reflection reaches the point where it would be
wise to pause if we wish to avoid the charge of engaging in
useless subtlety. But perhaps we should risk taking one or
two more steps so that the profound nature of the
theatrical work will not escape our apprehension now that
we have come to the end of our effort.
We have sufficiently stressed, perhaps too much, that
the theatre is essentially dedicated to the presentation of
all events embodied in persons who actually exist. This is
true, but perhaps it is necessary to determine exactly
whether the theatrical work does not create any other
existence save that of an illusion without any reality of its
own. The actors exist, but the characters do not. When
Mounet-Sully appeared at the curtain-call with his
beautiful blood-stained head, the audience was not
applauding Oedipus but him, the actor, the real intercessor
between the beauty conceived by the poet and us who had
seen it through him. Oedipus does not exist, even when

320
he is being played on the stage; he does not exist either as
an individual or as an event. It is only his representation
that exists, and if we want to speak of the existential
vocation of the theatre, the existence of the representation
alone can be the object of discussion. This is the reason,
moreover, why the actor is a creator of beauty and it is the
artist in him whom we applaud.
We know that the reality of the theatre is in truth but
appearance and if we examine the feelings of the spectator
closely we will probably see that he never completely loses
his awareness that he is watching theatre. Nor do any of
us wish him to do so, for it is as a work of art that the
semblance which the theatre creates enchants us. We see
young children brought too early to the theatre, for it is
not as an art that it interests them. They believe in the
reality of what they see and are afraid. Fortunately, no
book of etiquette exists on how to enjoy oneself at the
theatre; the only practically certain rule to go by as we
enter is to leave philosophy at the door. But once we have
experienced this, there is no law against thinking that one
of the best ways of enjoying ourselves in the theatre is to
surrender naively to what it can give us, provided only that
we know how to receive it as the pure pleasure of art.
It is not necessarily the pleasure of a pure art. It is
useful to recall this now that we have arrived at the last of
the major arts, with our discussion of the theatre. Let us
recall here that all the arts are rightfully connected with
each other since all have the creation of beauty as their
aim. Moreover, they remain free to pool the resources
which are proper to each one and which each art has at its

321
disposal, provided only that they observe an architectonic
order among themselves and, so to speak, a hierarchy
among the forms of the arts with which one of them
enters into partnership and subjects to its own end. Of no
other major art is this as true as it is of the theatre. It could
almost be said that the notion of pure art is never posed
with respect to the theatre. Since it is capable of
representing virtually any event whatsoever, a priori we can
see no reason why the cooperation of any other art ought
to be forbidden in the theatre if it helps it attain its proper
end. Greek art combined architecture, the dance, music
and poetry in the drama. Perhaps the art of the theatre
secretly aspires to subsume under its own form the
greatest number of elements possible in the other arts.
Racine himself admitted that when he received the
invitation to write for the theatre of Saint-Cyr it awakened
in him the plan to which he had often given thought,
namely “to combine as in the ancient Greek tragedies the
chorus and the singing with the action, and to use that
section of the chorus which the pagans used to sing the
praises of their false divinities to sing the praises of the
true God.” Here religion itself is once again associated
with the theatre as it seems to have been in its beginnings.
But neither comedy nor tragedy is necessary to the theatre.
Reduced to the role of pretext in the ballet comedy, they
are absorbed by music in the opera or in the musical
comedy, both of which, however, belong to the theatre.
Everything can legitimately be tried, given up, revived,
varied, adorned or stripped of its adornments, for in
contrast to knowledge which takes cognizance of its

322
object, the function of art is to create its own object in
freedom and for beauty’s sake.

323

You might also like